44623a5502523e90e3594a25656be4e3290709a5
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115 backward compatibility.)
3116 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118
3119 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121 name will not be output.
3122
3123 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129 written directly into the spool directory.
3130
3131 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132 .code
3133 exim -bP +local_domains
3134 .endd
3135 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137
3138 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143 that driver are output. For example:
3144 .code
3145 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146 .endd
3147 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152 &%authenticators%&.
3153
3154 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3155 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3156 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3157 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3158 The output format is one item per line.
3159
3160 .vitem &%-bp%&
3161 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3162 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3163 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3164 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3165 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3166 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3167 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3168 to allow any user to see the queue.
3169
3170 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3171 .code
3172 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3173 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3174 <other addresses>
3175 .endd
3176 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3177 .cindex "size" "of message"
3178 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3179 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3180 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3181 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3182 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3183 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3184 before the sender address.
3185
3186 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3187 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3188 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3189
3190 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3191 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3192 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3193 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3194 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3195 complete.
3196
3197
3198 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3199 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3200 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3201 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3202 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3203 of just &"D"&.
3204
3205
3206 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3207 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3208 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3209 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3210 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3211 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3212
3213
3214 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3215 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3216 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3217 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3218 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3219 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3224
3225 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3226 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3227 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3228
3229
3230 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3231 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3232 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3233 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3234 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3235 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3236
3237
3238 .vitem &%-brt%&
3239 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3240 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3241 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3242 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3243 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3244 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3245 .code
3246 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3247 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3248 .endd
3249 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3250 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3251 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3252 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3253 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3254 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3255 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3256 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3257 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3258 .code
3259 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3260 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3261 .endd
3262
3263 .vitem &%-brw%&
3264 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3265 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3266 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3267 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3268 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3269 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3270 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3271 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3272
3273 .vitem &%-bS%&
3274 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3275 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3276 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3277 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3278 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3279 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3280 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3281 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3282 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3283 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3284
3285 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3286 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3287 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3288
3289 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3290 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3291 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3292 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3293
3294 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3295 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3296 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3297
3298 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3299 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3300 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3301 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3302 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3303
3304 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3305 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3306
3307 .vitem &%-bs%&
3308 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3309 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3310 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3311 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3312 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3313 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3314 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3315 messages to the MTA.
3316
3317 In
3318 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3319 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3320 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3321 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3322 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3323 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3324 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3325
3326 .cindex "inetd"
3327 The
3328 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3329 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3330 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3331 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3332 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3333 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3334 the listening daemon.
3335
3336 .vitem &%-bt%&
3337 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3338 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3339 .cindex "address" "testing"
3340 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3341 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3342 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3343 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3344 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3345
3346 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3347 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3348
3349 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3350 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3351 security issues.
3352
3353 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3354 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3355 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3356 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3357 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3358 program.
3359
3360 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3361 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3362 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3363 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3364
3365 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3366 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3367 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3368 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3369 always shown.
3370
3371 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3372 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3373 message,
3374 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3375 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3376 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3377 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3378 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3379 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3380 doing such tests.
3381
3382 .vitem &%-bV%&
3383 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3384 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3385 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3386 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3387 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3388 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3389 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3390
3391 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3392 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3393 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3394 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3395 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3396 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3397 dynamic testing facilities.
3398
3399 .vitem &%-bv%&
3400 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3401 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3402 .cindex "address" "verification"
3403 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3404 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3405 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3406 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3407 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3408 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3409
3410 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3411 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3412 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3413
3414 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3415 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3416
3417 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3418 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3419 security issues.
3420
3421 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3422 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3423 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3424 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3425 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3426
3427 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3428 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3429 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3430 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3431 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3432 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3433 to succeed.
3434
3435 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3436 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3437 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3438
3439 The
3440 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3441 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3442 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3443 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3444
3445 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3446 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3447 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3448 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3449
3450 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3451 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3452 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3453 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3454 might happen.
3455
3456 .vitem &%-bw%&
3457 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3458 .cindex "daemon"
3459 .cindex "inetd"
3460 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3461 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3462 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3463 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3464
3465 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3466 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3467 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3468 each port only when the first connection is received.
3469
3470 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3471 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3472
3473 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3474 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3475 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3476 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3477 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3478 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3479 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3480 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3481 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3482 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3483 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3484
3485 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3486 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3487 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3488 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3489 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3490 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3491 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3492 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3493 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3494
3495 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3496 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3497 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3498 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3499 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3500 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3501 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3502
3503 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3504 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3505 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3506 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3507 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3508 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3509 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3510
3511 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3512 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3513 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3514 configuration file.
3515
3516 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3517 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3518 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3519 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3520 specified by this option.
3521
3522
3523 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3524 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3525 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3526 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3527 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3528 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3529 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3530 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3531
3532 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3533 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3534 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3535 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3536 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3537 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3538 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3539
3540 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3541 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3542 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3543 synonymous:
3544 .code
3545 exim -DABC ...
3546 exim -DABC= ...
3547 .endd
3548 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3549 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3550 example:
3551 .code
3552 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3553 .endd
3554 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3555 .new
3556 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3557 .wen
3558
3559
3560 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3561 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3562 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3563 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3564 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3565 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3566 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3567 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3568 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3569 return code.
3570
3571 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3572 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3573 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3574 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3575 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3576 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3577 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3578 are:
3579 .display
3580 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3581 &`auth `& authenticators
3582 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3583 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3584 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3585 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3586 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3587 &`filter `& filter handling
3588 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3589 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3590 &`ident `& ident lookup
3591 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3592 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3593 &`load `& system load checks
3594 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3595 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3596 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3597 &`memory `& memory handling
3598 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3599 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3600 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3601 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3602 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3603 &`retry `& retry handling
3604 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3605 &`route `& address routing
3606 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3607 &`tls `& TLS logic
3608 &`transport `& transports
3609 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3610 &`verify `& address verification logic
3611 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3612 .endd
3613 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3614 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3615 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3616 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3617 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3618 turn everything off.
3619
3620 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3621 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3622 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3623 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3624 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3625 rather than stderr.
3626
3627 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3628 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3629 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3630 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3631 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3632 run in parallel.
3633
3634 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3635 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3636 in processing.
3637
3638 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3639 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3642 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3643 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3644 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3645 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3646 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3647
3648 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3649 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3650 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3651 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3652 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3653
3654 .vitem &%-E%&
3655 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3656 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3657 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3658 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3659 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3660 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3661 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3662 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3663 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3666 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3667 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3668 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3669 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3670 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3671
3672 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3673 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3674 .cindex "sender" "name"
3675 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3676 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3677 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3678 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3679 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3680 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3681
3682 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3683 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3684 .cindex "sender" "address"
3685 .cindex "address" "sender"
3686 .cindex "trusted users"
3687 .cindex "envelope sender"
3688 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3689 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3690 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3691 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3692 users to use it.
3693
3694 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3695 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3696 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3697 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3698 domain.
3699
3700 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3701 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3702 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3703 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3704 examples of shell commands:
3705 .code
3706 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3707 exim -f "" user@domain
3708 .endd
3709 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3710 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3711 &%-bv%& options.
3712
3713 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3714 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3715 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3716 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3717
3718 White
3719 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3720 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3721 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3722 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3723 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3724 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3725
3726 .vitem &%-G%&
3727 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3728 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3729 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3730 .code
3731 control = suppress_local_fixups
3732 .endd
3733 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3734 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3735 in future.
3736
3737 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3738 this option.
3739
3740 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3741 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3742 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3743 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3744 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3745 headers.)
3746
3747 .vitem &%-i%&
3748 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3749 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3750 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3751 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3752 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3753 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3754 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3755
3756 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3757 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3758 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3759 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3760 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3761 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3762 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3763 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3764
3765 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3766
3767 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3768 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3769 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3770 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3771 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3772 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3773 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3774 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3775 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3776
3777 Retry
3778 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3779 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3780 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3781 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3782 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3783 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3784
3785 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3786 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3787 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3788 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3789
3790 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3791 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3792 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3793 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3794 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3795 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3796 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3797 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3798 can be used only by an admin user.
3799
3800 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3801 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3802 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3803 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3804 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3805 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3806 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3807 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3808 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3809 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3810 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3811
3812 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3813 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3814 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3815 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3816 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3817
3818 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3819 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3820 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3821 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3822 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3823
3824 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3825 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3826 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3827 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3828 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3829
3830 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3831 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3832 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3833 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3834 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3835 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3836 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3837 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3844 connection.
3845
3846 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3847 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3848 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3849 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3850 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3851
3852 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3853 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3854 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3855 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3856 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3857 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3858 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3859 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3860 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3861 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3862 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3863 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3864 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3865 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3866 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3867
3868 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3869 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3870 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3871 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3872 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3873 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3874 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3875 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3876 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3877 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3878
3879 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3880 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3881 .cindex "freezing messages"
3882 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3883 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3884 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3885 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3886 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3887 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3888 user.
3889
3890 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3891 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3892 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3893 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3894 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3895 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3896 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3897 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3898 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3899 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3900 user.
3901
3902 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3904 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3905 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3906 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3907 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3908 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3909
3910 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3911 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3912 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3913 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3914 .cindex "removing recipients"
3915 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3916 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3917 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3918 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3919 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3920 can be used only by an admin user.
3921
3922 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3923 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3924 .cindex "removing messages"
3925 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3926 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3927 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3928 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3929 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3930 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3931 placed on the queue.
3932
3933 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3934 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3935 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3936 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3937 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3938 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3939 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3940 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3941 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3942 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3943 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3944
3945 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3947 .cindex "thawing messages"
3948 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3949 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3950 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3951 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3952 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3953 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3954 by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3958 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3959 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3960 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3961 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3962
3963 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3964 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3965 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3967 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3968 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3969 only by an admin user.
3970
3971 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3972 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3973 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3974 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3977 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3980 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3981 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3982 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3983 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3984 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3985
3986 .vitem &%-m%&
3987 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3988 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3989 treats it that way too.
3990
3991 .vitem &%-N%&
3992 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3993 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3994 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3995 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3996 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3997 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3998 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3999 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4000 than &"=>"&.
4001
4002 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4003 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4004 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4005 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4006 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4007 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4008 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4009 for that message.
4010
4011 .vitem &%-n%&
4012 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4013 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4014 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4015 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4016
4017 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4018 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4019 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4020 Exim.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4024 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4025 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4026 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4027 description above.
4028
4029 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4030 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4031 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4032 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4033 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4034 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4035 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4036 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4037
4038 .vitem &%-odb%&
4039 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4040 .cindex "background delivery"
4041 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4042 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4043 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4044 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4045 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4046 processes to finish.
4047
4048 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4049 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4050 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4051 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4052
4053 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4054 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4055 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4056 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4057
4058 .vitem &%-odf%&
4059 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4060 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4061 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4062 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4063 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4064 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4065 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4066
4067 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4068 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4069 during deliveries.
4070
4071 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4072 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4073
4074 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4075 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4076 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4077 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4078
4079
4080 .vitem &%-odi%&
4081 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4082 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4083 Sendmail.
4084
4085 .vitem &%-odq%&
4086 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4087 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4088 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4089 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4090 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4091 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4092 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4093 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4094 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4095 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4096 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4097 forces queueing.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4100 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4102 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4103 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4104 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4105 configuration file is in effect.
4106
4107 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4108 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4109 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4110 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4111 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4112 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4113 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4114 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4115 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4116 &%-qq%& option.
4117
4118 .vitem &%-oee%&
4119 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4120 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4121 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4122 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4123 message.
4124
4125 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4126 Provided
4127 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4128 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4129 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4130 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4131
4132 .vitem &%-oem%&
4133 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4134 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4135 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4136 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4137 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4138 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4139
4140 .vitem &%-oep%&
4141 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4142 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4143 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4144 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4145 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4146 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4147
4148 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4149 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4150 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4151 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4152 effect as &%-oep%&.
4153
4154 .vitem &%-oew%&
4155 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4156 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4157 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4158 effect as &%-oem%&.
4159
4160 .vitem &%-oi%&
4161 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4162 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4163 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4164 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4165 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4166 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4167 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4170 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4171 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4172
4173 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4174 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4175 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4176 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4177 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4178 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4179 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4180 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4181
4182 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4183 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4184 .code
4185 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4186 .endd
4187 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4188 followed by a colon and the port number:
4189 .code
4190 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4191 .endd
4192 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4193 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4194 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4195 whichever one is last.
4196
4197 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4198 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4199 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4200 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4201 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4202 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4203 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4204 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4205
4206 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4207 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4208 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4209 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4210 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4211 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4212 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4213 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4214
4215 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4216 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4217 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4218 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4219 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4220 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4221 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4222 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4223 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4224 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4225
4226 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4227 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4228 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4229 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4230 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4231 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4232 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4233
4234 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4235 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4236 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4237 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4238 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4239 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4240 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4241 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4242 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4243
4244 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4245 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4246 is sending the bounce.
4247
4248 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4249 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4250 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4251 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4252 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4253 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4254 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4255 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4256 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4257 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4258 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4259 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4260
4261 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4262 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4263 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4264 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4265 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4266 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4267 uses the name it is given.
4268
4269 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4270 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4271 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4272 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4273 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4274 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4275 used, when there is no default.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-om%&
4278 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4280 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4281 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4282 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4283
4284 .vitem &%-oo%&
4285 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4286 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4287 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4288 whatever that means.
4289
4290 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4291 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4292 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4293 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4294 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4295 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4296 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4297 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4298 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4299
4300 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4301 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4302 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4303 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4304 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4305 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4306 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4307
4308 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4309 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4310 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4311 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4312 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4313 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4314 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4315 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4316
4317 .vitem &%-ov%&
4318 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4319 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4320
4321 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4322 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4323 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4324 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4325 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4326 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4327 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4328 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4329 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4330 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4331
4332 .vitem &%-pd%&
4333 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4334 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4335 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4336 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4337 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4338 needed.
4339
4340 .vitem &%-ps%&
4341 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4342 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4343 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4344 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4345 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4346 started.
4347
4348 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4349 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4350 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4351 .display
4352 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4353 .endd
4354 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4355 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4356 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4357 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4358 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4359
4360 .vitem &%-q%&
4361 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4362 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4363 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4364 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4365 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4366 and &%-S%& options).
4367
4368 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4369 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4370 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4371 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4372 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4373 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4374
4375 If
4376 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4377 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4378 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4379 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4380 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4381 proceeding.
4382
4383 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4384 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4385 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4386 this to be repeated periodically.
4387
4388 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4389 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4390 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4391 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4392
4393 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4394 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4395 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4396
4397 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4398 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4399 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4400 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4403 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4404 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4405 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4406 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4407 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4408 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4409 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4410 transports are run.
4411
4412 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4413 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4414 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4415 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4416 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4417 delivered down a single SMTP
4418 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4419 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4420 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4421 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4422 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4423 intermittently.
4424
4425 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4426 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4427 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4428 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4429 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4430 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4431 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4432
4433 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4434 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4435 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4436 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4437 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4438 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4439 their retry times are tried.
4440
4441 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4442 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4443 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4444 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4445 frozen or not.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4448 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4449 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4450 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4451 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4452 for later delivery.
4453
4454 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4455 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4456 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4457 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4458 starting message id. For example:
4459 .code
4460 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4461 .endd
4462 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4463 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4464 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4465 .code
4466 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4467 .endd
4468 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4469 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4470 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4471 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4472 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4473 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4474
4475 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4476 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4477 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4478 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4479 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4480 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4481 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4482 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4483 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4484 .code
4485 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4486 .endd
4487 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4488 process every 30 minutes.
4489
4490 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4491 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4492
4493 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4494 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4495 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4496 compatibility.
4497
4498 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4499 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4500 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4501
4502 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4503 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4504 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4505 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4506 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4507 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4508 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4509 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4510 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4511
4512 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4513 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4514 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4515 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4516 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4517 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4518
4519 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4520 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4521 .code
4522 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4523 .endd
4524 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4525 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4526 applied to each queue run.
4527
4528 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4529 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4530 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4531 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4532 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4533 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4534 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4535 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4536 address will be skipped.
4537
4538 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4539 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4540 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4541 &'ff'& is present.
4542
4543 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4544 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4545 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4546 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4547 an arbitrary command instead.
4548
4549 .vitem &%-r%&
4550 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4551 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4552
4553 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4554 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4555 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4556 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4557 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4558 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4559 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4560 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4561
4562 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4563 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4564 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4565 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4566 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4567
4568 .vitem &%-t%&
4569 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4570 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4571 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4572 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4573 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4574 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4575 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4576 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4577 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4578 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4579
4580 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4581 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4582 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4583 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4584 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4585 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4586 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4587 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4588 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4589 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4590 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4591
4592 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4593 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4594 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4595 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4596 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4597 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4598
4599 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4600 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4601 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4602 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4603 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4604 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4605 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4606 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4607 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4608
4609 .vitem &%-ti%&
4610 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4611 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4612 compatibility with Sendmail.
4613
4614 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4615 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4616 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4617 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4618 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4619 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4620 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4621 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4622
4623
4624 .vitem &%-U%&
4625 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4626 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4627 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4628 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4629 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4630 set. Exim ignores this option.
4631
4632 .vitem &%-v%&
4633 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4634 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4635 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4636 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4637 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4638 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4639 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4640 unconditional.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-x%&
4643 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4644 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4645 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4646 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4647 this option.
4648
4649 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4650 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4651 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4652 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4653
4654 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4655 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4656 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4657 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4658 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4659 under most shells.
4660 .endlist
4661
4662 .ecindex IIDclo1
4663 .ecindex IIDclo2
4664
4665
4666 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4667 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4668 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4669 . creates a man page for the options.
4670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4671
4672 .literal xml
4673 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4674 .literal off
4675
4676
4677
4678
4679
4680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4682
4683
4684 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4685 "The runtime configuration file"
4686
4687 .cindex "run time configuration"
4688 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4689 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4690 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4691 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4692 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4693 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4694 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4695 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4696 control.
4697
4698 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4699 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4700 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4701 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4702 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4703 actually alter the string.
4704
4705 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4706 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4707 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4708 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4709 existing file in the list.
4710
4711 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4712 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4713 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4714 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4715 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4716 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4717 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4718 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4719 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4720 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4721 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4722
4723 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4724 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4725 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4726 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4727 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4728
4729 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4730 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4731 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4732 compromise the Exim user account.
4733
4734 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4735 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4736 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4737 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4738 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4739 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4740 configuration.
4741
4742
4743
4744 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4745 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4746 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4747 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4748 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4749 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4750 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4751 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4752 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4753 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4754 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4755
4756 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4757 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4758 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4759 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4760 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4761 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4762 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4763 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4764 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4765 &%-M%&).
4766
4767 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4768 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4769 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4770 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4771 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4772
4773 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4774 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4775 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4776 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4777 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4778 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4779
4780 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4781 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4782 necessarily be discarded.
4783 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4784 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4785 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4786 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4787 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4788 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4789
4790 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4791 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4792 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4793 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4794 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4795 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4796 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4797
4798 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4799 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4800 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4801
4802
4803
4804 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4805 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4806 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4807 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4808 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4809 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4810 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4811 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4812
4813 .ilist
4814 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4815 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4816 .next
4817 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4818 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4819 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4820 .next
4821 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4822 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4823 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4824 .next
4825 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4826 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4827 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4828 .next
4829 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4830 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4831 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4832 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4833 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4834 .next
4835 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4836 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4837 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4838 .next
4839 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4840 want to use this feature, you must set
4841 .code
4842 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4843 .endd
4844 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4845 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4846 .endlist
4847
4848 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4849 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4850 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4851 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4852
4853 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4854 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4855 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4856 and does not introduce a comment.
4857
4858 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4859 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4860 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4861 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4862 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4863
4864 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4865 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4866 change settings as required.
4867
4868 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4869 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4870 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4871 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4872 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4873 described.
4874
4875
4876
4877 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4878 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4879 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4880 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4881 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4882 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4883 using this syntax:
4884 .display
4885 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4886 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4887 .endd
4888 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4889 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4890 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4891 name is required.
4892
4893 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4894 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4895 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4896 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4897
4898 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4899 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4900 for example:
4901 .code
4902 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4903 .include /some/file
4904 .endd
4905 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4906 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4907 inclusion appears.
4908
4909
4910
4911 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4912 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4913 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4914 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4915 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4916 definition, and must be of the form
4917 .display
4918 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4919 .endd
4920 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4921 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4922 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4923 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4924 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4925
4926 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4927 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4928 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4929
4930 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4931 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4932 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4933 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4934 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4935 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4936 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4937 define
4938 .display
4939 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4940 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4941 .endd
4942 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4943 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4944 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4945 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4946 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4947 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4948
4949
4950 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4951 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4952 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4953 &'='&. For example:
4954 .code
4955 MAC = initial value
4956 ...
4957 MAC == updated value
4958 .endd
4959 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4960 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4961 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4962 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4963 .code
4964 MAC = initial value
4965 ...
4966 MAC == MAC and something added
4967 .endd
4968 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4969 from a number of other files.
4970
4971 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4972 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4973 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4974 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4975 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4976 file to be ignored.
4977
4978
4979
4980 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4981 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4982 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4983 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4984 .code
4985 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4986 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4987 .endd
4988 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4989 .code
4990 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4991 .endd
4992 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4993 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4994 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4995
4996
4997 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4998 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4999 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5000 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5001 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5002 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5003 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5004
5005 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5006 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5007 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5008 line. Thus:
5009 .code
5010 .ifdef AAA
5011 message_size_limit = 50M
5012 .else
5013 message_size_limit = 100M
5014 .endif
5015 .endd
5016 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5017 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5018 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5019 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5020 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5021
5022 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5023 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5024 in this line"& will always be true.
5025
5026 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5027 to clarify complicated nestings.
5028
5029
5030
5031 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5032 .cindex "common option syntax"
5033 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5034 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5035 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5036 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5037 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5038 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5039 space) and then the value. For example:
5040 .code
5041 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5042 .endd
5043 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5044 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5045 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5046 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5047 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5048 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5049 word &"hide"&. For example:
5050 .code
5051 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5052 .endd
5053 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5054 .code
5055 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5056 .endd
5057 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5058 all instances of the same driver.
5059
5060 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5061 that are found in option settings.
5062
5063
5064 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5065 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5066 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5067 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5068 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5069 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5070 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5071 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5072 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5073 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5074 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5075 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5076 .code
5077 queue_only
5078 queue_only = true
5079 .endd
5080 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5081 .code
5082 no_queue_only
5083 queue_only = false
5084 .endd
5085 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5086
5087
5088
5089
5090 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5091 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5092 .cindex "format" "integer"
5093 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5094 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5095 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5096 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5097 hexadecimal number.
5098
5099 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5100 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5101 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5102 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5103 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5104 used.
5105
5106
5107 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5108 .cindex "integer format"
5109 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5110 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5111 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5112 Such options are always output in octal.
5113
5114
5115 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5116 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5117 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5118 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5119 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5120
5121
5122
5123 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5124 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5125 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5126 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5127 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5128
5129 .table2 30pt
5130 .irow &%s%& seconds
5131 .irow &%m%& minutes
5132 .irow &%h%& hours
5133 .irow &%d%& days
5134 .irow &%w%& weeks
5135 .endtable
5136
5137 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5138 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5139 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5140
5141
5142
5143 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5144 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5145 .cindex "format" "string"
5146 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5147 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5148 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5149 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5150 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5151 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5152 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5153 therefore equivalent:
5154 .code
5155 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5156 trusted_users = uucp:\
5157 # This comment line is ignored
5158 mail
5159 .endd
5160 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5161 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5162 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5163 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5164 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5165
5166 .table2 100pt
5167 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5168 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5169 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5170 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5171 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5172 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5173 character"
5174 .endtable
5175
5176 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5177 character, that character replaces the pair.
5178
5179 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5180 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5181 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5182 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5183 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5184 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5185
5186
5187 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5188 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5189 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5190 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5191 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5192 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5193 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5194 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5195 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5196 within a quoted configuration string.
5197
5198
5199 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5200 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5201 .cindex "format" "user name"
5202 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5203 .cindex "format" "group name"
5204 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5205 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5206 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5207 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5208
5209
5210 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5211 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5212 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5213 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5214 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5215 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5216 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5217 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5218 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5219 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5220 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5221
5222 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5223 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5224 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5225 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5226 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5227 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5228 example, the list
5229 .code
5230 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5231 .endd
5232 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5233
5234 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5235 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5236 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5237 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5238
5239 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5240 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5241 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5242 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5243 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5244 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5245 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5246 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5247 .code
5248 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5249 .endd
5250 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5251 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5252 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5253
5254 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5255 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5256 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5257 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5258 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5259 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5260 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5261 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5262 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5263 .code
5264 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5265 .endd
5266 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5267 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5268 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5269 the value in quotes. For example:
5270 .code
5271 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5272 .endd
5273 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5274 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5275 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5276 enclosing an empty list item.
5277
5278
5279
5280 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5281 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5282 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5283 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5284 .code
5285 senders = user@domain :
5286 .endd
5287 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5288 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5289 items, the second of which is empty:
5290 .code
5291 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5292 .endd
5293 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5294 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5295 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5296 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5297 .code
5298 senders = :
5299 .endd
5300 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5301 is at the end of the list.
5302
5303
5304
5305
5306 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5307 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5308 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5309 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5310 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5311 a sequence of lines like this:
5312 .display
5313 <&'instance name'&>:
5314 <&'option'&>
5315 ...
5316 <&'option'&>
5317 .endd
5318 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5319 followed by three options settings:
5320 .code
5321 localuser:
5322 driver = accept
5323 check_local_user
5324 transport = local_delivery
5325 .endd
5326 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5327 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5328 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5329 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5330 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5331 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5332
5333 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5334 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5335
5336 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5337 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5338 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5339 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5340 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5341 server.
5342
5343 .cindex "generic options"
5344 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5345 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5346 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5347 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5348 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5349 .cindex "private options"
5350 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5351 they all have default values.
5352
5353 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5354 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5355 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5356
5357 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5358 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5359 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5360 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5361 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5362 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5363 configuration lines:
5364 .code
5365 remote_smtp:
5366 driver = smtp
5367 .endd
5368 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5369 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5370 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5371 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5372 thus:
5373 .code
5374 special_smtp:
5375 driver = smtp
5376 port = 1234
5377 command_timeout = 10s
5378 .endd
5379 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5380 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5381 lines.
5382
5383 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5384 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5385 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5386 option.
5387
5388
5389
5390
5391
5392
5393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5395
5396 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5397 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5398 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5399 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5400 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5401 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5402 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5403 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5404 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5405 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5406 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5407
5408
5409
5410 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5411 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5412 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5413 the line
5414 .code
5415 # primary_hostname =
5416 .endd
5417 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5418 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5419 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5420 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5421
5422 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5423 .code
5424 domainlist local_domains = @
5425 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5426 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5427 .endd
5428 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5429 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5430 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5431 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5432
5433 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5434 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5435 on the local host.
5436
5437 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5438 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5439 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5440 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5441 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5442 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5443
5444 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5445 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5446 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5447 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5448 domain is permitted.
5449
5450 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5451 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5452 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5453 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5454 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5455 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5456
5457 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5458 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5459 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5460
5461 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5462 .code
5463 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5464 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5465 .endd
5466 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5467 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5468 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5469 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5470 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5471 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5472 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5473 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5474 contents of a message to be checked.
5475
5476 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5477 .code
5478 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5479 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5480 .endd
5481 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5482 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5483 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5484 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5485
5486 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5487 .code
5488 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5489 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5490 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5491 .endd
5492 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5493 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5494 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5495 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5496 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5497 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5498 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5499
5500 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5501 .code
5502 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5503 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5504 .endd
5505 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5506 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5507 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5508 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5509 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5510 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5511 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5512 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5513 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5514 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5515 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5516 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5517 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5518 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5519 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5520 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5521
5522 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5523 .code
5524 # qualify_domain =
5525 # qualify_recipient =
5526 .endd
5527 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5528 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5529 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5530 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5531 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5532 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5533
5534 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5535 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5536 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5537 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5538 .code
5539 # allow_domain_literals
5540 .endd
5541 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5542 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5543 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5544 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5545 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5546 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5547
5548 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5549 .code
5550 never_users = root
5551 .endd
5552 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5553 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5554 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5555 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5556 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5557 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5558 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5559 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5560
5561 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5562 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5563 line,
5564 .code
5565 host_lookup = *
5566 .endd
5567 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5568 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5569 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5570 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5571 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5572 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5573 unreachable.
5574
5575 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5576 1413 (hence their names):
5577 .code
5578 rfc1413_hosts = *
5579 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5580 .endd
5581 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5582 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5583 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5584 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5585 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5586 information, you can change this.
5587
5588 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5589 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5590 .code
5591 prdr_enable = true
5592 .endd
5593
5594 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5595 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5596 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5597 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5598 .code
5599 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5600 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5601 .endd
5602 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5603 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5604
5605 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5606 over the default:
5607 .code
5608 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5609 +tls_certificate_verified
5610 .endd
5611
5612 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5613 .code
5614 # percent_hack_domains =
5615 .endd
5616 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5617 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5618 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5619
5620 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5621 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5622 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5623 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5624 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5625 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5626 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5627 always bounce messages.
5628 .code
5629 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5630 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5631 .endd
5632 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5633 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5634 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5635 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5636 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5637
5638
5639
5640 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5641 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5642 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5643 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5644 It starts with the line
5645 .code
5646 begin acl
5647 .endd
5648 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5649 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5650 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5651
5652 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5653 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5654 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5655 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5656 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5657 result of the ACL processing.
5658 .code
5659 acl_check_rcpt:
5660 .endd
5661 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5662 ACL, and names it.
5663 .code
5664 accept hosts = :
5665 .endd
5666 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5667 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5668 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5669 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5670 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5671 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5672
5673 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5674 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5675 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5676 manner.
5677 .code
5678 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5679 domains = +local_domains
5680 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5681
5682 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5683 domains = !+local_domains
5684 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5685 .endd
5686 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5687 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5688 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5689 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5690 in Internet mail addresses.
5691
5692 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5693 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5694 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5695 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5696 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5697 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5698 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5699 policy of being as safe as possible.
5700
5701 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5702 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5703 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5704 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5705 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5706 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5707
5708 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5709 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5710 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5711 have to modify this rule.
5712
5713 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5714 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5715 common convention of local parts constructed as
5716 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5717 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5718 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5719 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5720 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5721 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5722
5723 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5724 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5725 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5726 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5727 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5728 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5729 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5730 .code
5731 accept local_parts = postmaster
5732 domains = +local_domains
5733 .endd
5734 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5735 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5736 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5737 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5738 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5739
5740 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5741 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5742 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5743 .code
5744 require verify = sender
5745 .endd
5746 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5747 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5748 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5749 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5750 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5751 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5752 discusses the details of address verification.
5753 .code
5754 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5755 control = submission
5756 .endd
5757 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5758 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5759 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5760 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5761 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5762 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5763 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5764 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5765 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5766 .code
5767 accept authenticated = *
5768 control = submission
5769 .endd
5770 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5771 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5772 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5773 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5774 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5775 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5776 .code
5777 require message = relay not permitted
5778 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5779 .endd
5780 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5781 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5782 .code
5783 require verify = recipient
5784 .endd
5785 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5786 fails, the address is rejected.
5787 .code
5788 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5789 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5790 # $dnslist_text
5791 # dnslists = black.list.example
5792 #
5793 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5794 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5795 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5796 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5797 .endd
5798 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5799 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5800 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5801 line.
5802 .code
5803 # require verify = csa
5804 .endd
5805 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5806 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5807 records.
5808 .code
5809 accept
5810 .endd
5811 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5812 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5813 .code
5814 acl_check_data:
5815 .endd
5816 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5817 of this ACL are commented out:
5818 .code
5819 # deny malware = *
5820 # message = This message contains a virus \
5821 # ($malware_name).
5822 .endd
5823 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5824 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5825 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5826 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5827 .code
5828 # warn spam = nobody
5829 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5830 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5831 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5832 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5833 .endd
5834 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5835 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5836 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5837 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5838 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5839 whatever the spam score.
5840 .code
5841 accept
5842 .endd
5843 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5844
5845
5846 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5847 .cindex "default" "routers"
5848 .cindex "routers" "default"
5849 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5850 by the line
5851 .code
5852 begin routers
5853 .endd
5854 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5855 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5856 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5857 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5858 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5859 .code
5860 # domain_literal:
5861 # driver = ipliteral
5862 # domains = !+local_domains
5863 # transport = remote_smtp
5864 .endd
5865 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5866 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5867 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5868 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5869 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5870 .code
5871 dnslookup:
5872 driver = dnslookup
5873 domains = ! +local_domains
5874 transport = remote_smtp
5875 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5876 no_more
5877 .endd
5878 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5879 domains. This is specified by the line
5880 .code
5881 domains = ! +local_domains
5882 .endd
5883 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5884 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5885 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5886 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5887 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5888 passed on to the following routers.
5889
5890 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5891 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5892 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5893 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5894 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5895
5896 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5897 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5898 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5899 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5900 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5901 the address fails and is bounced.
5902
5903 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5904 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5905 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5906 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5907 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5908 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5909 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5910 out.
5911 .code
5912 system_aliases:
5913 driver = redirect
5914 allow_fail
5915 allow_defer
5916 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5917 # user = exim
5918 file_transport = address_file
5919 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5920 .endd
5921 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5922 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5923 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5924 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5925 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5926 the next router.
5927
5928 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5929 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5930 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5931 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5932 .code
5933 userforward:
5934 driver = redirect
5935 check_local_user
5936 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5937 # local_part_suffix_optional
5938 file = $home/.forward
5939 # allow_filter
5940 no_verify
5941 no_expn
5942 check_ancestor
5943 file_transport = address_file
5944 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5945 reply_transport = address_reply
5946 .endd
5947 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5948 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5949 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5950 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5951 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5952 namely:
5953 .code
5954 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5955 # local_part_suffix_optional
5956 .endd
5957 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5958 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5959 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5960 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5961 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5962 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5963 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5964
5965 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5966 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5967 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5968 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5969
5970 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5971 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5972 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5973 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5974 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5975 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5976 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5977
5978 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5979 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5980 There are two reasons for doing this:
5981
5982 .olist
5983 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5984 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5985 unnecessary work.
5986 .next
5987 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5988 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5989 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5990 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5991 this time.
5992 .endlist
5993
5994 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5995 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5996 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5997 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5998
5999 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6000 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6001 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6002 .code
6003 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6004 .endd
6005 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6006 transport.
6007 .code
6008 localuser:
6009 driver = accept
6010 check_local_user
6011 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6012 # local_part_suffix_optional
6013 transport = local_delivery
6014 .endd
6015 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6016 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6017 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6018 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6019 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6020
6021
6022 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6023 .cindex "default" "transports"
6024 .cindex "transports" "default"
6025 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6026 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6027 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6028 .code
6029 begin transports
6030 .endd
6031 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6032 .code
6033 remote_smtp:
6034 driver = smtp
6035 hosts_try_prdr = *
6036 .endd
6037 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6038 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6039 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6040 It is negotiated between client and server
6041 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6042 All other options are defaulted.
6043 .code
6044 local_delivery:
6045 driver = appendfile
6046 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6047 delivery_date_add
6048 envelope_to_add
6049 return_path_add
6050 # group = mail
6051 # mode = 0660
6052 .endd
6053 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6054 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6055 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6056 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6057 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6058 show how this can be done.
6059
6060 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6061 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6062 similarly-named options above.
6063 .code
6064 address_pipe:
6065 driver = pipe
6066 return_output
6067 .endd
6068 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6069 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6070 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6071 be returned to the sender.
6072 .code
6073 address_file:
6074 driver = appendfile
6075 delivery_date_add
6076 envelope_to_add
6077 return_path_add
6078 .endd
6079 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6080 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6081 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6082 .code
6083 address_reply:
6084 driver = autoreply
6085 .endd
6086 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6087 filter files.
6088
6089
6090
6091 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6092 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6093 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6094 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6095 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6096 introduced by the line
6097 .code
6098 begin retry
6099 .endd
6100 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6101 errors:
6102 .code
6103 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6104 .endd
6105 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6106 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6107 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6108 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6109
6110 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6111 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6112 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6113
6114
6115 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6116 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6117 .code
6118 begin rewrite
6119 .endd
6120 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6121 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6122
6123
6124
6125 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6126 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6127 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6128 .code
6129 begin authenticators
6130 .endd
6131 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6132 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6133 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6134 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6135 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6136 to support most MUA software.
6137
6138 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6139 .code
6140 #PLAIN:
6141 # driver = plaintext
6142 # server_set_id = $auth2
6143 # server_prompts = :
6144 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6145 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6146 .endd
6147 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6148 .code
6149 #LOGIN:
6150 # driver = plaintext
6151 # server_set_id = $auth1
6152 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6153 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6154 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6155 .endd
6156
6157 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6158 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6159 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6160 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6161 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6162 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6163 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6164 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6165
6166 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6167 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6168 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6169 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6170
6171 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6172 usercode and password are in different positions.
6173 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6174
6175 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6176
6177
6178
6179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6181
6182 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6183
6184 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6185 .cindex "PCRE"
6186 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6187 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6188 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6189 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6190 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6191 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6192
6193 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6194 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6195 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6196 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6197 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6198 case-insensitive.
6199
6200 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6201 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6202 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6203 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6204 .code
6205 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6206 .endd
6207 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6208 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6209 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6210 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6211 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6212 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6213 matched.
6214
6215 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6216 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6217 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6218 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6219 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6220 match anywhere in the subject string.
6221
6222 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6223 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6224 .code
6225 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6226 .endd
6227 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6228 You need to use:
6229 .code
6230 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6231 .endd
6232 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6233 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6234
6235
6236
6237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6239
6240 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6241 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6242 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6243 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6244 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6245 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6246
6247 .olist
6248 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6249 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6250 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6251 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6252 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6253 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6254 .next
6255 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6256 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6257 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6258 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6259 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6260 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6261 .endlist
6262
6263 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6264 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6265 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6266 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6267 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6268 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6269
6270 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6271 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6272 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6273 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6274 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6275 .code
6276 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6277 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6278 .endd
6279 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6280 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6281 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6282 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6283 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6284 .code
6285 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6286 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6287 .endd
6288 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6289 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6290
6291 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6292 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6293 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6294 .code
6295 domain1:
6296 domain2:
6297 .endd
6298 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6299 matches the list item.
6300
6301 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6302 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6303 .code
6304 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6305 .endd
6306 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6307 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6308 causes a second lookup to occur.
6309
6310 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6311 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6312 lookup is permitted.
6313
6314
6315 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6316 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6317 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6318 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6319
6320 .ilist
6321 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6322 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6323 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6324 .next
6325 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6326 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6327 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6328 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6329 .endlist
6330
6331 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6332 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6333 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6334 .code
6335 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6336 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6337 .endd
6338 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6339 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6340 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6341
6342
6343
6344
6345 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6346 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6347 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6348 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6349
6350 .ilist
6351 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6352 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6353 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6354 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6355 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6356 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6357 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6358 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6359 be found in several places:
6360 .display
6361 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6362 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6363 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6364 .endd
6365 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6366 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6367 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6368 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6369 .next
6370 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6371 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6372 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6373 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6374 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6375 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6376 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6377
6378 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6379 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6380 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6381 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6382 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6383 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6384 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6385 .next
6386 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6387 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6388 .cindex "sasldb2"
6389 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6390 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6391 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6392 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6393 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6394 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6395 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6396 .next
6397 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6398 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6399 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6400 .cindex "Courier"
6401 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6402 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6403 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6404 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6405 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6406 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6407 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6408 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6409 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6410 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6411 .next
6412 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6413 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6414 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6415 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6416 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6417 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6418 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6419 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6420 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6421 .next
6422 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6423 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6424 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6425 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6426 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6427 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6428 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6429 .code
6430 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6431 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6432 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6433 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6434 .endd
6435 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6436 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6437 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6438 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6439 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6440
6441 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6442 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6443 lookup types support only literal keys.
6444
6445 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6446 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6447 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6448 .next
6449 .cindex "linear search"
6450 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6451 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6452 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6453 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6454 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6455 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6456 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6457 in the file is used.
6458
6459 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6460 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6461 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6462 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6463 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6464 colon, for example:
6465 .code
6466 baduser: :fail:
6467 .endd
6468 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6469 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6470 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6471 wildcarding of any kind.
6472
6473 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6474 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6475 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6476 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6477 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6478 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6479 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6480 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6481 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6482
6483 .next
6484 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6485 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6486 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6487 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6488 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6489 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6490 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6491 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6492
6493 .next
6494 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6495 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6496 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6497 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6498 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6499 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6500 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6501 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6502 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6503
6504 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6505 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6506 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6507 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6508
6509 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6510 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6511
6512 .olist
6513 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6514 .code
6515 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6516 *fish data for anythingfish
6517 .endd
6518 .next
6519 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6520 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6521 .code
6522 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6523 .endd
6524 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6525 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6526 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6527 .code
6528 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6529 .endd
6530 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6531 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6532 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6533 .code
6534 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6535 .endd
6536
6537 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6538 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6539 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6540 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6541 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6542
6543 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6544 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6545 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6546 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6547 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6548
6549 .next
6550 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6551 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6552 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6553 example:
6554 .code
6555 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6556 .endd
6557 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6558 .endlist olist
6559
6560 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6561 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6562 be followed by optional colons.
6563
6564 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6565 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6566 lookup types support only literal keys.
6567 .endlist ilist
6568
6569
6570 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6571 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6572 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6573 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6574 many of them are given in later sections.
6575
6576 .ilist
6577 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6578 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6579 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6580 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6581 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6582 .next
6583 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6584 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6585 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6586 .next
6587 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6588 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6589 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6590 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6591 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6592 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6593 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6594 .next
6595 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6596 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6597 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6598 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6599 .next
6600 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6601 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6602 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6603 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6604 .next
6605 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6606 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6607 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6608 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6609 .next
6610 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6611 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6612 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6613 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6614 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6615 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6616 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6617 password value. For example:
6618 .code
6619 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6620 .endd
6621 .next
6622 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6623 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6624 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6625 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6626
6627 .next
6628 .new
6629 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6630 .cindex lookup Redis
6631 &(redis)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6632 Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6633 .wen
6634
6635 .next
6636 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6637 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6638 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6639 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6640
6641 .next
6642 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6643 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6644 .next
6645 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6646 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6647 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6648 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6649 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6650 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6651 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6652 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6653 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6654 .code
6655 require condition = \
6656 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6657 .endd
6658 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6659 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6660 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6661 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6662 .endlist
6663
6664
6665
6666 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6668 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6669 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6670 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6671 options such as a list of local domains.
6672
6673 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6674 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6675 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6676 or may give up altogether.
6677
6678
6679
6680 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6681 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6682 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6683 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6684 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6685 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6686 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6687 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6688
6689 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6690 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6691 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6692
6693 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6694 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6695 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6696
6697 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6698 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6699 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6700 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6701 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6702 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6703 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6704 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6705 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6706 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6707 .code
6708 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6709 .endd
6710 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6711 looks up these keys, in this order:
6712 .code
6713 jane@eyre.example
6714 *@eyre.example
6715 *
6716 .endd
6717 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6718 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6719 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6720 Exim move on to try the next key.
6721
6722
6723
6724 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6725 .cindex "partial matching"
6726 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6727 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6728 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6729 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6730 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6731 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6732 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6733 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6734 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6735 a key in a DBM file is
6736 .code
6737 *.dates.fict.example
6738 .endd
6739 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6740 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6741 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6742 file.
6743
6744 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6745 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6746 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6747
6748 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6749 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6750 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6751 partial matching keys
6752 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6753 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6754 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6755
6756 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6757 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6758 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6759 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6760 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6761 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6762 remains.
6763
6764 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6765 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6766 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6767 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6768 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6769 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6770 .code
6771 2250.dates.fict.example
6772 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6773 *.dates.fict.example
6774 *.fict.example
6775 .endd
6776 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6777 finishes.
6778
6779 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6780 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6781 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6782 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6783 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6784 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6785 .code
6786 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6787 .endd
6788 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6789 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6790 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6791 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6792 .code
6793 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6794 .endd
6795 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6796 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6797
6798 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6799 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6800 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6801
6802 .ilist
6803 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6804 .next
6805 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6806 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6807 .next
6808 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6809 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6810 for &"*"& on its own.
6811 .next
6812 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6813 .endlist
6814
6815
6816 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6817 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6818 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6819 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6820 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6821 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6822 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6823
6824 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6825 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6826 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6827 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6828 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6829
6830
6831
6832
6833 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6834 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6835 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6836 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6837 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6838 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6839 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6840
6841 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6842 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6843 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6844 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6845 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6846 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6847
6848 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6849 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6850 complete.
6851
6852
6853
6854
6855 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6856 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6857 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6858 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6859 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6860 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6861 .code
6862 [name=$local_part]
6863 .endd
6864 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6865 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6866 .code
6867 [name="$local_part"]
6868 .endd
6869 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6870 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6871 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6872 of the following form is provided:
6873 .code
6874 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6875 .endd
6876 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6877 .code
6878 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6879 .endd
6880 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6881 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6882 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6883
6884
6885
6886
6887 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6888 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6889 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6890 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6891 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6892 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6893 an expansion string could contain:
6894 .code
6895 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6896 .endd
6897 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6898 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6899 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6900 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6901
6902 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6903 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6904 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6905
6906 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6907 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6908 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6909 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6910 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6911 .code
6912 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6913 .endd
6914 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6915 white space is ignored.
6916 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6917 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6918 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6919
6920 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6921 When the type is PTR,
6922 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6923 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6924 .code
6925 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6926 .endd
6927 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6928 altered and nothing is added.
6929
6930 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6931 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6932 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6933 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6934 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6935 The field separator can be modified as above.
6936
6937 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6938 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6939 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6940 unless a field separator is specified.
6941 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6942 For SPF records the
6943 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6944 .code
6945 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6946 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6947 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6948 .endd
6949 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6950 white space is ignored.
6951
6952 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6953 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6954 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6955 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6956 specified.
6957 .code
6958 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6959 .endd
6960
6961 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6962 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6963 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6964 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6965 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6966 each followed by a comma,
6967 that may appear before the record type.
6968
6969 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6970 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6971 a defer-option modifier.
6972 The possible keywords are
6973 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6974 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6975 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6976 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6977 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6978 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6979 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6980 .code
6981 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6982 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6983 .endd
6984 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6985 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6986
6987 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6988 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6989 The possible keywords are
6990 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6991 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6992 with the lookup.
6993 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6994 is not labelled as authenticated data
6995 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6996 The default is &"never"&.
6997
6998 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6999
7000 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7001 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7002 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7003 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7004 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7005 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7006
7007 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7008 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7009 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7010
7011 .new
7012 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7013 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7014 .cindex DNS TTL
7015 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7016 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7017 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7018 .wen
7019
7020
7021 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7022 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7023 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7024 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7025 the pseudo-type MXH:
7026 .code
7027 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7028 .endd
7029 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7030 returned.
7031
7032 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7033 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7034 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7035 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7036 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7037 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7038 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7039 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7040 .code
7041 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7042 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7043 .endd
7044 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7045 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7046 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7047
7048 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7049 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7050 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7051 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7052 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7053 such a list.
7054
7055 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7056 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7057 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7058 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7059 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7060 result of a successful lookup such as:
7061 .code
7062 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7063 .endd
7064 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7065 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7066 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7067
7068 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7069 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7070 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7071 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7072 .code
7073 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7074 .endd
7075
7076
7077 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7078 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7079 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7080 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7081 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7082 .code
7083 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7084 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7085 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7086 .endd
7087 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7088 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7089 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7090 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7091
7092 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7093 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7094 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7095
7096
7097
7098
7099 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7100 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7101 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7102 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7103 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7104 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7105 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7106 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7107 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7108 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7109 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7110 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7111 .code
7112 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7113 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7114 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7115 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7116 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7117 .endd
7118 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7119 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7120
7121 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7122 the way they handle the results of a query:
7123
7124 .ilist
7125 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7126 gives an error.
7127 .next
7128 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7129 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7130 .next
7131 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7132 from all of them are returned.
7133 .endlist
7134
7135
7136 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7137 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7138 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7139 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7140
7141
7142 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7143 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7144 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7145 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7146 .code
7147 data = ${lookup ldap \
7148 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7149 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7150 .endd
7151 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7152 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7153 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7154 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7155
7156 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7157 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7158 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7159
7160 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7161 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7162 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7163 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7164 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7165 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7166 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7167 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7168 &_exim.conf_&.
7169
7170
7171 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7172 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7173 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7174 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7175 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7176 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7177
7178 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7179 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7180 the string:
7181 .code
7182 * => \2A
7183 ( => \28
7184 ) => \29
7185 \ => \5C
7186 .endd
7187 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7188 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7189 .code
7190 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7191 .endd
7192 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7193 .code
7194 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7195 .endd
7196 yields
7197 .code
7198 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7199 .endd
7200 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7201 .code
7202 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7203 .endd
7204 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7205 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7206 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7207 .code
7208 , + " \ < > ;
7209 .endd
7210 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7211 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7212 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7213 .code
7214 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7215 .endd
7216 yields
7217 .code
7218 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7219 .endd
7220 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7221 .code
7222 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7223 .endd
7224 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7225 authentication below.
7226
7227
7228 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7229 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7230 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7231 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7232 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7233 by starting it with
7234 .code
7235 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7236 .endd
7237 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7238 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7239 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7240 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7241 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7242 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7243 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7244 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7245 failures, and timeouts.
7246
7247 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7248 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7249 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7250 doubled. For example
7251 .code
7252 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7253 .endd
7254 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7255 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7256 the local host) is used.
7257
7258 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7259 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7260 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7261 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7262 not available.
7263
7264 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7265 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7266 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7267 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7268 .code
7269 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7270 .endd
7271 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7272 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7273 .code
7274 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7275 .endd
7276 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7277 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7278 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7279 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7280 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7281 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7282 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7283 backup host.
7284
7285 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7286 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7287 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7288
7289 .ilist
7290 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7291 interface.
7292 .next
7293 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7294 .endlist
7295
7296
7297 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7298 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7299
7300
7301
7302 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7303 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7304 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7305 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7306 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7307 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7308 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7309 them. The following names are recognized:
7310 .display
7311 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7312 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7313 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7314 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7315 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7316 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7317 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7318 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7319 .endd
7320 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7321 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7322 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7323 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7324
7325 .cindex LDAP timeout
7326 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7327 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7328 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7329 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7330 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7331 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7332 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7333 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7334 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7335 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7336
7337 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7338 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7339
7340 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7341 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7342 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7343 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7344 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7345 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7346 alternate list (colon-separated).
7347
7348 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7349 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7350 .code
7351 ${lookup ldap
7352 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7353 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7354 {$value}fail}
7355 .endd
7356 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7357 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7358 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7359 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7360
7361 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7362 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7363 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7364
7365 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7366 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7367 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7368 quoting has two advantages:
7369
7370 .ilist
7371 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7372 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7373 .next
7374 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7375 .endlist
7376
7377 For example, a setting such as
7378 .code
7379 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7380 .endd
7381 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7382
7383 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7384 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7385 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7386 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7387 .code
7388 PASS=${quote:$3}
7389 .endd
7390 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7391 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7392 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7393
7394
7395
7396 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7397 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7398 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7399 as a sequence of values, for example
7400 .code
7401 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7402 .endd
7403 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7404 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7405 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7406 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7407 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7408 directory.
7409
7410 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7411 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7412 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7413 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7414
7415 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7416 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7417 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7418 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7419 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7420 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7421 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7422 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7423 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7424
7425 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7426 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7427 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7428 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7429 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7430
7431 .code
7432 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7433 value1.1,value1,,2
7434
7435 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7436 value two
7437
7438 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7439 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7440
7441 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7442 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7443
7444 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7445 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7446 .endd
7447 You can
7448 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7449 results of LDAP lookups.
7450 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7451 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7452 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7453 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7454 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7455 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7456
7457
7458
7459
7460 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7461 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7462 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7463 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7464 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7465 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7466 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7467 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7468 .code
7469 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7470 .endd
7471 might return the string
7472 .code
7473 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7474 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7475 .endd
7476 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7477 .code
7478 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7479 .endd
7480 would just return
7481 .code
7482 Martin Guerre
7483 .endd
7484 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7485 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7486 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7487
7488
7489
7490 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7491 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7492 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7493 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7494 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7495 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7496 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7497 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7498 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7499 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7500 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7501 .cindex lookup Redis
7502 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7503 and SQLite
7504 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7505 might be
7506 .code
7507 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7508 {$value}fail}
7509 .endd
7510 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7511 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7512 .code
7513 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7514 {$value}}
7515 .endd
7516 might be
7517 .code
7518 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7519 .endd
7520 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7521 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7522 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7523 .code
7524 Mister X
7525 .endd
7526 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7527 with a newline between the data for each row.
7528
7529
7530 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7531 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7532 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7533 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7534 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7535 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7536 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7537 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7538 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7539 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7540 .cindex lookup Redis
7541 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7542 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7543 or &%redis_servers%&
7544 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7545 information.
7546 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7547 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7548 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7549 For all but Redis
7550 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7551 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7552 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7553 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7554 .code
7555 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7556 .endd
7557 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7558 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7559 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7560 .code
7561 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7562 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7563 .endd
7564 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7565 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7566 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7567 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7568 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7569 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7570
7571 .new
7572 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7573 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7574 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7575 information.
7576 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7577 host, database number, and password.
7578 .olist
7579 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7580 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7581 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7582 .next
7583 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7584 .next
7585 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7586 .endlist
7587 .wen
7588
7589 .new
7590 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7591 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7592 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7593 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7594
7595 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7596 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7597 .wen
7598
7599 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7600 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7601 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7602 done by starting the query with
7603 .display
7604 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7605 .endd
7606 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7607 .olist
7608 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7609 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7610 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7611 taken from there.
7612 .next
7613 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7614 .endlist
7615 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7616 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7617 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7618
7619 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7620 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7621 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7622 like this:
7623 .code
7624 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7625 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7626 master/db/name/pw
7627 .endd
7628 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7629 .code
7630 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7631 .endd
7632 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7633 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7634 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7635 .code
7636 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7637 .endd
7638
7639
7640 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7641 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7642 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7643 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7644 .new
7645 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7646 the default value is &"exim"&.
7647 .wen
7648 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7649 .display
7650 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7651 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7652 .endd
7653 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7654 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7655
7656 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7657 the queries.
7658
7659 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7660 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7661
7662 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7663 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7664 is zero because no rows are affected.
7665
7666
7667 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7668 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7669 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7670 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7671 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7672 looks like this:
7673 .code
7674 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7675 .endd
7676 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7677 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7678 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7679
7680 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7681 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7682 affected.
7683
7684 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7685 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7686 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7687 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7688 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7689 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7690 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7691 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7692 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7693 .code
7694 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7695 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7696 .endd
7697 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7698 .code
7699 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7700 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7701 .endd
7702 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7703 quote, which it doubles.
7704
7705 .cindex timeout SQLite
7706 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7707 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7708 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7709 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7710 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7711 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7712 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7713 option.
7714 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7715 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7716
7717
7718 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7720
7721 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7722 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7723 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7724 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7725 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7726 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7727 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7728 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7729 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7730
7731 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7732 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7733 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7734 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7735
7736 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7737 support all the complexity available in
7738 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7739
7740
7741
7742 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7743 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7744 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7745 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7746 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7747 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7748 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7749 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7750
7751
7752 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7753 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7754 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7755
7756 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7757 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7758 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7759 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7760 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7761 .code
7762 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7763 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7764 .endd
7765 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7766 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7767 senders based on the receiving domain.
7768
7769
7770
7771
7772 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7773 .cindex "list" "negation"
7774 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7775 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7776 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7777 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7778 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7779 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7780
7781 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7782 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7783 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7784 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7785 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7786 .code
7787 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7788 .endd
7789 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7790 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7791 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7792 .code
7793 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7794 .endd
7795 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7796 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7797 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7798
7799 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7800 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7801 item.
7802
7803
7804
7805 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7806 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7807 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7808 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7809 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7810 file names are not allowed,
7811 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7812 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7813 lines:
7814
7815 .ilist
7816 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7817 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7818 .next
7819 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7820 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7821 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7822 .code
7823 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7824 .endd
7825 .endlist
7826
7827 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7828 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7829 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7830 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7831
7832 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7833 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7834 .code
7835 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7836 .endd
7837 and the file contains the lines
7838 .code
7839 !a.b.c
7840 *.b.c
7841 .endd
7842 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7843 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7844
7845
7846
7847 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7848 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7849 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7850 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7851 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7852 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7853 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7854 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7855
7856 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7857 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7858 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7859 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7860
7861
7862
7863
7864 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7865 .cindex "named lists"
7866 .cindex "list" "named"
7867 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7868 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7869 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7870 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7871 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7872 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7873 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7874 .code
7875 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7876 .endd
7877 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7878 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7879 configured with the line
7880 .code
7881 domains = +local_domains
7882 .endd
7883 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7884 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7885 .code
7886 dnslookup:
7887 driver = dnslookup
7888 domains = ! +local_domains
7889 transport = remote_smtp
7890 no_more
7891 .endd
7892 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7893 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7894 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7895 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7896 .code
7897 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7898 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7899 .endd
7900 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7901 .code
7902 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7903 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7904 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7905 .endd
7906 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7907 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7908 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7909 .code
7910 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7911 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7912 .endd
7913 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7914 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7915 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7916 .code
7917 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7918 .endd
7919 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7920 referenced lists if you can.
7921
7922 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7923 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7924 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7925 .code
7926 domains = +local_domains
7927 .endd
7928 on several of your routers
7929 or in several ACL statements,
7930 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7931 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7932 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7933 the same each time they are referenced.
7934
7935 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7936 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7937 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7938 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7939
7940
7941
7942 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7943 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7944 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7945 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7946 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7947 write
7948 .code
7949 ALIST = host1 : host2
7950 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7951 .endd
7952 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7953 .code
7954 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7955 .endd
7956 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7957 list, and write
7958 .code
7959 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7960 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7961 .endd
7962 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7963 .code
7964 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7965 .endd
7966
7967
7968 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7969 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7970 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7971 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7972 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7973 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7974 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7975 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7976 message. For example:
7977 .code
7978 domainlist special_domains = \
7979 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7980 .endd
7981 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7982 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7983 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7984 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7985 same list each time.
7986
7987 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7988 cache the result anyway. For example:
7989 .code
7990 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7991 .endd
7992 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7993 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7994
7995
7996
7997 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7998 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7999 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8000 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8001 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8002
8003 .ilist
8004 .cindex "primary host name"
8005 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8006 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8007 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8008 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8009 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8010 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8011 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8012 differ only in their names.
8013 .next
8014 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8015 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8016 .cindex "domain literal"
8017 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8018 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8019 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8020 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8021 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8022 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8023 .next
8024 .cindex "@mx_any"
8025 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8026 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8027 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8028 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8029 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8030 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8031 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8032 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8033 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8034 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8035 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8036
8037 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8038 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8039 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8040 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8041 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8042
8043 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8044 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8045 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8046 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8047 on a router). For example:
8048 .code
8049 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8050 .endd
8051 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8052 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8053
8054 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8055 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8056 contain negative items.
8057
8058 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8059 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8060 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8061 .code
8062 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8063 an.other.domain : ...
8064 .endd
8065 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8066 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8067 .code
8068 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8069 an.other.domain ? ...
8070 .endd
8071 .next
8072 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8073 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8074 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8075 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8076 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8077 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8078 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8079 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8080 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8081 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8082
8083 .next
8084 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8085 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8086 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8087 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8088 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8089 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8090 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8091 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8092 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8093
8094 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8095 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8096 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8097 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8098 expression by expansion, of course).
8099 .next
8100 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8101 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8102 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8103 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8104 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8105 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8106 .code
8107 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8108 .endd
8109 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8110 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8111 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8112 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8113 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8114 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8115 other statements in the same ACL.
8116
8117 .next
8118 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8119 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8120 .code
8121 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8122 .endd
8123 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8124 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8125
8126 .next
8127 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8128 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8129 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8130 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8131 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8132 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8133 expansion variable.
8134 .next
8135 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8136 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8137 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8138 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8139 .code
8140 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8141 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8142 .endd
8143 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8144 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8145 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8146 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8147 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8148 .next
8149 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8150 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8151 between the pattern and the domain.
8152 .endlist
8153
8154 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8155 .code
8156 domainlist funny_domains = \
8157 @ : \
8158 lib.unseen.edu : \
8159 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8160 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8161 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8162 nis;domains.byname : \
8163 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8164 .endd
8165 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8166 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8167 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8168 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8169 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8170 patterns earlier.
8171
8172
8173
8174 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8175 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8176 .cindex "list" "host list"
8177 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8178 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8179 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8180 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8181 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8182 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8183 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8184
8185
8186 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8187 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8188 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8189 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8190 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8191 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8192 not used.
8193
8194 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8195 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8196 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8197
8198
8199
8200 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8201 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8202 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8203 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8204 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8205 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8206 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8207 concerns.)
8208
8209 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8210 inspecting its IP address:
8211
8212 .ilist
8213 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8214 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8215 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8216 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8217 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8218 with the IP address of the subject host.
8219
8220 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8221 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8222 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8223 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8224 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8225
8226 .next
8227 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8228 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8229 domain name, as just described.
8230
8231 .next
8232 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8233 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8234 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8235 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8236 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8237 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8238 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8239 that can never match a client host.
8240
8241 .next
8242 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8243 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8244 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8245 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8246 .code
8247 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8248 accept hosts = @[]
8249 .endd
8250 .next
8251 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8252 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8253 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8254 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8255 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8256 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8257 significant end of the address.
8258
8259 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8260 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8261 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8262 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8263 .code
8264 192.168.23.236/31
8265 .endd
8266 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8267 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8268 matches.
8269
8270 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8271 .code
8272 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8273 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8274 .endd
8275 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8276 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8277 For example:
8278 .code
8279 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8280 .endd
8281 could make use of a file containing
8282 .code
8283 172.16.0.0/12
8284 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8285 .endd
8286 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8287 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8288 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8289 .code
8290 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8291 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8292 .endd
8293 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8294 list.
8295 .endlist
8296
8297
8298
8299 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8300 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8301 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8302 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8303 address, the pattern takes this form:
8304 .display
8305 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8306 .endd
8307 For example:
8308 .code
8309 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8310 .endd
8311 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8312 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8313 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8314 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8315 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8316 returned by the lookup is not used.
8317
8318 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8319 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8320 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8321 patterns of this form:
8322 .display
8323 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8324 .endd
8325 For example:
8326 .code
8327 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8328 .endd
8329 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8330 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8331 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8332 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8333 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8334
8335 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8336 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8337 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8338 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8339 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8340 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8341 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8342 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8343 addresses are always used.
8344
8345 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8346 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8347 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8348 configurations.
8349
8350 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8351 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8352 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8353 case the IP address is used on its own.
8354
8355
8356
8357 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8358 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8359 .cindex "unknown host name"
8360 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8361 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8362 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8363 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8364 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8365 above.)
8366
8367 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8368 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8369 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8370 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8371 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8372 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8373 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8374
8375 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8376 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8377
8378 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8379 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8380 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8381 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8382 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8383 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8384 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8385 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8386 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8387
8388 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8389 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8390
8391 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8392 .cindex "alias for host"
8393 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8394 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8395
8396 .ilist
8397 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8398 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8399 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8400 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8401 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8402 expression.
8403 .next
8404 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8405 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8406 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8407 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8408 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8409 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8410 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8411 example,
8412 .code
8413 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8414 .endd
8415 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8416 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8417 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8418 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8419 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8420 .code
8421 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8422 .endd
8423 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8424 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8425 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8426 required.
8427 .endlist
8428
8429
8430
8431
8432 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8433 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8434 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8435 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8436 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8437 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8438
8439 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8440 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8441
8442 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8443 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8444 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8445 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8446 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8447 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8448 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8449 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8450 not recognized in an indirected file).
8451
8452 .ilist
8453 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8454 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8455 .code
8456 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8457 .endd
8458 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8459 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8460
8461 .next
8462 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8463 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8464 example:
8465 .code
8466 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8467 192.168.4.5
8468 .endd
8469 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8470 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8471 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8472 .endlist
8473
8474 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8475 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8476 list.
8477
8478 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8479 "SECTmixwilhos"
8480 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8481
8482 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8483 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8484 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8485
8486 .ilist
8487 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8488 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8489 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8490 .code
8491 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8492 .endd
8493 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8494 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8495 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8496 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8497 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8498 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8499 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8500
8501 .next
8502 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8503 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8504 .code
8505 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8506 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8507 .endd
8508 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8509 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8510 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8511 this section.
8512 .endlist
8513
8514
8515 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8516 "SECTtemdnserr"
8517 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8518 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8519 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8520 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8521 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8522 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8523 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8524 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8525 host lists such as whitelists.
8526
8527
8528
8529 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8530 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8531 .cindex "unknown host name"
8532 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8533 If a pattern is of the form
8534 .display
8535 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8536 .endd
8537 for example
8538 .code
8539 dbm;/host/accept/list
8540 .endd
8541 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8542 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8543 is not used.
8544
8545 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8546 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8547 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8548 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8549 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8550 lookup, both using the same file.
8551
8552
8553
8554 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8555 If a pattern is of the form
8556 .display
8557 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8558 .endd
8559 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8560 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8561 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8562 .code
8563 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8564 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8565 .endd
8566 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8567 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8568 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8569 operator.
8570
8571 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8572 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8573 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8574
8575 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8576 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8577 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8578 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8579 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8580 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8581
8582
8583
8584
8585
8586 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8587 .cindex "list" "address list"
8588 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8589 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8590 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8591 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8592 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8593 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8594 using this option setting:
8595 .code
8596 senders = :
8597 .endd
8598 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8599 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8600 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8601 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8602
8603 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8604 example:
8605 .code
8606 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8607 .endd
8608 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8609 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8610 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8611 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8612 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8613 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8614 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8615 .code
8616 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8617 *@+hostile_domains:\
8618 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8619 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8620 .endd
8621 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8622 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8623 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8624 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8625 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8626
8627 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8628 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8629 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8630 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8631 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8632 .code
8633 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8634 .endd
8635
8636 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8637 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8638 senders:
8639
8640 .ilist
8641 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8642 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8643 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8644 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8645 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8646 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8647 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8648 .code
8649 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8650 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8651 .endd
8652 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8653 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8654
8655 .next
8656 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8657 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8658 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8659 example:
8660 .code
8661 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8662 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8663 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8664 .endd
8665 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8666 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8667 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8668 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8669
8670 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8671 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8672 panic log.
8673 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8674 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8675 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8676 default. For example, with this lookup:
8677 .code
8678 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8679 .endd
8680 the file could contains lines like this:
8681 .code
8682 user1@domain1.example
8683 *@domain2.example
8684 .endd
8685 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8686 that are tried is:
8687 .code
8688 nimrod@jaeger.example
8689 *@jaeger.example
8690 *
8691 .endd
8692 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8693 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8694
8695 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8696 .code
8697 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8698 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8699 .endd
8700 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8701 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8702 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8703 .endlist
8704
8705
8706 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8707 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8708 always fails.
8709
8710
8711 .ilist
8712 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8713 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8714 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8715 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8716 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8717 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8718 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8719 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8720 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8721
8722 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8723 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8724 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8725 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8726 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8727 with
8728 .code
8729 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8730 .endd
8731 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8732 .code
8733 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8734 .endd
8735 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8736
8737 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8738 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8739 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8740 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8741 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8742 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8743 .code
8744 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8745 spammer3 : spammer4
8746 .endd
8747 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8748 doubling.
8749
8750 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8751 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8752 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8753 might have entries like
8754 .code
8755 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8756 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8757 *: ^\d{8}$
8758 .endd
8759 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8760 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8761 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8762 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8763
8764 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8765 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8766 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8767
8768 .next
8769 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8770 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8771 can only return a single list of local parts.
8772 .endlist
8773
8774 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8775 in these two examples:
8776 .code
8777 senders = +my_list
8778 senders = *@+my_list
8779 .endd
8780 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8781 example it is a named domain list.
8782
8783
8784
8785
8786 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8787 .cindex "case of local parts"
8788 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8789 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8790 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8791 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8792 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8793 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8794 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8795 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8796 default.
8797
8798 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8799 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8800 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8801 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8802 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8803 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8804 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8805 case-independent.
8806
8807 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8808 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8809 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8810 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8811 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8812 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8813 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8814 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8815
8816
8817
8818 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8819 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8820 .cindex "local part" "list"
8821 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8822 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8823 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8824 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8825 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8826 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8827 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8828 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8829
8830 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8831 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8832 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8833 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8834 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8835 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8836 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8837 types.
8838 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8839
8840
8841
8842
8843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8845
8846 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8847 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8848 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8849 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8850
8851 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8852 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8853 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8854 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8855 escape character, as described in the following section.
8856
8857 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8858 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8859 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8860 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8861 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8862 reasons.
8863
8864
8865
8866 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8867 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8868 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8869 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8870 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8871 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8872 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8873 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8874
8875 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8876 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8877 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8878 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8879 .code
8880 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8881 .endd
8882 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8883 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8884 string.
8885
8886
8887
8888 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8889 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8890 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8891 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8892 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8893 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8894 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8895 encoding.
8896
8897 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8898 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8899 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8900
8901
8902 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8903 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8904 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8905 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8906 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8907 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8908 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8909 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8910 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8911 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8912 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8913 and &%nhash%&.
8914
8915 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8916 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8917 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8918
8919 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8920 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8921 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8922 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8923 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8924 .code
8925 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8926 .endd
8927 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8928 Exim message identifier. For example:
8929 .code
8930 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8931 .endd
8932 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8933 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8934
8935
8936 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8937 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8938 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8939 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8940 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8941 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8942 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8943 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8944 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8945 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8946 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8947 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8948 being expanded.
8949
8950
8951
8952
8953 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8954 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8955 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8956 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8957 white space is significant.
8958
8959 .vlist
8960 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8961 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8962 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8963 .code
8964 $local_part
8965 ${domain}
8966 .endd
8967 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8968 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8969 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8970 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8971 given, the expansion fails.
8972
8973 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8974 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8975 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8976 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8977 .code
8978 ${lc:$local_part}
8979 .endd
8980 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8981 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8982 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8983 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8984 string easier to understand.
8985
8986 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8987 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8988 expansion item below.
8989
8990
8991 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8992 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8993 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8994 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8995 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8996 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8997 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8998 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8999 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9000 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9001 the result of the expansion.
9002 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9003 the expansion result is an empty string.
9004 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9005
9006
9007 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9008 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9009 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
9010 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9011 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9012 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9013 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9014 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9015 .display
9016 &`version `&
9017 &`serial_number `&
9018 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9019 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9020 &`notbefore `& time
9021 &`notafter `& time
9022 &`sig_algorithm `&
9023 &`signature `&
9024 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9025 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9026 &`crl_uri `& list
9027 .endd
9028 If the field is found,
9029 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9030 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9031 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9032 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9033
9034 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9035 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9036 extracted is used.
9037
9038 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9039
9040 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9041 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9042 not quite
9043 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9044 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9045 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9046 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9047 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9048 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9049 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9050 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9051
9052 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9053 take an optional modifier of "int"
9054 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9055 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9056 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9057
9058 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9059 newline-separated by default,
9060 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9061 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9062 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9063
9064 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9065 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9066 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9067 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9068 if so the element tags are omitted.
9069
9070 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9071
9072 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9073 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9074 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9075 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9076 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9077 .code
9078 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9079 .endd
9080 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9081 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9082 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9083
9084 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9085 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9086 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9087 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9088 must have the following type:
9089 .code
9090 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9091 .endd
9092 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9093 function should return one of the following values:
9094
9095 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9096 into the expanded string that is being built.
9097
9098 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9099 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9100
9101 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9102 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9103
9104 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9105
9106 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9107 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9108 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9109
9110
9111 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9112 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9113 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9114 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9115 removed.
9116 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9117 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9118 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9119
9120 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9121 appear, for example:
9122 .code
9123 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9124 .endd
9125 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9126 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9127
9128 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9129 search failure.
9130 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9131 search success.
9132
9133
9134 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9135 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9136 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9137 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9138 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9139 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9140 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9141 form:
9142 .display
9143 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9144 .endd
9145 .vindex "&$value$&"
9146 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9147 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9148 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9149 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9150 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9151 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9152 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9153 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9154 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9155
9156 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9157 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9158 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9159 yield &"2001"&:
9160 .code
9161 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9162 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9163 .endd
9164 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9165 appear, for example:
9166 .code
9167 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9168 .endd
9169 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9170 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9171
9172
9173 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9174 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9175 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9176 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9177 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9178 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9179 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9180 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9181 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9182 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9183 <&'string3'&> as before.
9184
9185 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9186 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9187 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9188 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9189 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9190 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9191 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9192 provided. For example:
9193 .code
9194 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9195 .endd
9196 yields &"42"&, and
9197 .code
9198 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9199 .endd
9200 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9201 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9202
9203
9204 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9205 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9206 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9207 .vindex "&$item$&"
9208 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9209 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9210 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9211 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9212 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9213 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9214 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9215 .code
9216 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9217 .endd
9218 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9219 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9220
9221
9222 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9223 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9224 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9225 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9226 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9227 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9228
9229 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9230 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9231 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9232 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9233 .code
9234 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9235 .endd
9236 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9237 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9238 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9239 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9240 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9241 .code
9242 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9243 .endd
9244 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9245 letters appear. For example:
9246 .display
9247 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9248 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9249 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9250 .endd
9251
9252 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9253 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9254 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9255 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9256 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9257 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9258 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9259 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9260 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9261 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9262 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9263 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9264 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9265 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9266 .code
9267 $header_reply-to:
9268 .endd
9269 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9270 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9271 lines) may be present.
9272
9273 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9274 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9275
9276 .ilist
9277 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9278 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9279 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9280
9281 .next
9282 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9283 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9284 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9285 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9286 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9287 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9288 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9289 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9290
9291 .next
9292 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9293 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9294 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9295 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9296 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9297 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9298 .endlist ilist
9299
9300 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9301 command of the following form:
9302 .code
9303 headers charset "UTF-8"
9304 .endd
9305 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9306 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9307 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9308 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9309 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9310 ISO-8859-1.
9311
9312 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9313 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9314 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9315 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9316
9317 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9318 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9319 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9320 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9321 router or transport are not accessible.
9322
9323 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9324 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9325 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9326 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9327 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9328 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9329
9330 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9331 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9332 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9333 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9334 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9335 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9336 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9337 header.)
9338
9339 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9340 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9341 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9342 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9343 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9344 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9345 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9346 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9347
9348
9349 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9350 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9351 .cindex &%hmac%&
9352 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9353 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9354 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9355 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9356 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9357 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9358 present. For example:
9359 .code
9360 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9361 .endd
9362 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9363 produces:
9364 .code
9365 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9366 .endd
9367 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9368 an Exim configuration:
9369 .code
9370 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9371 .endd
9372 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9373 .code
9374 headers_add = \
9375 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9376 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9377 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9378 .endd
9379 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9380 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9381 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9382 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9383 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9384 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9385
9386
9387 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9388 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9389 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9390 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9391 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9392 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9393 .code
9394 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9395 .endd
9396 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9397 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9398 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9399 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9400 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9401
9402 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9403 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9404 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9405 .code
9406 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9407 .endd
9408 you can use
9409 .code
9410 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9411 .endd
9412
9413
9414
9415 .new
9416 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9417 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9418 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9419 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9420 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9421 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9422 .wen
9423
9424
9425
9426 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9427 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9428 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9429 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9430 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9431 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9432 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9433 some of the braces:
9434 .code
9435 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9436 .endd
9437 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9438 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9439 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9440
9441
9442 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9443 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9444 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9445 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9446 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9447 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9448 apart from an optional leading minus,
9449 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9450
9451 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9452 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9453
9454 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9455 If the number is negative, the fields are
9456 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9457 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9458 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9459
9460 If the modulus of the
9461 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9462 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9463
9464 For example:
9465 .code
9466 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9467 .endd
9468 yields &"42"&, and
9469 .code
9470 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9471 .endd
9472 yields &"result: 42"&.
9473
9474 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9475 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9476 extracted is used.
9477 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9478
9479
9480 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9481 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9482 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9483 described in the next item.
9484
9485 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9486 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9487 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9488 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9489 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9490 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9491 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9492 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9493 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9494
9495 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9496 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9497 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9498 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9499 out by the system administrator.
9500
9501 .vindex "&$value$&"
9502 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9503 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9504 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9505 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9506 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9507 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9508 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9509 original lookup fails.
9510
9511 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9512 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9513 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9514 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9515 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9516 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9517 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9518 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9519
9520 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9521 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9522 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9523 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9524
9525 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9526 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9527 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9528 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9529
9530 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9531 .code
9532 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9533 .endd
9534 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9535 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9536 .code
9537 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9538 {$value}fail}
9539 .endd
9540
9541
9542 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9543 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9544 .vindex "&$item$&"
9545 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9546 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9547 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9548 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9549 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9550 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9551 .code
9552 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9553 .endd
9554 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9555 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9556 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9557
9558 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9559 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9560 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9561 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9562 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9563 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9564 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9565 .code
9566 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9567 .endd
9568 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9569 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9570 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9571 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9572 example,
9573 .code
9574 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9575 .endd
9576 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9577
9578
9579
9580 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9581 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9582 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9583 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9584 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9585 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9586 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9587 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9588
9589 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9590 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9591 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9592 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9593 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9594 not its contents.
9595
9596 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9597 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9598 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9599
9600 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9601 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9602
9603
9604 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9605 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9606 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9607 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9608 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9609 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9610 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9611 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9612
9613 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9614 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9615 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9616 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9617 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9618 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9619 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9620 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9621 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9622 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9623
9624 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9625 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9626 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9627 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9628
9629 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9630 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9631 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9632 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9633 is the expansion of the third argument.
9634
9635 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9636 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9637 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9638
9639 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9640 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9641 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9642 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9643 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9644 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9645 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9646 newlines are left in the string.
9647 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9648 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9649 the string expansion fails.
9650
9651 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9652 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9653
9654
9655
9656 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9657 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9658 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9659 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9660 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9661 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9662 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9663 examples:
9664 .code
9665 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9666 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9667 .endd
9668 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9669 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9670 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9671 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9672 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9673 example:
9674 .code
9675 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9676 .endd
9677 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9678 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9679 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9680 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9681 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9682 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9683 .code
9684 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9685 .endd
9686 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9687 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9688 turns them into spaces:
9689 .code
9690 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9691 .endd
9692 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9693 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9694 addition, the following errors can occur:
9695
9696 .ilist
9697 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9698 .next
9699 Failure to connect the socket;
9700 .next
9701 Failure to write the request string;
9702 .next
9703 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9704 .endlist
9705
9706 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9707 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9708 errors occurs. For example:
9709 .code
9710 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9711 {socket failure}}
9712 .endd
9713 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9714 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9715 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9716 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9717 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9718
9719 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9720 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9721
9722
9723 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9724 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9725 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9726 .vindex "&$value$&"
9727 .vindex "&$item$&"
9728 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9729 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9730 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9731 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9732 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9733 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9734 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9735 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9736 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9737 .code
9738 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9739 .endd
9740 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9741 can be found:
9742 .code
9743 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9744 .endd
9745 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9746 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9747 expansion items.
9748
9749 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9750 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9751 expansion item above.
9752
9753 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9754 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9755 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9756 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9757 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9758 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9759 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9760 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9761 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9762
9763 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9764 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9765 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9766 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9767 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9768 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9769 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9770 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9771 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9772 character.
9773
9774 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9775 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9776 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9777 .vindex "&$value$&"
9778 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9779 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9780 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9781 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9782 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9783 &$value$&.
9784
9785 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9786 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9787 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9788 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9789
9790 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9791 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9792 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9793 troubleshoot:
9794 .code
9795 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9796 log_message = Output of id: $value
9797 .endd
9798 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9799 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9800 .code
9801 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9802 .endd
9803
9804 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9805 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9806 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9807 .code
9808 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9809 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9810 ...
9811 endif
9812 .endd
9813 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9814 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9815 commands.
9816
9817 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9818 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9819 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9820 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9821
9822 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9823 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9824
9825
9826 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9827 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9828 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9829 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9830 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9831 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9832 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9833 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9834 .code
9835 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9836 .endd
9837 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9838 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9839 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9840 .code
9841 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9842 .endd
9843 yields &"defabc"&, and
9844 .code
9845 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9846 .endd
9847 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9848 the regular expression from string expansion.
9849
9850
9851
9852 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9853 .cindex sorting "a list"
9854 .cindex list sorting
9855 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9856 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9857 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9858 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9859 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9860 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9861 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9862 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9863 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9864 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9865 to give values for comparison.
9866
9867 The item result is a sorted list,
9868 with the original list separator,
9869 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9870
9871 Examples:
9872 .code
9873 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9874 .endd
9875 sorts a list of numbers, and
9876 .code
9877 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9878 .endd
9879 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9880
9881
9882 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9883 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9884 .cindex "substring extraction"
9885 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9886 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9887 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9888 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9889 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9890 .code
9891 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9892 .endd
9893 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9894 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9895 omitted.
9896
9897 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9898 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9899 length required. For example
9900 .code
9901 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9902 .endd
9903 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9904 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9905 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9906 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9907
9908 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9909 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9910 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9911 .code
9912 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9913 .endd
9914 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9915 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9916 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9917 .code
9918 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9919 .endd
9920 yields an empty string, but
9921 .code
9922 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9923 .endd
9924 yields &"1"&.
9925
9926 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9927 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9928 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9929 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9930 .code
9931 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9932 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9933 .endd
9934 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9935
9936
9937
9938 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9939 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9940 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9941 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9942 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9943 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9944 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9945 replacement list. For example
9946 .code
9947 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9948 .endd
9949 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9950 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9951 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9952 place.
9953 .endlist
9954
9955
9956
9957 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9958 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9959 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9960 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9961 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9962 following operations can be performed:
9963
9964 .vlist
9965 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9966 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9967 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9968 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9969 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9970 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9971
9972
9973 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9975 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9976 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9977 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9978 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9979 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9980 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9981 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9982
9983 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9984 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9985 character. For example:
9986 .code
9987 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9988 .endd
9989 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9990 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9991 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9992 processing lists.
9993
9994 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9995 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9996 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9997 email address separator. For the example header line:
9998 .code
9999 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10000 .endd
10001 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10002 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10003 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10004 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10005 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10006 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10007 quoted.
10008 .code
10009 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10010 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10011 user@example.com
10012 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10013 Last:user@example.com
10014 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10015 user@example.com
10016 .endd
10017
10018 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10019 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10020 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10021 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10022 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10023 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10024 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10025 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10026 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10027
10028 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10029 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10030 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10031 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10032 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10033 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10034 string.
10035
10036 .new
10037 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10038 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10039 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10040 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10041 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10042 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10043
10044 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10045 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10046
10047
10048 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10049 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10050 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10051 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10052 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10053 .wen
10054
10055
10056 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10057 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10058 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10059 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10060 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10061
10062
10063 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10064 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10065 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10066 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10067 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10068 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10069 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10070
10071
10072 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10073 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10074 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10075 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10076 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10077 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10078 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10079 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10080 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10081 C programming language):
10082 .table2 70pt 300pt
10083 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10084 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10085 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10086 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10087 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10088 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10089 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10090 .endtable
10091 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10092 space is permitted before or after operators.
10093
10094 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10095 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10096 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10097 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10098 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10099
10100 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10101 or 1024*1024*1024,
10102 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10103 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10104
10105 .display
10106 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10107 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10108 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10109 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10110 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10111 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10112 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10113 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10114 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10115 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10116 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10117 .endd
10118
10119 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10120 .code
10121 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10122 condition = \
10123 ${if and { \
10124 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10125 { \
10126 < \
10127 {$recipients_count} \
10128 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10129 } \
10130 }{yes}{no}}
10131 .endd
10132 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10133 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10134
10135
10136 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10137 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10138 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10139 example,
10140 .code
10141 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10142 .endd
10143 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10144 and then re-expands what it has found.
10145
10146
10147 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10148 .cindex "Unicode"
10149 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10150 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10151 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10152 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10153 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10154 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10155 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10156 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10157 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10158
10159 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10160 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10161 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10162 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10163 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10164 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10165 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10166
10167
10168 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10169 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10170 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10171 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10172 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10173 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10174 .code
10175 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10176 .endd
10177 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10178 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10179
10180
10181
10182 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10183 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10184 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10185 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10186 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10187 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10188
10189
10190
10191 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10192 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10193 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10194 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10195 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10196 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10197 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10198
10199
10200 .new
10201 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10202 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10203 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10204 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10205 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10206 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10207 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10208
10209 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10210 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10211 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10212 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10213 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10214 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10215 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10216 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10217 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10218 .wen
10219
10220
10221 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10222 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10223 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10224 .cindex "lower casing"
10225 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10226 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10227 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10228 .code
10229 ${lc:$local_part}
10230 .endd
10231
10232 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10233 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10234 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10235 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10236 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10237 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10238 .code
10239 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10240 .endd
10241 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10242 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10243 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10244
10245
10246 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10247 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10248 .cindex "list" "item count"
10249 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10250 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10251 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10252
10253
10254 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10255 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10256 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10257 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10258 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10259 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10260 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10261 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10262 matching list is returned.
10263
10264
10265 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10266 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10267 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10268 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10269 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10270 empty.
10271
10272
10273 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10274 .cindex "masked IP address"
10275 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10276 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10277 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10278 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10279 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10280 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10281 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10282 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10283 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10284 .code
10285 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10286 .endd
10287 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10288 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10289 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10290 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10291 .code
10292 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10293 .endd
10294 returns the string
10295 .code
10296 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10297 .endd
10298 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10299
10300
10301 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10302 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10303 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10304 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10305 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10306 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10307 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10308
10309 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10310 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10311
10312
10313 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10314 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10315 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10316 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10317 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10318 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10319 .code
10320 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10321 .endd
10322 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10323
10324
10325 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10326 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10327 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10328 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10329 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10330 is an empty string or
10331 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10332 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10333 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10334 respectively For example,
10335 .code
10336 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10337 .endd
10338 becomes
10339 .code
10340 "ab\"*\"cd"
10341 .endd
10342 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10343 variable or a message header.
10344
10345 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10346 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10347 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10348 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10349 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10350 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10351 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10352
10353
10354 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10355 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10356 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10357 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10358 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10359 .code
10360 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10361 .endd
10362 returns
10363 .code
10364 two%20%5C2A%20two
10365 .endd
10366 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10367 yields an unchanged string.
10368
10369
10370 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10371 .cindex "random number"
10372 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10373 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10374 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10375 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10376 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10377 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10378 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10379 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10380 random().
10381
10382
10383 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10384 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10385 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10386 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10387 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10388 for DNS. For example,
10389 .code
10390 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10391 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10392 .endd
10393 returns
10394 .code
10395 4.2.0.192
10396 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10397 .endd
10398
10399
10400 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10401 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10402 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10403 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10404 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10405 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10406 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10407 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10408 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10409 characters
10410 .code
10411 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10412 .endd
10413 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10414 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10415 characters.
10416
10417
10418 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10419 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10420 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10421 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10422 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10423 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10424 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10425 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10426
10427 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10428 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10429 to use this operator as well.
10430
10431
10432
10433 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10434 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10435 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10436 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10437 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10438 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10439 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10440
10441
10442 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10443 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10444 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10445 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10446 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10447 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10448 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10449
10450 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10451 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10452
10453
10454 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10455 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10456 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10457 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10458 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10459 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10460 certificate,
10461 and returns
10462 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10463 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10464
10465
10466 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10467 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10468 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10469 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10470 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10471 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10472 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10473 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10474 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10475 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10476 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10477 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10478 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10479
10480 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10481 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10482 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10483
10484 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10485 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10486 .new
10487 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10488 .wen
10489
10490
10491
10492 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10493 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10494 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10495 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10496 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10497 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10498
10499
10500 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10501 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10502 .cindex "substring extraction"
10503 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10504 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10505 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10506 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10507 .code
10508 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10509 .endd
10510 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10511 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10512
10513 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10514 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10515 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10516 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10517 seconds.
10518
10519 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10520 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10521 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10522 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10523 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10524 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10525 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10526
10527 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10529 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10530 .cindex "upper casing"
10531 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10532 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10533 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10534
10535 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10536 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10537 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10538 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10539 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10540 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10541 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10542
10543 .new
10544 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10545 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10546 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10547 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10548 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10549 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10550 .cindex EAI
10551 .cindex internationalisation
10552 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10553 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10554 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10555 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10556 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10557 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10558 .wen
10559 .endlist
10560
10561
10562
10563
10564
10565
10566 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10567 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10568 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10569 while expanding strings:
10570
10571 .vlist
10572 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10573 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10574 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10575 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10576 condition.
10577
10578 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10579 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10580 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10581 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10582 are:
10583 .display
10584 &`= `& equal
10585 &`== `& equal
10586 &`> `& greater
10587 &`>= `& greater or equal
10588 &`< `& less
10589 &`<= `& less or equal
10590 .endd
10591 For example:
10592 .code
10593 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10594 .endd
10595 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10596 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10597 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10598 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10599 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10600 zero.
10601
10602 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10603 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10604 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10605
10606
10607 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10608 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10609 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10610 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10611 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10612 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10613 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10614 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10615 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10616 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10617 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10618 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10619 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10620 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10621
10622 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10623 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10624 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10625 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10626 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10627 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10628 false if zero.
10629 An empty string is treated as false.
10630 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10631 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10632 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10633
10634 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10635 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10636 For example:
10637 .code
10638 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10639 .endd
10640
10641
10642 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10643 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10644 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10645 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10646 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10647 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10648 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10649 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10650
10651 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10652
10653 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10655 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10656 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10657 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10658 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10659 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10660 included in the binary.
10661
10662 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10663 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10664 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10665 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10666 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10667 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10668 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10669 string in LDAP form is:
10670 .code
10671 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10672 .endd
10673 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10674 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10675 .code
10676 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10677 .endd
10678 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10679 supported:
10680
10681 .ilist
10682 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10683 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10684 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10685 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10686 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10687 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10688 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10689 comparison fails.
10690
10691 .next
10692 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10693 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10694 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10695 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10696 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10697 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10698
10699 .next
10700 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10701 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10702 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10703 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10704 whatever its length.
10705
10706 .next
10707 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10708 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10709 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10710 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10711 .endlist
10712 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10713 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10714 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10715 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10716 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10717 support &[crypt16()]&.
10718
10719 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10720 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10721 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10722 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10723 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10724
10725 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10726 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10727 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10728
10729 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10730 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10731 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10732 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10733 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10734
10735 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10736 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10737 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10738 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10739 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10740 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10741 .code
10742 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10743 .endd
10744 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10745 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10746
10747 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10748 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10749 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10750 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10751 exists in the message. For example,
10752 .code
10753 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10754 .endd
10755 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10756 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10757
10758 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10759 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10760 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10761 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10762 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10763 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10764 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10765 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10766 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10767
10768 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10769 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10770 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10771 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10772 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10773 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10774 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10775 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10776
10777 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10778 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10779 .cindex "first delivery"
10780 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10781 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10782 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10783 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10784
10785
10786 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10787 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10788 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10789 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10790 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10791 .vindex "&$item$&"
10792 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10793 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10794 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10795 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10796 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10797 .ilist
10798 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10799 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10800 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10801 .next
10802 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10803 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10804 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10805 .endlist
10806 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10807 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10808 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10809 list separator is changed to a comma:
10810 .code
10811 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10812 .endd
10813 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10814 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10815
10816 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10817
10818
10819 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10820 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10821 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10822 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10823 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10824 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10825 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10826 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10827 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10828 case-independent.
10829
10830 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10831 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10832 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10833 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10834 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10835 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10836 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10837 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10838 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10839 case-independent.
10840
10841 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10842 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10843 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10844 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10845 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10846 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10847 is true.
10848
10849 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10850 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10851 .code
10852 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10853 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10854 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10855 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10856 .endd
10857
10858 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10859 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10860 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10861 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10862 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10863 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10864 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10865 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10866 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10867 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10868 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10869
10870 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10871 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10872 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10873 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10874 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10875
10876 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10877 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10878 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10879 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10880 .code
10881 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10882 .endd
10883 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10884
10885 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10886 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10887 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10888 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10889 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10890 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10891 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10892 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10893 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10894 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10895 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10896 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10897 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10898 this can be used.
10899
10900
10901 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10902 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10903 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10904 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10905 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10906 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10907 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10908 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10909 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10910 case-independent.
10911
10912 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10913 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10914 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10915 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10916 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10917 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10918 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10919 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10920 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10921 case-independent.
10922
10923
10924 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10925 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10926 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10927 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10928 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10929 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10930 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10931 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10932 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10933 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10934 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10935 For example,
10936 .code
10937 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10938 .endd
10939 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10940 backslashes is also required.
10941
10942 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10943 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10944 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10945 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10946 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10947 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10948
10949 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10950 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10951 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10952 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10953 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10954 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10955 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10956 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10957
10958 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10959 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10960 See &*match_local_part*&.
10961
10962 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10963 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10964 See &*match_local_part*&.
10965
10966 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10967 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10968 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10969 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10970 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10971 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10972 .code
10973 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10974 .endd
10975 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10976
10977 .ilist
10978 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10979 .next
10980 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10981 .next
10982 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10983 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10984 in a single test such as
10985 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10986 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10987 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10988 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10989 .code
10990 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10991 .endd
10992 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10993 .next
10994 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10995 .next
10996 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10997 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10998 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10999 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11000 masks. For example:
11001 .code
11002 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11003 .endd
11004 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11005 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11006 address mask, for example:
11007 .code
11008 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11009 .endd
11010 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11011 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11012 .code
11013 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11014 .endd
11015 .endlist ilist
11016
11017 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11018 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11019
11020 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11021
11022 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11023 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11024 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11025 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11026 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11027 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11028 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11029 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11030 example is:
11031 .code
11032 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11033 .endd
11034 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11035 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
11036 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11037 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11038 .code
11039 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11040 .endd
11041 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11042 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11043 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11044 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11045 caselessly.
11046
11047 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11048 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11049
11050 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11051 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11052 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11053 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11054
11055 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11056 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11057 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11058 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11059 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11060 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11061 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11062 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11063 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11064 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11065 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11066 .code
11067 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11068 .endd
11069 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11070 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11071
11072 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11073 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11074 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11075 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11076 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11077 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11078 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11079
11080 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11081 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11082 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11083 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11084 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11085 .code
11086 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11087 .endd
11088 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11089 .code
11090 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11091 .endd
11092 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11093 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11094 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11095 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
11096 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
11097 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
11098 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
11099 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
11100
11101
11102 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11103 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11104 .cindex "Cyrus"
11105 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11106 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11107 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11108 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11109 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11110 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11111
11112 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11113 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11114 building Exim. For example:
11115 .code
11116 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11117 .endd
11118 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11119 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11120 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11121 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11122
11123 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11124 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11125 configuration, you might have this:
11126 .code
11127 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11128 .endd
11129 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11130 .code
11131 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11132 .endd
11133 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11134 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11135 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11136 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11137 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11138 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11139
11140
11141 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11142 .cindex "Radius"
11143 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11144 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11145 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11146 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11147 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11148 support.
11149
11150 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11151 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11152 this library, you need to set
11153 .code
11154 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11155 .endd
11156 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11157 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11158 .code
11159 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11160 .endd
11161 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11162 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11163 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11164
11165 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11166 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11167 the authentication is successful. For example:
11168 .code
11169 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11170 .endd
11171
11172
11173 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11174 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11175 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11176 .cindex "Cyrus"
11177 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11178 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11179 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11180 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11181 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11182 by a process that is not running as root.
11183
11184 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11185 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11186 building Exim. For example:
11187 .code
11188 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11189 .endd
11190 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11191 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11192 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11193
11194 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11195 two are mandatory. For example:
11196 .code
11197 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11198 .endd
11199 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11200 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11201 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11202 .endlist vlist
11203
11204
11205
11206 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11207 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11208 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11209 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11210 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11211 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11212 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11213
11214
11215 .vlist
11216 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11217 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11218 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11219 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11220 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11221 For example,
11222 .code
11223 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11224 .endd
11225 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11226 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11227 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11228
11229 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11230 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11231 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11232 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11233 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11234 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11235 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11236 parsed but not evaluated.
11237 .endlist
11238 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11239
11240
11241
11242
11243 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11244 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11245 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11246 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11247 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11248
11249 .vlist
11250 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11251 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11252 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11253 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11254 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11255 In the expansion condition case
11256 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11257 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11258 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11259 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11260 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11261 matching condition.
11262
11263 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11264 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11265 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11266 any unused variables being made empty.
11267
11268 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11269 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11270 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11271 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11272 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11273 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11274 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11275 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11276 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11277 during subsequent delivery.
11278
11279 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11280 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11281 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11282 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11283 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11284 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11285 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11286 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11287 delivery.
11288
11289 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11290 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11291 this variable has the number of arguments.
11292
11293 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11294 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11295 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11296 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11297 be preserved by coding like this:
11298 .code
11299 warn !verify = sender
11300 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11301 .endd
11302 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11303 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11304 failure.
11305
11306 .vitem &$address_data$&
11307 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11308 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11309 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11310 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11311 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11312 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11313 user filter files.
11314
11315 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11316 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11317 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11318 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11319 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11320 from the child's routing.
11321
11322 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11323 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11324 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11325 address.
11326
11327 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11328 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11329 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11330
11331 .vitem &$address_file$&
11332 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11333 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11334 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11335 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11336 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11337 .code
11338 /home/r2d2/savemail
11339 .endd
11340 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11341 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11342 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11343 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11344 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11345 to the relevant file.
11346
11347 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11348 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11349 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11350 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11351
11352 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11353 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11354 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11355 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11356
11357 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11358 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11359 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11360 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11361 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11362 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11363 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11364 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11365 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11366 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11367 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11368 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11369 command line option.
11370
11371 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11372 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11373 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11374 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11375 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11376 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11377 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11378 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11379 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11380 the ACL's as well.
11381
11382
11383 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11384 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11385 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11386 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11387 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11388 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11389 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11390 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11391 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11392 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11393 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11394
11395 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11396 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11397 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11398 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11399 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11400
11401
11402 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11403 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11404 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11405 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11406 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11407 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11408 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11409 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11410 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11411 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11412 an undefined mechanism.
11413
11414 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11415 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11416 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11417 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11418 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11419 the ACL malware condition.
11420
11421 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11422 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11423 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11424 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11425 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11426 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11427
11428 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11429 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11430 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11431 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11432 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11433 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11434 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11435
11436 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11437 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11438 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11439 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11440 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11441
11442 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11443 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11444 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11445 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11446 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11447
11448 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11449 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11450 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11451 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11452 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11453 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11454 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11455
11456 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11457 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11458 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11459 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11460 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11461 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11462 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11463
11464 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11465 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11466 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11467 address that was connected to.
11468
11469 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11470 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11471 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11472 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11473 compilations of the same version of the program.
11474
11475 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11476 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11477 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11478 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11479 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11480 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11481
11482 .vitem &$config_file$&
11483 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11484 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11485
11486 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11487 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11488 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11489 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11490 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11491
11492 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11493 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11494 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11495 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11496 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11497
11498 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11499 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11500 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11501 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11502 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11503 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11504 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11505 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11506 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11507 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11508 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11509 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11510 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11511 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11512 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11513 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11514 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11515 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11516 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11517 &$dkim_key_length$&
11518 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11519 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11520
11521 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11522 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11523 When a message has been received this variable contains
11524 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11525 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11526
11527 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11528 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11529 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11530 &$dnslist_value$&
11531 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11532 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11533 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11534 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11535 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11536 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11537 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11538 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11539 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11540
11541 .vitem &$domain$&
11542 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11543 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11544 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11545 case for &$domain$&.
11546
11547 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11548 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11549 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11550 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11551
11552 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11553 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11554 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11555 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11556 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11557 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11558
11559 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11560 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11561 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11562
11563 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11564
11565 .ilist
11566 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11567 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11568 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11569 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11570 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11571 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11572 the &(smtp)& transport.
11573
11574 .next
11575 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11576 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11577 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11578 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11579
11580 .next
11581 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11582 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11583 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11584 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11585 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11586 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11587
11588 .next
11589 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11590 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11591 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11592 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11593 .endlist
11594
11595
11596 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11597 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11598 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11599 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11600 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11601 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11602 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11603 used.
11604
11605 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11606 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11607 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11608 to nothing.
11609
11610 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11611 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11612 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11613
11614 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11615 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11616 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11617
11618 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11619 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11620 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11621
11622 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11623 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11624 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11625 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11626 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11627 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11628
11629 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11630 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11631 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11632 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11633 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11634
11635 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11636 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11637 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11638 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11639 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11640
11641 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11642 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11643 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11644 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11645 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11646
11647 .vitem &$home$&
11648 .vindex "&$home$&"
11649 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11650 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11651 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11652 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11653 by a setting on the transport itself.
11654
11655 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11656 of the environment variable HOME.
11657
11658 .vitem &$host$&
11659 .vindex "&$host$&"
11660 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11661 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11662 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11663 to local and remote transports.
11664
11665 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11666 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11667 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11668 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11669 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11670 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11671 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11672 is connected.
11673
11674 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11675 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11676 client is connected.
11677
11678
11679 .vitem &$host_address$&
11680 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11681 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11682 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11683 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11684
11685 .vitem &$host_data$&
11686 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11687 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11688 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11689 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11690 .code
11691 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11692 message = $host_data
11693 .endd
11694 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11695 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11696 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11697 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11698 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11699 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11700 variables is set to &"1"&.
11701
11702 .ilist
11703 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11704 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11705
11706 .next
11707 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11708 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11709 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11710 .endlist ilist
11711
11712 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11713 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11714 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11715 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11716 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11717 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11718 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11719 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11720 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11721 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11722
11723 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11724 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11725 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11726
11727 .vitem &$host_port$&
11728 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11729 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11730 for an outbound connection.
11731
11732
11733 .vitem &$inode$&
11734 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11735 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11736 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11737 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11738 a unique name for the file.
11739
11740 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11741 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11742 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11743
11744 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11745 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11746 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11747
11748 .vitem &$item$&
11749 .vindex "&$item$&"
11750 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11751 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11752 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11753 empty.
11754
11755 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11756 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11757 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11758 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11759 lookup.
11760
11761 .vitem &$load_average$&
11762 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11763 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11764 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11765 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11766
11767 .vitem &$local_part$&
11768 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11769 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11770 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11771 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11772 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11773
11774 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11775 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11776 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11777 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11778 once.
11779
11780 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11781 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11782 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11783 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11784 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11785 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11786
11787 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11788 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11789 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11790 &$address_pipe$&).
11791
11792 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11793 local part of the recipient address.
11794
11795 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11796 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11797 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11798
11799 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11800 the addresses
11801 .code
11802 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11803 abc\:xyz@test.example
11804 .endd
11805 the value of &$local_part$& is
11806 .code
11807 abc:xyz
11808 .endd
11809 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11810 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11811 have:
11812 .code
11813 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11814 .endd
11815 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11816 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11817 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11818
11819 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11820 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11821 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11822 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11823 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11824 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11825 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11826
11827 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11828 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11829 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11830 variable expands to nothing.
11831
11832 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11833 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11834 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11835 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11836 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11837
11838 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11839 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11840 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11841 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11842 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11843
11844 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11845 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11846 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11847 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11848
11849 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11850 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11851 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11852
11853 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11854 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11855 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11856 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11857 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11858 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11859 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11860 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11861
11862 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11863 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11864 This contains the expanded value of the
11865 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11866 been read.
11867
11868 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11869 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11870 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11871 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11872 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11873 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11874
11875 .vitem &$log_space$&
11876 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11877 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11878 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11879 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11880 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11881 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11882
11883
11884 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11885 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11886 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11887 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11888 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11889 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11890 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11891 and &"yes"& if it was.
11892 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11893 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11894 as authenticated data.
11895
11896 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11897 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11898 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11899 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11900 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11901 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11902 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11903 variable is empty.
11904
11905 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11906 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11907 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11908 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11909 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11910
11911 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11912 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11913 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11914 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11915 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11916 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11917 character(s).
11918
11919 .vitem &$message_age$&
11920 .cindex "message" "age of"
11921 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11922 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11923 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11924 delivery attempt.
11925
11926 .vitem &$message_body$&
11927 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11928 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11929 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11930 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11931 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11932 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11933 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11934 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11935 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11936
11937 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11938 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11939 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11940 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11941 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11942
11943 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11944 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11945 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11946 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11947 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11948 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11949 &$message_body$&.
11950
11951 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11952 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11953 .cindex "message body" "size"
11954 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11955 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11956 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11957 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11958 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11959
11960 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11961 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11962 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11963 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11964 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11965 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11966 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11967 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11968
11969 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11970 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11971 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11972 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11973 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11974 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11975
11976 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11977 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11978 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11979 contents of header lines is done.
11980
11981 .vitem &$message_id$&
11982 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11983
11984 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11985 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11986 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11987 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11988 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11989 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11990 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11991 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11992 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11993 from the body is not counted.
11994
11995 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11996 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11997 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11998 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11999 header and the body).
12000
12001 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12002 .code
12003 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12004 condition = \
12005 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12006 .endd
12007 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12008 message has not yet been received.
12009
12010 .vitem &$message_size$&
12011 .cindex "size" "of message"
12012 .cindex "message" "size"
12013 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12014 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12015 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12016 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12017 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12018 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12019 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12020 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12021 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12022
12023 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12024 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12025 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12026 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12027
12028 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12029 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12030 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12031 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12032
12033 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12034 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12035 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12036
12037 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12038 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12039 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12040 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12041 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12042 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12043 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12044 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12045 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12046 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12047
12048 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12049 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12050 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12051
12052 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12053 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12054 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12055 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12056 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12057 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12058 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12059 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12060 the original address.
12061
12062 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12063 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12064 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12065 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12066 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12067
12068 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12069 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12070 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12071
12072 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12073 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12074 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12075 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12076 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12077 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12078 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12079 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12080 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12081
12082 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12083 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12084 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12085 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12086 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
12087 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12088 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12089 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12090 user.
12091
12092 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12093 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12094 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12095 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12096
12097 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12098 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12099 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12100 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12101
12102 .vitem &$pid$&
12103 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12104 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12105 This variable contains the current process id.
12106
12107 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12108 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12109 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12110 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12111 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12112 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12113 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12114 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12115 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12116 variable"& error if encountered.
12117
12118 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12119 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12120 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12121 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12122 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12123 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12124 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12125
12126
12127 .new
12128 .vitem &$proxy_host_address$& &&&
12129 &$proxy_host_port$& &&&
12130 &$proxy_target_address$& &&&
12131 &$proxy_target_port$& &&&
12132 &$proxy_session$&
12133 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12134 or Socks5 support
12135 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12136 .wen
12137
12138 .new
12139 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12140 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12141 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12142 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12143 .wen
12144
12145 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12146 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12147 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12148 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12149
12150 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12151 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12152 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12153 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12154
12155 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12156 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12157 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12158 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12159
12160 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12161 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12162 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12163
12164 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12165 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12166 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12167 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12168
12169 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12170 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12171 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12172 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12173 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12174
12175 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12176 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12177 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12178 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12179 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12180 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12181
12182 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12183 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12184 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12185 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12186 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12187
12188 .vitem &$received_count$&
12189 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12190 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12191 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12192 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12193 delivering.
12194
12195 .vitem &$received_for$&
12196 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12197 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12198 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12199 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12200 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12201
12202 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12203 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12204 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12205 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12206 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12207 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12208 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12209 option.
12210
12211 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12212 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12213 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12214 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12215 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12216 time.
12217 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12218
12219 .vitem &$received_port$&
12220 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12221 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12222
12223 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12224 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12225 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12226 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12227 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12228 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12229 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12230 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12231 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12232
12233 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12234 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12235 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12236 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12237 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12238 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12239
12240 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12241 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12242 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12243
12244 .vitem &$received_time$&
12245 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12246 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12247 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12248
12249 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12250 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12251 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12252 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12253 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12254 .display
12255 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12256 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12257 .endd
12258 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12259 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12260 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12261 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12262
12263 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12264 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12265 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12266 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12267
12268 .ilist
12269 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12270 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12271
12272 .next
12273 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12274
12275 .next
12276 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12277 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12278 MAIL).
12279
12280 .next
12281 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12282 .next
12283
12284 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12285 .endlist
12286
12287 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12288 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12289
12290 .vitem &$recipients$&
12291 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12292 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12293 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12294 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12295 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12296 cases:
12297
12298 .olist
12299 In a system filter file.
12300 .next
12301 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12302 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12303 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12304 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12305 .next
12306 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12307 .endlist
12308
12309
12310 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12311 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12312 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12313 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12314 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12315 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12316
12317
12318 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12319 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12320 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12321 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12322
12323 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12324 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12325 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12326 these variables contain the
12327 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12328
12329
12330 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12331 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12332 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12333 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12334 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12335 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12336 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12337
12338 .vitem &$return_path$&
12339 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12340 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12341 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12342 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12343 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12344 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12345 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12346 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12347 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12348 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12349 envelope sender.
12350
12351 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12352 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12353 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12354
12355 .vitem &$router_name$&
12356 .cindex "router" "name"
12357 .cindex "name" "of router"
12358 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12359 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12360
12361 .vitem &$runrc$&
12362 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12363 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12364 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12365 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12366 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12367 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12368 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12369 another.
12370
12371 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12372 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12373 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12374 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12375 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12376 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12377 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12378 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12379
12380 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12381 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12382 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12383 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12384 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12385 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12386
12387 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12388 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12389 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12390 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12391 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12392 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12393 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12394 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12395
12396 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12397 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12398 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12399
12400 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12401 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12402 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12403
12404 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12405 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12406 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12407 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12408 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12409 this:
12410 .display
12411 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12412 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12413 .endd
12414 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12415 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12416 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12417 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12418
12419 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12420 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12421 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12422 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12423 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12424 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12425 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12426 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12427 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12428 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12429 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12430 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12431 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12432
12433 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12434 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12435 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12436 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12437 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12438
12439 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12440 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12441 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12442 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12443 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12444 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12445
12446 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12447 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12448 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12449 this variable contains that
12450 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12451
12452 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12453 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12454 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12455 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12456 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12457 &$authenticated_id$&.
12458
12459 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12460 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12461 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12462 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12463 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12464 resolver library states that both
12465 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12466 other times, this variable is false.
12467
12468 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12469 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12470 library, by setting:
12471 .code
12472 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12473 .endd
12474
12475 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12476 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12477
12478 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12479 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12480
12481
12482 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12483 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12484 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12485 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12486 other means, this variable is empty.
12487
12488 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12489 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12490 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12491 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12492 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12493 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12494 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12495
12496 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12497 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12498 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12499 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12500
12501 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12502 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12503 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12504 is set to &"1"&.
12505
12506 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12507 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12508 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12509 following are true:
12510
12511 .ilist
12512 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12513 .next
12514 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12515 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12516 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12517 .next
12518 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12519 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12520 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12521 .next
12522 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12523 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12524 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12525 .next
12526 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12527 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12528 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12529 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12530 .code
12531 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12532 .endd
12533 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12534 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12535 .endlist
12536
12537
12538 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12539 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12540 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12541 number that was used on the remote host.
12542
12543 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12544 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12545 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12546 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12547 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12548 called Exim.
12549
12550 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12551 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12552 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12553 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12554
12555 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12556 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12557 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12558 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12559 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12560 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12561 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12562 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12563 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12564 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12565 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12566 the parentheses.
12567
12568 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12569 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12570 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12571 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12572 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12573
12574 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12575 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12576 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12577 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12578 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12579
12580 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12581 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12582 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12583 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12584 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12585 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12586 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12587
12588 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12589 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12590 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12591 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12592 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12593
12594 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12595 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12596 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12597 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12598 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12599 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12600
12601 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12602 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12603 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12604 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12605 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12606 .code
12607 MAIL FROM:<>
12608 MAIL FROM: <>
12609 .endd
12610 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12611 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12612 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12613 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12614
12615 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12616 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12617 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12618 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12619 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12620 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12621 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12622
12623 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12624 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12625 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12626 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12627 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12628 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12629 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12630 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12631 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12632 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12633 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12634
12635 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12636 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12637 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12638 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12639 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12640 message is junk mail.
12641
12642 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12643 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12644 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12645 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12646
12647
12648 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12649 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12650 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12651
12652 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12653 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12654 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12655 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12656 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12657 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12658
12659 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12660 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12661 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12662 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12663 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12664 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12665 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12666 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12667 .code
12668 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12669 .endd
12670 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12671
12672
12673 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12674 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12675 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12676 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12677 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12678 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12679
12680 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12681 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12682 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12683 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12684 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12685 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12686 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12687 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12688
12689 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12690 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12691 the outbound.
12692
12693 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12694 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12695 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12696 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12697 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12698 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12699
12700 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12701 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12702 .cindex certificate veriables
12703 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12704 inbound connection when the message was received.
12705 It is only useful as the argument of a
12706 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12707 or a &%def%& condition.
12708
12709 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12710 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12711 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12712 inbound connection when the message was received.
12713 It is only useful as the argument of a
12714 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12715 or a &%def%& condition.
12716 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12717 which is not the leaf.
12718
12719 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12720 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12721 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12722 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12723 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12724 or a &%def%& condition.
12725
12726 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12727 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12728 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12729 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12730 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12731 or a &%def%& condition.
12732 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12733 which is not the leaf.
12734
12735 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12736 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12737 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12738 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12739
12740 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12741 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12742 the outbound.
12743
12744 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12745 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12746 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12747 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12748 and &"0"& otherwise.
12749
12750 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12751 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12752 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12753 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12754 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12755 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12756 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12757 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12758 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12759
12760 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12761 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12762 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12763
12764 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12765 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12766 This variable is
12767 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12768 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12769 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12770 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12771
12772 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12773 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12774 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12775 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12776 .code
12777 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12778 1 No response to request
12779 2 Response not verified
12780 3 Verification failed
12781 4 Verification succeeded
12782 .endd
12783
12784 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12785 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12786 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12787 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12788 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12789
12790 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12791 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12792 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12793 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
12794 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12795 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12796 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12797 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12798 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12799 which is not the leaf.
12800
12801 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12802 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12803 the outbound.
12804
12805 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12806 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12807 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12808 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12809 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12810 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12811 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12812 which is not the leaf.
12813
12814 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12815 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12816 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12817 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12818 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12819 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12820 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12821 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12822 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12823 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12824 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12825
12826 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12827 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12828 the outbound.
12829
12830 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12831 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12832 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12833 During outbound
12834 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12835 the transport.
12836
12837 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12838 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12839 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12840 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12841
12842 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12843 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12844 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12845
12846 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12847 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12848 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12849
12850 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12851 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12852 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12853 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12854 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12855 values for those that are behind (west).
12856
12857 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12858 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12859 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12860 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12861
12862 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12863 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12864 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12865 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12866 flag.
12867
12868 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12869 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12870 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12871 -0500.
12872
12873 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12874 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12875 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12876 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12877
12878 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12879 .cindex "transport" "name"
12880 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12881 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12882 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12883
12884 .vitem &$value$&
12885 .vindex "&$value$&"
12886 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12887 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12888 &*reduce*& expansion.
12889
12890 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12891 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12892 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12893 or for cutthrough delivery,
12894 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12895 Otherwise, empty.
12896
12897 .vitem &$version_number$&
12898 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12899 The version number of Exim.
12900
12901 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12902 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12903 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12904 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12905
12906 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12907 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12908 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12909 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12910 .endlist
12911 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12912
12913
12914
12915 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12917
12918 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12919 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12920 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12921 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12922 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12923 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12924 the line
12925 .code
12926 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12927 .endd
12928 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12929
12930
12931 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12932 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12933 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12934 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12935 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12936 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12937 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12938 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12939 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12940
12941 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12942 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12943 should usually be something like
12944 .code
12945 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12946 .endd
12947 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12948 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12949 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12950 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12951 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12952 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12953 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12954 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12955 two ways:
12956
12957 .ilist
12958 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12959 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12960 a startup when Exim is entered.
12961 .next
12962 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12963 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12964 .endlist
12965
12966 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12967 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12968
12969
12970 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12971 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12972 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12973 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12974 forms:
12975 .code
12976 ${perl{foo}}
12977 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12978 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12979 .endd
12980 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12981 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12982 with an error message of the form
12983 .code
12984 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12985 .endd
12986 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12987 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12988 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12989 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12990 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12991 that was passed to &%die%&.
12992
12993
12994 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12995 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12996 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12997 the Perl code
12998 .code
12999 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13000 .endd
13001 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13002 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13003 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13004
13005 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13006 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13007 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13008 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13009
13010 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13011 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13012 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13013 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13014 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13015 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13016 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13017
13018
13019 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13020 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13021 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13022 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13023 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13024 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13025 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13026 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13027 avoided, but the output is lost.
13028
13029 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13030 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13031 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13032 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13033 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13034 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13035 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13036 .code
13037 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13038 .endd
13039 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13040 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13041 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13042 as the first subroutine argument.
13043 .ecindex IIDperl
13044
13045
13046 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13048
13049 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13050 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13051 "Starting the daemon"
13052 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13053 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13054 .cindex "network interface"
13055 .cindex "interface" "network"
13056 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13057 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13058 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13059 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13060 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13061 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13062 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13063 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13064 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13065 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13066 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13067
13068 .olist
13069 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13070 and ports to listen on.
13071 .next
13072 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13073 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13074 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13075 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13076 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13077 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13078 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13079 as an error situation.
13080 .next
13081 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13082 for the outgoing connection.
13083 .endlist
13084
13085
13086 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13087 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13088 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13089 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13090 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13091
13092 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13093 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13094 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13095 chapter describes how they operate.
13096
13097 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13098 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13099
13100
13101
13102 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13103 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13104 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13105 following options:
13106
13107 .ilist
13108 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13109 or service names.
13110 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13111 .next
13112 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13113 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13114 .endlist
13115
13116 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13117 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13118 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13119 colons. For example:
13120 .code
13121 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13122 192.168.23.65 ; \
13123 ::1 ; \
13124 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13125 .endd
13126 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13127 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13128
13129 .olist
13130 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13131 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13132 .code
13133 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13134 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13135 .endd
13136 .next
13137 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13138 with a colon separator, for example:
13139 .code
13140 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13141 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13142 .endd
13143 .endlist
13144
13145 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13146 default setting contains just one port:
13147 .code
13148 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13149 .endd
13150 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13151 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13152 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13153 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13154 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13155
13156
13157
13158 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13159 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13160 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13161 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13162 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13163 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13164 .code
13165 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13166 .endd
13167 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13168 .code
13169 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13170 .endd
13171 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13172
13173
13174
13175 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13176 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13177 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13178 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13179 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13180 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13181 exim.
13182
13183 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13184 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13185 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13186 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13187 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13188 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13189 .code
13190 -oX 1225
13191 .endd
13192 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13193 whereas
13194 .code
13195 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13196 .endd
13197 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13198 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13199 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13200
13201
13202
13203 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13204 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13205 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13206 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13207 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13208 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13209 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13210 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13211 list of port numbers or service names,
13212 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13213 common use of this option is expected to be
13214 .code
13215 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13216 .endd
13217 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13218 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13219 this way when a daemon is started.
13220
13221 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13222 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13223 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13224 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13225 connections via the daemon.)
13226
13227
13228
13229
13230 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13231 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13232 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13233 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13234 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13235 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13236 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13237 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13238 .code
13239 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13240 .endd
13241 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13242 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13243 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13244 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13245 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13246 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13247 .code
13248 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13249 .endd
13250 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13251 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13252 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13253 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13254 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13255
13256 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13257 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13258 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13259 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13260 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13261 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13262 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13263 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13264 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13265 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13266 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13267 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13268
13269 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13270 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13271 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13272 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13273 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13274
13275
13276
13277 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13278 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13279 .code
13280 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13281 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13282 .endd
13283 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13284 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13285 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13286 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13287
13288 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13289 .code
13290 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13291 .endd
13292 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13293 .code
13294 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13295 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13296 .endd
13297 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13298 IPv4 loopback address only:
13299 .code
13300 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13301 .endd
13302 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13303 .code
13304 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13305 .endd
13306 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13307
13308
13309
13310 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13311 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13312 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13313 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13314 treated as local.
13315
13316 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13317 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13318 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13319 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13320
13321 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13322 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13323 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13324 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13325 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13326 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13327 used for listening. Consider this example:
13328 .code
13329 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13330 192.168.53.235 ; \
13331 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13332
13333 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13334 .endd
13335 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13336 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13337 Exim is routing.
13338
13339 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13340 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13341 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13342 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13343 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13344 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13345 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13346 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13347
13348
13349
13350 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13351 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13352 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13353 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13354 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13355 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13356 details.
13357
13358
13359
13360
13361 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13362 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13363
13364 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13365 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13366 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13367 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13368
13369 .ilist
13370 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13371 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13372 .next
13373 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13374 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13375 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13376 .next
13377 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13378 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13379 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13380 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13381 settings.
13382 .endlist
13383
13384 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13385 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13386 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13387 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13388 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13389 listed in more than one group.
13390
13391 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13392 .table2
13393 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13394 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13395 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13396 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13397 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13398 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13399 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13400 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13401 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13402 .endtable
13403
13404
13405 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13406 .table2
13407 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13408 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13409 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13410 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13411 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13412 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13413 .endtable
13414
13415
13416
13417 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13418 .table2
13419 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13420 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13421 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13422 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13423 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13424 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13425 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13426 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13427 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13428 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13429 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13430 .endtable
13431
13432
13433
13434 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13435 .table2
13436 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13437 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13438 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13439 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13440 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13441 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13442 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13443 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13444 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13445 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13446 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13447 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13448 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13449 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13450 .endtable
13451
13452
13453
13454 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13455 .table2
13456 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13457 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13458 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13459 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13460 .endtable
13461
13462
13463
13464 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13465 .table2
13466 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13467 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13468 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13469 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13470 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13471 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13472 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13473 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13474 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13475 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13476 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13477 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13478 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13479 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13480 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13481 .endtable
13482
13483
13484
13485 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13486 .table2
13487 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13488 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13489 .endtable
13490
13491
13492
13493 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13494 .table2
13495 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13496 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13497 .endtable
13498
13499
13500
13501 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13502 .table2
13503 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13504 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13505 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13506 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13507 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13508 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13509 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13510 .endtable
13511
13512
13513
13514 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13515 .table2
13516 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13517 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13518 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13519 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13520 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13521 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13522 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13523 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13524 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13525 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13526 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13527 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13528 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13529 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13530 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13531 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13532 connection"
13533 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13534 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13535 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13536 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13537 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13538 .endtable
13539
13540
13541
13542 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13543 .table2
13544 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13545 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13546 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13547 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13548 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13549 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13550 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13551 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13552 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13553 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13554 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13555 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13556 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13557 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13558 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13559 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13560 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13561 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13562 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13563 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13564 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13565 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13566 words""&"
13567 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13568 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13569 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13570 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13571 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13572 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13573 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13574 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13575 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13576 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13577 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13578 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13579 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13580 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13581 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13582 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13583 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13584 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13585 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13586 .endtable
13587
13588
13589
13590 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13591 .table2
13592 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13593 item"
13594 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13595 item"
13596 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13597 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13598 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13599 .endtable
13600
13601
13602
13603 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13604 .table2
13605 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13606 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13607 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13608 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13609 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13610 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13611 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13612 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13613 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13614 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13615 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13616 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13617 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13618 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13619 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13620 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13621 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13622 .endtable
13623
13624
13625
13626 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13627 .table2
13628 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13629 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13630 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13631 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13632 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13633 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13634 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13635 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13636 .endtable
13637
13638
13639
13640 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13641 .table2
13642 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13643 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13644 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13645 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13646 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13647 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13648 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13649 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13650 .endtable
13651
13652
13653
13654
13655 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13656 .table2
13657 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13658 .endtable
13659
13660
13661
13662
13663
13664 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13665 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13666
13667 .table2
13668 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13669 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13670 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13671 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13672 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13673 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13674 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13675 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13676 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13677 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13678 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13679 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13680 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13681 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13682 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13683 connection"
13684 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13685 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13686 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13687 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13688 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13689 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13690 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13691 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13692 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13693 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13694 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13695 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13696 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13697 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13698 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13699 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13700 .endtable
13701
13702
13703
13704 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13705 .table2
13706 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13707 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13708 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13709 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13710 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13711 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13712 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13713 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
13714 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13715 .endtable
13716
13717
13718
13719 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13720 .table2
13721 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13722 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13723 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13724 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13725 words""&"
13726 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13727 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13728 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13729 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13730 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13731 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13732 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13733 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13734 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13735 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13736 .endtable
13737
13738
13739
13740 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13741 .table2
13742 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13743 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13744 directory"
13745 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13746 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13747 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13748 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13749 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13750 .endtable
13751
13752
13753
13754 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13755 .table2
13756 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13757 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13758 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13759 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13760 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13761 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13762 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13763 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13764 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13765 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13766 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13767 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13768 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13769 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13770 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13771 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13772 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13773 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13774 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13775 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13776 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13777 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13778 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13779 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13780 .endtable
13781
13782
13783
13784 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13785 .table2
13786 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13787 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13788 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13789 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13790 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13791 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13792 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13793 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13794 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13795 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13796 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13797 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13798 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13799 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13800 .endtable
13801
13802
13803
13804 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13805 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13806 &dagger;.
13807
13808 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13809 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13810 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13811 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13812 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13813 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13814 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13815 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13816 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13817
13818 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13819 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13820 It now defaults to true.
13821 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13822 .display
13823 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13824 .endd
13825
13826 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13827 .code
13828 log_selector = +8bitmime
13829 .endd
13830
13831 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13832 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13833 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13834 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13835 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13836 further details.
13837
13838 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13839 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13840 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13841 SMTP messages.
13842
13843 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13844 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13845 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13846 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13847 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13848
13849 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13850 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13851 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13852 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13853 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13854
13855 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13856 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13857 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13858 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13859
13860 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13861 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13862 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13863 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13864 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13865
13866 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13867 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13868 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13869 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13870 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13871 This option defines the ACL that,
13872 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13873 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13874 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13875 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13876
13877 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13878 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13879 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13880 of a received message.
13881 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13882
13883 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13884 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13885 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13886 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13887
13888 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13889 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13890 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13891 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13892
13893 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13894 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13895 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13896 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13897 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13898
13899
13900 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13901 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13902 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13903 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13904
13905 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13906 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13907 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13908 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13909 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13910
13911 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13912 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13913 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13914 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13915 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13916
13917 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13918 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13919 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13920 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13921 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13922
13923 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13924 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13925 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13926 further details.
13927
13928 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13929 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13930 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13931 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13932
13933 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13934 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13935 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13936 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13937
13938 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13939 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13940 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13941 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13942
13943 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13944 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13945 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13946 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13947
13948 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13949 .cindex "admin user"
13950 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13951 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13952 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13953 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13954 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13955 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13956 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13957
13958 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13959 .cindex "domain literal"
13960 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13961 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13962 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13963 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13964
13965 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13966 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13967 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13968 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13969 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13970 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13971 the local host's IP addresses.
13972
13973
13974 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13975 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13976 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13977 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13978 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13979 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13980 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13981 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13982 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13983
13984 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13985 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13986 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13987 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13988 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13989 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13990 experiment if they wish.
13991
13992 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13993 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13994 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13995 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13996 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13997 suitable setting is:
13998 .code
13999 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14000 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14001 .endd
14002 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14003 .code
14004 dns_check_names_pattern =
14005 .endd
14006 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14007
14008
14009 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14010 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14011 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14012 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14013 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14014 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14015 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14016 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14017 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14018 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14019 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14020
14021 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14022 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14023 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14024 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14025 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14026 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14027
14028 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14029 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14030 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14031 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14032 .code
14033 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14034 .endd
14035 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14036 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14037 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14038 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14039
14040
14041 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14042 .cindex "thawing messages"
14043 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14044 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14045 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14046 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14047 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14048 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14049
14050 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14051 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14052 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14053
14054
14055 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14056 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14057 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14058 .code
14059 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14060 .endd
14061 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14062 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14063
14064
14065 .option bi_command main string unset
14066 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14067 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14068 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14069 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14070 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14071
14072
14073 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14074 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14075 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14076 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14077 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14078 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14079
14080
14081 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14082 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14083 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14084 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14085
14086 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14087 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14088 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14089 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14090 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14091 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14092 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14093 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14094 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14095 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14096
14097 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14098 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14099 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14100 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14101
14102
14103 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14104 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14105 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14106 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14107 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14108 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14109 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14110 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14111 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14112
14113 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14114 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14115 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14116 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14117 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14118 messages.
14119
14120 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14121 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14122 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14123 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14124 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14125 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14126 connection. A typical setting might be:
14127 .code
14128 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14129 .endd
14130 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14131 .code
14132 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14133 .endd
14134 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14135 address.
14136
14137 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14138 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14139 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14140 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14141 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14142 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14143
14144
14145 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14146 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14147 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14148 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14149
14150
14151 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14152 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14153 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14154 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14155
14156
14157 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14158 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14159 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14160 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14161
14162
14163 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14164 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14165 callout verification. The default value is
14166 .code
14167 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14168 .endd
14169 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14170
14171
14172 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14173 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14174
14175
14176 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14177 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14178
14179 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14180 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14181 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14182 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14183 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14184 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14185 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14186 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14187 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14188 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14189
14190
14191 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14192 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14193
14194
14195 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14196 .cindex "checking disk space"
14197 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14198 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14199 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14200 message is accepted.
14201
14202 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14203 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14204 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14205 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14206 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14207 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14208 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14209 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14210
14211
14212 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14213 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14214 .code
14215 check_spool_space = 10M
14216 check_spool_inodes = 100
14217 .endd
14218 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14219 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14220 transit.
14221
14222 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14223 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14224 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14225
14226 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14227 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14228 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14229 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14230 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14231 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14232
14233 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14234 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14235
14236 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14237 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14238 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14239
14240 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14241 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14242 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14243 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14244 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14245 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14246
14247 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14248 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14249 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14250 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14251 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14252 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14253 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14254
14255 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14256 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14257
14258 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14259 .cindex "warning of delay"
14260 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14261 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14262 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14263 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14264 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14265 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14266 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14267 with
14268 .code
14269 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14270 .endd
14271 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14272 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14273 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14274 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14275 .code
14276 delay_warning = 6h
14277 .endd
14278 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14279 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14280 .code
14281 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14282 .endd
14283 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14284 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14285 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14286
14287 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14288 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14289 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14290 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14291 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14292 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14293 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14294 not sent. The default is:
14295 .code
14296 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14297 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14298 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14299 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14300 } {no}{yes}}
14301 .endd
14302 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14303 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14304 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14305 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14306
14307 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14308 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14309 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14310 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14311 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14312 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14313 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14314 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14315
14316 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14317 .cindex "load average"
14318 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14319 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14320 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14321 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14322 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14323
14324
14325 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14326 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14327 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14328 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14329 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14330 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14331 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14332 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14333
14334 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14335 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14336 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14337 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14338 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14339 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14340 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14341 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14342
14343 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14344 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14345 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14346 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14347
14348
14349 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14350 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14351 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14352 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14353 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14354 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14355 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14356
14357
14358 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14359 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14360 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14361 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14362 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14363 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14364
14365
14366 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14367 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14368 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14369 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14370 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14371 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14372 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14373 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14374 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14375 by a setting such as this:
14376 .code
14377 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14378 .endd
14379 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14380 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14381 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14382 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14383 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14384 options are applied after this global option.
14385
14386 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14387 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14388 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14389 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14390 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14391 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14392 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14393 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14394 value of this option. The default pattern is
14395 .code
14396 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14397 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14398 .endd
14399 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14400 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14401 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14402 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14403 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14404 empty string.
14405
14406 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14407 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14408 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14409
14410 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14411 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14412 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14413 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14414
14415
14416 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14417 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14418 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14419 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14420 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14421 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14422
14423 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14424
14425
14426 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14427 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14428 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14429 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14430 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14431 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14432 domain matches this list.
14433
14434 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14435 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14436 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14437
14438
14439 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14440 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14441 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14442 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14443 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14444 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14445 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14446 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14447 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14448 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14449 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14450 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14451 to set in them.
14452 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14453
14454
14455 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14456 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14457
14458
14459 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14460 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14461 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14462 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14463 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14464 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14465 match with this expanded domain list.
14466
14467 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14468 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14469 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14470 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14471 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14472 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14473
14474 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14475 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14476 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14477
14478 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14479 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14480 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14481 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14482 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14483
14484 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14485 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14486 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14487 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14488 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14489 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14490 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14491 on.
14492
14493 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14494
14495
14496 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14497 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14498 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14499 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14500
14501 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14502 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14503 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14504 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14505 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14506 and accepted from, these hosts.
14507 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14508 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14509 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14510 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14511 are sent.
14512
14513 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14514 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14515 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14516 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14517 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14518 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14519 .code
14520 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14521 .endd
14522 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14523 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14524
14525 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14526 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14527 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14528 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14529 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14530 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14531 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14532 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14533 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14534
14535
14536 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14537 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14538 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14539 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14540 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14541 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14542 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14543 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14544 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14545
14546 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14547 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14548 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14549 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14550 are examined. For example:
14551 .code
14552 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14553 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14554 postmaster@mydomain.example
14555 .endd
14556 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14557 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14558 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14559 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14560 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14561 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14562 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14563
14564
14565 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14566 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14567 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14568 .display
14569 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14570 .endd
14571 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14572 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14573 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14574 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14575 overrides the default.
14576
14577 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14578 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14579 and warning messages. For example:
14580 .code
14581 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14582 .endd
14583 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14584 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14585 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14586 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14587 not used.
14588
14589
14590 .new
14591 .option event_action main string&!! unset
14592 .cindex events
14593 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
14594 For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
14595 .wen
14596
14597
14598 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14599 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14600 .cindex "Exim group"
14601 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14602 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14603 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14604 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14605 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14606 security issues.
14607
14608
14609 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14610 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14611 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14612 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14613 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14614 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14615 other place.
14616 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14617 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14618 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14619 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14620
14621
14622 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14623 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14624 .cindex "Exim user"
14625 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14626 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14627 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14628 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14629
14630 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14631 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14632 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14633 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14634
14635
14636 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14637 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14638 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14639 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14640
14641
14642 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14643 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14644
14645 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14646 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14647 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14648 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14649 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14650 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14651 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14652 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14653 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14654 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14655 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14656 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14657 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14658 addresses.
14659
14660
14661 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14662 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14663 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14664 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14665 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14666 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14667 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14668 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14669 retries.
14670
14671 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14672 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14673 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14674 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14675
14676
14677
14678 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14679 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14680 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14681 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14682 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14683 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14684 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14685 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14686 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14687 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14688 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14689 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14690 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14691 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14692 logging that you require.
14693
14694
14695 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14696 .cindex "HP-UX"
14697 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14698 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14699 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14700 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14701 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14702 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14703 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14704 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14705
14706 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14707 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14708 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14709 user's name.
14710
14711 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14712 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14713 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14714 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14715 .code
14716 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14717 gecos_name = $1
14718 .endd
14719
14720 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14721 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14722
14723
14724 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14725 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14726 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14727 implementations of TLS.
14728
14729
14730 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14731 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14732 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14733
14734 See
14735 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14736 for documentation.
14737
14738
14739
14740 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14741 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14742 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14743 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14744 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14745 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14746
14747
14748
14749 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14750 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14751 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14752 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14753 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14754 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14755 sections are rejected.
14756
14757
14758 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14759 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14760 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14761 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14762 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14763 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14764 zero means &"no limit"&.
14765
14766
14767
14768
14769 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14770 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14771 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14772 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14773 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14774 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14775 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14776 if you want to do semantic checking.
14777 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14778 set.
14779
14780
14781 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14782 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14783 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14784 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14785 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14786 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14787 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14788 .code
14789 helo_allow_chars = _
14790 .endd
14791 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14792
14793
14794 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14795 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14796 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14797 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14798 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14799 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14800 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14801 do.
14802
14803
14804 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14805 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14806 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14807 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14808 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14809 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14810 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14811 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14812 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14813 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14814 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14815 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14816
14817 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14818 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14819 EHLO command either:
14820
14821 .ilist
14822 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14823 .next
14824 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14825 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14826 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14827 calling host address, or
14828 .next
14829 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14830 .endlist
14831
14832 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14833 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14834 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14835
14836 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14837 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14838 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14839
14840 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14841 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14842 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14843 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14844 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14845 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14846 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14847 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14848 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14849 error.
14850
14851 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14852 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14853 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14854 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14855 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14856 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14857 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14858 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14859 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14860
14861 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14862 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14863 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14864 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14865 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14866
14867 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14868 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14869 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14870 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14871
14872
14873 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14874 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14875 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14876 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14877 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14878 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14879 default configuration file contains
14880 .code
14881 host_lookup = *
14882 .endd
14883 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14884 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14885
14886 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14887 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14888 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14889
14890 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14891 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14892 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14893 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14894 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14895 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14896
14897
14898 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14899 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14900 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14901 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14902 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14903 if you want.
14904
14905 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14906 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14907 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14908 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14909
14910
14911
14912 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14913 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14914 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14915 as soon as the connection is made.
14916 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14917 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14918 connections immediately.
14919
14920 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14921 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14922 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14923 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14924 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14925
14926
14927 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14928 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14929 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14930 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14931 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14932 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14933 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14934 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14935 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14936 .code
14937 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14938 .endd
14939 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14940
14941
14942
14943 .new
14944 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
14945 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
14946 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
14947 connections. For details see &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
14948 .wen
14949
14950
14951 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14952 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14953 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14954 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14955 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14956 records
14957 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14958 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14959
14960 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14961 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14962 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14963 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14964 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14965 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14966 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14967
14968
14969 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14970 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14971 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14972 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14973 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14974
14975
14976
14977 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14978 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14979 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14980 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14981 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14982 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14983
14984 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14985 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14986 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14987 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14988 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14989 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14990 for frozen messages. For example,
14991 .code
14992 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14993 .endd
14994 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14995 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14996 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14997 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14998 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14999 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15000
15001
15002 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15003 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15004 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15005 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15006 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15007 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15008 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15009 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15010 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15011 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15012
15013
15014 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15015 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15016
15017
15018 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15019 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15020 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15021 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15022 logged.
15023
15024
15025 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15026 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15027 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15028 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15029 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15030 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15031 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15032 and constrained to be a directory.
15033
15034
15035 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15036 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15037 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15038 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15039 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15040 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15041 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15042 and constrained to be a file.
15043
15044
15045 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15046 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15047 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15048 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15049 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15050 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15051
15052
15053 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15054 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15055 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15056 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15057 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15058 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15059 identity to be proven.
15060
15061
15062 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15063 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15064 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15065 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15066 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15067
15068
15069 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15070 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15071 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15072 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15073 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15074 with LDAP support.
15075
15076
15077 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15078 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15079 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15080 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15081 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15082 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15083 to hard/demand.
15084
15085
15086 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15087 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15088 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15089 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15090 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15091 of SSL-on-connect.
15092 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15093 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15094
15095
15096 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15097 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15098 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15099 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15100 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15101 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15102 has been built with LDAP support.
15103
15104
15105
15106 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15107 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15108 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15109 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15110 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15111 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15112 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15113
15114 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15115 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15116 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15117
15118 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15119 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15120 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15121 and the default qualify domain.
15122
15123 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15124 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15125 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15126 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15127
15128 .cindex "envelope sender"
15129 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15130 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15131 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15132
15133 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15134 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15135 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15136
15137
15138
15139
15140 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15141 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15142 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15143 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15144 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15145 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15146 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15147 example, if
15148 .code
15149 local_from_prefix = *-
15150 .endd
15151 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15152 .code
15153 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15154 .endd
15155 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15156 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15157 qualify domain.
15158
15159
15160 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15161 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15162
15163
15164 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15165 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15166 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15167 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15168 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15169 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15170 &%local_interfaces%& is
15171 .code
15172 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15173 .endd
15174 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15175 .code
15176 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15177 .endd
15178
15179 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15180 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15181 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15182 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15183 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15184 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15185 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15186 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15187
15188
15189
15190 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15191 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15192 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15193 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15194 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15195 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15196 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15197 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15198
15199
15200
15201
15202 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15203 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15204 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15205 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15206 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15207 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15208 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15209 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15210 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15211 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15212 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15213 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15214 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15215 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15216 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15217
15218
15219
15220 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15221 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15222 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15223 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15224 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15225 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15226 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15227 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15228 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15229 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15230 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15231 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15232 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15233 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15234 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15235
15236
15237 .option log_selector main string unset
15238 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15239 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15240 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15241 minus characters. For example:
15242 .code
15243 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15244 .endd
15245 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15246 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15247
15248
15249 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15250 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15251 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15252 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15253 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15254 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15255 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15256 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15257 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15258 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15259 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15260 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15261 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15262
15263
15264 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15265 .cindex "too many open files"
15266 .cindex "open files, too many"
15267 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15268 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15269 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15270 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15271 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15272 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15273 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15274 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15275 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15276 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15277 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15278 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15279
15280
15281 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15282 .cindex "length of login name"
15283 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15284 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15285 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15286 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15287 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15288 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15289
15290
15291 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15292 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15293 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15294 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15295 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15296 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15297 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15298 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15299
15300
15301 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15302 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15303 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15304 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15305 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15306 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15307 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15308
15309
15310 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15311 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15312 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15313 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15314 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15315 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15316 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15317 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15318 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15319 empty string, the option is ignored.
15320
15321
15322 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15323 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15324 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15325 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15326 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15327 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15328 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15329 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15330 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15331 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15332 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15333 colons will become hyphens.
15334
15335
15336 .option message_logs main boolean true
15337 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15338 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15339 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15340 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15341 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15342 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15343 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15344 which is not affected by this option.
15345
15346
15347 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15348 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15349 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15350 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15351 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15352 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15353 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15354 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15355 optionally followed by K or M.
15356
15357 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15358 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15359 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15360 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15361 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15362
15363 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15364 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15365 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15366 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15367 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15368 message that an individual transport can process.
15369
15370 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15371 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15372 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15373 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15374 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15375 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15376 some problems may result.
15377
15378 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15379 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15380 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15381
15382
15383 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15384 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15385 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15386 .code
15387 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15388 .endd
15389 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15390 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15391 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15392 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15393 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15394
15395
15396 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15397 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15398 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15399 contains a full description of this facility.
15400
15401
15402
15403 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15404 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15405 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15406 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15407 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15408
15409
15410 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15411 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15412 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15413 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15414 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15415 safety precaution.
15416
15417 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15418 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15419 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15420 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15421 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15422
15423 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15424 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15425 example is
15426 .code
15427 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15428 .endd
15429 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15430 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15431 transport driver.
15432
15433
15434 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15435 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15436 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15437 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15438 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15439
15440 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15441 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15442 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15443 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15444 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15445 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15446 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15447
15448 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15449 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15450 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15451 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15452 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15453
15454 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15455
15456 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15457 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15458 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15459 some now infamous attacks.
15460
15461 Examples:
15462 .code
15463 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15464 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15465 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15466
15467 # Disable older protocol versions:
15468 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15469 .endd
15470
15471 Possible options may include:
15472 .ilist
15473 &`all`&
15474 .next
15475 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15476 .next
15477 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15478 .next
15479 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15480 .next
15481 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15482 .next
15483 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15484 .next
15485 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15486 .next
15487 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15488 .next
15489 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15490 .next
15491 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15492 .next
15493 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15494 .next
15495 &`no_compression`&
15496 .next
15497 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15498 .next
15499 &`no_sslv2`&
15500 .next
15501 &`no_sslv3`&
15502 .next
15503 &`no_ticket`&
15504 .next
15505 &`no_tlsv1`&
15506 .next
15507 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15508 .next
15509 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15510 .next
15511 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15512 .next
15513 &`single_dh_use`&
15514 .next
15515 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15516 .next
15517 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15518 .next
15519 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15520 .next
15521 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15522 .next
15523 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15524 .next
15525 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15526 .endlist
15527
15528 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15529 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15530 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15531 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15532 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15533 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15534
15535
15536 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15537 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15538 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15539 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15540 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15541
15542
15543 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15544 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15545 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15546 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15547 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15548 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15549 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15550 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15551 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15552 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15553 an ACL.
15554
15555 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15556 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15557 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15558 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15559 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15560 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15561 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15562
15563
15564 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15565 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15566 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15567
15568
15569 .option perl_startup main string unset
15570 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15571 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15572
15573
15574 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15575 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15576 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15577 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15578 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15579 PostgreSQL support.
15580
15581
15582 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15583 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15584 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15585 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15586 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15587 to the host name:
15588 .code
15589 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15590 .endd
15591 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15592 spool directory.
15593 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15594 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15595 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15596
15597
15598 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15599 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15600 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15601 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15602 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15603 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15604 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15605 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15606 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15607
15608
15609 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15610 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15611 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15612 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15613 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15614 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15615 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15616 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15617
15618 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15619 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15620 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15621 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15622 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15623 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15624 volume of mail. Use with care!
15625
15626
15627 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15628 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15629 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15630 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15631 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15632 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15633 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15634 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15635 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15636 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15637
15638 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15639 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15640 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15641 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15642 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15643 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15644
15645
15646 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15647 .cindex "printing characters"
15648 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15649 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15650 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15651 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15652 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15653 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15654 characters.
15655
15656 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15657 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15658 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15659 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15660 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15661 standards.
15662
15663
15664 .option process_log_path main string unset
15665 .cindex "process log path"
15666 .cindex "log" "process log"
15667 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15668 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15669 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15670 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15671 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15672 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15673 different spool directories.
15674
15675
15676 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15677 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15678 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15679 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15680 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15681 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15682 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15683
15684
15685 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15686 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15687 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15688 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15689 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15690 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15691 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15692 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15693 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15694
15695 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15696 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15697 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15698 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15699 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15700 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15701 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15702
15703
15704 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15705 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15706 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15707
15708
15709
15710 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15711 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15712 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15713 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15714 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15715 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15716 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15717 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15718
15719
15720 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15721 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15722 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15723 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15724 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15725
15726
15727 .option queue_only main boolean false
15728 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15729 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15730 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15731 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15732 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15733 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15734
15735 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15736 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15737 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15738 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15739
15740
15741 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15742 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15743 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15744 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15745 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15746 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15747 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15748 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15749 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15750 .code
15751 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15752 .endd
15753 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15754 &_/some/file_& exists.
15755
15756
15757 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15758 .cindex "load average"
15759 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15760 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15761 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15762 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15763 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15764 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15765 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15766 false.
15767
15768 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15769 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15770 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15771 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15772
15773
15774 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15775 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15776 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15777 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15778 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15779 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15780 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15781 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15782 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15783 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15784 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15785 re-evaluated for each message.
15786
15787
15788 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15789 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15790 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15791 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15792 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15793 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15794
15795
15796 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15797 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15798 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15799 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15800 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15801 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15802 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15803 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15804 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15805 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15806 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15807 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15808 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15809
15810
15811
15812 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15813 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15814 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15815 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15816 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15817 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15818 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15819 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15820 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15821
15822 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15823 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15824 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15825 the daemon's command line.
15826
15827 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15828 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15829 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15830 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15831 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15832 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15833 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15834 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15835 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15836 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15837 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15838 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15839 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15840 &%queue_domains%&.
15841
15842
15843 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15844 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15845 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15846 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15847 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15848 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15849 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15850
15851 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15852 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15853 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15854 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15855 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15856 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15857 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15858 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15859 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15860 header lines. The default setting is:
15861
15862 .code
15863 received_header_text = Received: \
15864 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15865 {${if def:sender_ident \
15866 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15867 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15868 by $primary_hostname \
15869 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15870 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15871 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15872 ${if def:sender_address \
15873 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15874 id $message_exim_id\
15875 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15876 .endd
15877
15878 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15879 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15880 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15881 header lines such as the following:
15882 .code
15883 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15884 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15885 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15886 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15887 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15888 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15889 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15890 .endd
15891 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15892 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15893 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15894 message was accepted.
15895
15896
15897 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15898 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15899 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15900 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15901 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15902 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15903 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15904 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15905
15906
15907 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15908 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15909 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15910 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15911 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15912 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15913 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15914 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15915 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15916 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15917 option was not set.
15918
15919
15920 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15921 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15922 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15923 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15924 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15925 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15926 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15927 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15928 done.
15929
15930 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15931 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15932 RCPT commands in a single message.
15933
15934
15935 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15936 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15937 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15938 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15939 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15940 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15941 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15942
15943
15944 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15945 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15946 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15947 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15948 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15949 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15950 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15951 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15952 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15953 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15954 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15955 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15956 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15957 tagged with its process id.
15958
15959 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15960 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15961 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15962 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15963 is received.
15964
15965 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15966 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15967 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15968 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15969 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15970 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15971 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15972 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15973 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15974 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15975 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15976
15977 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15978 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15979 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15980 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15981
15982
15983 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15984 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15985 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15986 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15987 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15988 .code
15989 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15990 .endd
15991 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15992 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15993
15994
15995 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15996 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15997 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15998 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15999 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16000 past failures.
16001
16002
16003 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16004 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16005 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16006 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16007 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16008 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16009 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16010 the default value.
16011
16012
16013 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16014 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16015 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16016 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16017 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16018 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16019 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16020 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16021 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16022 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16023
16024
16025 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16026 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16027
16028
16029 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16030 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16031 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16032 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16033 an item in the list.
16034 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16035 for the system.
16036
16037 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16038 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16039 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16040 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16041 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16042
16043
16044 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16045 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16046 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16047 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16048 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16049 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16050 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16051 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16052 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16053 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16054
16055
16056 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16057 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16058 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16059 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16060 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16061 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16062 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16063
16064
16065
16066 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16067 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16068 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16069 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16070 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16071 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16072 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16073 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16074 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16075 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16076 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16077
16078
16079
16080 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16081 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16082 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16083 .cindex "inetd"
16084 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16085 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16086 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16087 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16088 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16089 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16090
16091 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16092 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16093 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16094 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16095
16096
16097 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16098 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16099 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16100 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16101 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16102 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16103 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16104 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16105
16106 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16107 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16108 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16109 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16110 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16111 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16112 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16113 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16114
16115
16116 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16117 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16118 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16119 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16120 live with.
16121
16122
16123 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16124 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16125 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16126 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16127 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16128 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16129 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16130 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16131 . the option name to split.
16132
16133 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16134 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16135 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16136 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16137 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16138 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16139 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16140 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16141 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16142 seen).
16143
16144
16145 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16146 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16147 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16148 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16149 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16150 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16151 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16152 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16153 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16154 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16155 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16156
16157 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16158 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16159 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16160 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16161 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16162 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16163
16164
16165
16166 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16167 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16168 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16169 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16170 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16171 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16172 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16173 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16174 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16175 to all messages received in the same connection.
16176
16177 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16178 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16179 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16180 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16181
16182
16183 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16184
16185 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16186 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16187 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16188 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16189 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16190 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16191 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16192 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16193 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16194 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16195 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16196 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16197 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16198
16199
16200 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16201 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16202 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16203 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16204 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16205 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16206 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16207 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16208 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16209 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16210 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16211 individual host.
16212
16213 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16214 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16215 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16216 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16217
16218
16219 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16220 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16221 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16222 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16223 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16224 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16225 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16226 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16227 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16228
16229 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16230 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16231 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16232 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16233
16234 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16235 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16236 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16237 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16238 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16239 For example:
16240 .code
16241 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16242 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16243 .endd
16244
16245 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16246 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16247 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16248 &%helo_data%& value.
16249
16250 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16251 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16252 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16253 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16254 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16255 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16256 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16257 .code
16258 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16259 $version_number $tod_full
16260 .endd
16261 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16262 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16263 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16264 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16265 multiline response).
16266
16267
16268 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16269 .cindex "checking disk space"
16270 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16271 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16272 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16273 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16274 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16275 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16276 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16277
16278
16279 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16280 .cindex "connection backlog"
16281 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16282 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16283 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16284 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16285 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16286 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16287 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16288 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16289 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16290 attacks by SYN flooding.
16291
16292
16293 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16294 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16295 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16296 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16297 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16298 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16299 fewer, but they still exist.
16300
16301 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16302 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16303 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16304 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16305 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16306 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16307 does detect many instances.
16308
16309 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16310 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16311 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16312 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16313
16314
16315
16316 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16317 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16318 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16319 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16320 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16321 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16322 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16323 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16324 example:
16325 .code
16326 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16327 $sender_host_address
16328 .endd
16329 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16330 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16331 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16332 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16333 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16334 the command.
16335
16336
16337 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16338 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16339 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16340 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16341 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16342
16343
16344 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16345 .cindex "load average"
16346 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16347 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16348 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16349 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16350 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16351 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16352
16353
16354
16355 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16356 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16357 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16358 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16359 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16360 .code
16361 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16362 .endd
16363 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16364 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16365 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16366 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16367 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16368
16369 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16370 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16371 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16372 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16373 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16374 not count towards the limit.
16375
16376
16377
16378 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16379 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16380 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16381 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16382 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16383 that subvert web
16384 clients
16385 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16386 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16387
16388
16389
16390 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16391 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16392 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16393 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16394 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16395 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16396 recipients.
16397
16398 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16399 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16400 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16401 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16402
16403 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16404 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16405 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16406 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16407 values:
16408
16409 .ilist
16410 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16411 .next
16412 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16413 fractional parts are allowed here.
16414 .next
16415 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16416 .next
16417 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16418 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16419 .endlist
16420
16421 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16422 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16423 .code
16424 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16425 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16426 .endd
16427 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16428 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16429 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16430 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16431
16432
16433 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16434 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16435
16436
16437 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16438 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16439
16440
16441 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16442 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16443 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16444 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16445 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16446 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16447 the message is abandoned.
16448 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16449 .code
16450 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16451 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16452 .endd
16453 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16454 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16455
16456 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16457 expanded before use and may depend on
16458 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16459
16460
16461 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16462 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16463 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16464 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16465 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16466 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16467
16468
16469 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16470 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16471 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16472
16473
16474 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16475 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16476 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16477 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16478 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16479 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16480 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16481 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16482 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16483 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16484 .code
16485 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16486 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16487 .endd
16488
16489
16490 .new
16491 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16492 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16493 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16494 the availability therof is advertised in
16495 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16496 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
16497 .wen
16498
16499
16500 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16501 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16502 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16503 The default value is
16504 .code
16505 127.0.0.1 783
16506 .endd
16507 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16508
16509
16510
16511 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16512 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16513 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16514 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16515 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16516 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16517 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16518 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16519 arrival of the message.
16520
16521 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16522 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16523 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16524 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16525 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16526
16527 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16528 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16529 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16530 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16531 automatically deleted.
16532
16533 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16534 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16535 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16536 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16537 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16538 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16539 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16540 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16541 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16542
16543
16544 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16545 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16546 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16547 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16548 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16549 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16550 &$primary_hostname$&.
16551
16552 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16553 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16554 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16555 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16556 as failures in the configuration file.
16557
16558 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16559 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16560
16561 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16562 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16563 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16564 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16565
16566 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16567 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16568 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16569 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16570 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16571 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16572
16573 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16574 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16575 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16576 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16577 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16578 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16579 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16580
16581
16582 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16583 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16584 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16585 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16586 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16587 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16588 domain causes a syntax error.
16589 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16590 syntax checking.
16591
16592
16593 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16594 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16595 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16596 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16597 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16598 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16599 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16600 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16601 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16602 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16603 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16604 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16605
16606
16607 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16608 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16609 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16610 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16611 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16612 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16613 details of Exim's logging.
16614
16615
16616
16617 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16618 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16619 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16620 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16621 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16622
16623
16624
16625 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16626 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16627 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16628 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16629 details of Exim's logging.
16630
16631
16632 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16633 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16634 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16635 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16636 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16637 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16638 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16639 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16640 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16641 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16642 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16643
16644
16645 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16646 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16647 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16648 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16649 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16650 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16651
16652
16653 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16654 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16655 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16656 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16657 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16658
16659 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16660 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16661 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16662 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16663 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16664
16665 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16666 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16667 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16668 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16669 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16670 contains the pipe command.
16671
16672
16673 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16674 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16675 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16676 is used in a system filter.
16677
16678
16679 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16680 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16681 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16682 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16683 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16684 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16685 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16686 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16687 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16688 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16689
16690 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16691 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16692 transport option overrides.
16693
16694
16695 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16696 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16697 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16698 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16699 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16700 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16701 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16702 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16703 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16704 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16705 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16706 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16707 TCP_NODELAY.
16708
16709
16710 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16711 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16712 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16713 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16714 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16715 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16716 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16717 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16718 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16719 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16720
16721 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16722 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16723 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16724
16725
16726 .option timezone main string unset
16727 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16728 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16729 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16730 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16731 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16732 .code
16733 timezone = UTC
16734 .endd
16735 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16736 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16737 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16738 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16739 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16740 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16741
16742
16743 .new
16744 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16745 .wen
16746 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16747 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16748 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16749 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16750 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16751 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16752 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16753 .new
16754 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16755 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16756 the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16757 .wen
16758
16759
16760 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16761 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16762 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16763 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16764 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16765 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16766 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16767
16768 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16769 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16770 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16771 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16772
16773 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16774 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16775 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16776 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16777
16778 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16779 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16780 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16781 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16782 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16783
16784 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16785
16786
16787 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16788 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16789 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16790 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16791 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16792 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16793
16794 The value must be at least 1024.
16795
16796 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16797 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16798 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16799
16800 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16801 number.
16802
16803 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16804 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16805 larger prime than requested.
16806
16807
16808 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16809 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16810 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16811 to be used by Exim.
16812
16813 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16814 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16815 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16816 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16817 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16818 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16819 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16820
16821 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16822 loaded by Exim.
16823
16824 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16825 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16826 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16827 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16828
16829 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16830 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16831 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16832 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16833
16834 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16835 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16836 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16837 "ike23".
16838
16839 The available primes are:
16840 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16841 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16842 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16843
16844 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16845 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16846
16847 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16848 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16849 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16850 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16851 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16852 userbase.
16853
16854 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16855 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16856 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16857 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16858 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16859 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16860 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16861
16862
16863 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16864 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16865 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16866 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16867
16868 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16869 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16870 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16871 which tell the library to choose.
16872
16873 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16874
16875
16876 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16877 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16878 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16879 This option
16880 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16881 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16882 Certificate Authority.
16883
16884 .new
16885 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16886 .wen
16887
16888
16889 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16890 .cindex SSMTP
16891 .cindex SMTPS
16892 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16893 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16894 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16895 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16896
16897
16898
16899 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16900 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16901 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16902 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16903 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16904 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16905 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16906
16907 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16908
16909
16910 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16911 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16912 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16913 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16914 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16915 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16916 TLS session.
16917
16918
16919 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16920 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16921 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16922 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16923 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16924 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16925 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16926 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16927 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16928 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16929 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16930
16931
16932 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16933 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16934 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16935 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16936
16937
16938 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16939 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16940 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16941 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16942 word "system"
16943 or the absolute path to
16944 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16945 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16946
16947 The "system" value for the option will use a
16948 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16949 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16950 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16951 must be specified.
16952
16953 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16954 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16955
16956 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16957 explicitly
16958 either by file or directory
16959 are added to those given by the system default location.
16960
16961 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16962 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16963 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16964 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16965 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16966 use the explicit directory version.
16967
16968 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16969
16970 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16971 being unset.
16972
16973
16974 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16975 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16976 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16977 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16978 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16979 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16980 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16981 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16982
16983 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16984 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16985 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16986 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16987 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16988 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16989 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16990
16991 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16992 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16993 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16994 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16995 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16996 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16997 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16998 certificate"&.
16999
17000 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17001 certificates.
17002
17003
17004 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17005 .cindex "trusted groups"
17006 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17007 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17008 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17009 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17010 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17011 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17012 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17013 are trusted.
17014
17015 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17016 .cindex "trusted users"
17017 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17018 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17019 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17020 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17021 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17022 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17023 Exim user are trusted.
17024
17025 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17026 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17027 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17028 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17029 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17030 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17031 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17032 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17033 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17034 &%-F%& option.
17035
17036 .option unknown_username main string unset
17037 See &%unknown_login%&.
17038
17039 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17040 .cindex "trusted users"
17041 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17042 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17043 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17044 .cindex "envelope sender"
17045 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17046 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17047 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17048 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17049 is used) is ignored.
17050
17051 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17052 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17053 .code
17054 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17055 .endd
17056 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17057 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17058 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17059 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17060 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17061 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17062 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17063 followed by a hyphen
17064 by a setting like this:
17065 .code
17066 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17067 .endd
17068 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17069 restriction, you can use
17070 .code
17071 untrusted_set_sender = *
17072 .endd
17073 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17074 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17075 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17076 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17077 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17078 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17079 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17080 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17081
17082 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17083 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17084 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17085 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17086 sender address.
17087
17088
17089 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17090 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17091 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17092 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17093 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17094 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17095 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17096 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17097 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17098 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17099 .code
17100 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17101 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17102 .endd
17103 The pattern can be seen by running
17104 .code
17105 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17106 .endd
17107 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17108 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17109 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17110 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17111 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17112 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17113
17114
17115 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17116 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17117
17118
17119 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17120 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17121 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17122 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17123 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17124 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17125 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17126 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17127
17128
17129 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17130 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17131 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17132 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17133 .ecindex IIDconfima
17134 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17135
17136
17137
17138
17139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17140 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17141
17142 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17143 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17144 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17145 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17146 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17147
17148 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17149 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17150 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17151 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17152 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17153
17154
17155
17156 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17157 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17158 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17159 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17160 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17161 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17162 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17163
17164 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17165 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17166 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17167 routers, and the eventual transport.
17168
17169 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17170 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17171 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17172 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17173 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17174
17175 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17176 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17177 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17178 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17179 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17180
17181 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17182 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17183 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17184 .code
17185 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17186 .endd
17187 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17188 .code
17189 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17190 .endd
17191 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17192 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17193
17194 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17195 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17196 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17197 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17198 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17199 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17200 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17201
17202
17203
17204 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17205 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
17206 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17207 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17208 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17209 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17210 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17211 routing.
17212
17213
17214
17215 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17216 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17217 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17218 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17219 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17220 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17221 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17222 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17223 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17224 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17225 you could put:
17226 .code
17227 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17228 .endd
17229 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17230 and
17231 .code
17232 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17233 .endd
17234 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17235 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17236 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17237 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17238
17239
17240 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17241 .cindex "case of local parts"
17242 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17243 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17244 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17245 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17246 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17247 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17248 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17249 more details.
17250
17251 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17252 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17253 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17254 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17255 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17256 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17257 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17258 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17259 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17260
17261 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17262 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17263 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17264 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17265
17266
17267
17268 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17269 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17270 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17271 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17272 .vindex "&$home$&"
17273 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17274 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17275 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17276 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17277 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17278 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17279 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17280 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17281 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17282 the router is skipped.
17283
17284 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17285 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17286 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17287 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17288 setting to achieve this. For example:
17289 .code
17290 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17291 .endd
17292 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17293 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17294 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17295
17296
17297
17298 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17299 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17300 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17301 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17302 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17303 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17304 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17305 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17306
17307 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17308 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17309
17310 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17311 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17312
17313 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17314 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17315 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17316 .code
17317 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17318 .endd
17319 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17320 .code
17321 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17322 .endd
17323
17324 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17325 .code
17326 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17327 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17328 condition = foobar
17329 .endd
17330
17331 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17332 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17333 be specified using &%condition%&.
17334
17335 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17336 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17337 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17338 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17339 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17340 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17341 Router rules processing behavior.
17342
17343 This is best illustrated in an example:
17344 .code
17345 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17346 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17347
17348 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17349 true {yes} {no}}
17350
17351 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17352 {yes} {no}}
17353 .endd
17354 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17355 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17356 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17357 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17358 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17359 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17360 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17361 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17362
17363 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17364 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17365 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17366 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17367 string characters.
17368
17369 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17370 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17371 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17372 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17373 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17374
17375
17376 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17377 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17378 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17379 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17380 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17381 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17382 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17383 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17384 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17385 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17386 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17387 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17388 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17389 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17390
17391
17392
17393 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17394 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17395 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17396 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17397 transport option of the same name.
17398
17399 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17400 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17401 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17402 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17403 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17404 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17405 the dnssec request bit set.
17406 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17407
17408 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17409 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17410 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17411 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17412 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17413 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17414 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17415 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17416 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17417
17418
17419 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17420 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17421 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17422 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17423 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17424 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17425 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17426 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17427
17428
17429
17430 .option driver routers string unset
17431 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17432 to be used.
17433
17434
17435 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17436 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17437 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17438 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17439 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17440 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17441 Not effective on redirect routers.
17442
17443
17444
17445 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17446 .cindex "envelope sender"
17447 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17448 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17449 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17450 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17451 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17452 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17453 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17454
17455 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17456 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17457 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17458 setting.
17459
17460 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17461 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17462 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17463 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17464
17465 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17466 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17467 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17468 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17469 settings:
17470 .code
17471 errors_to =
17472 errors_to = ""
17473 .endd
17474 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17475 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17476 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17477 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17478 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17479
17480 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17481 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17482 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17483 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17484 setting &%return_path%&.
17485
17486 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17487 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17488 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17489
17490
17491
17492 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17493 .cindex "address" "testing"
17494 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17495 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17496 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17497 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17498 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17499 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17500 on for the system alias file.
17501 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17502 are evaluated.
17503
17504 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17505 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17506 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17507
17508
17509
17510 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17511 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17512 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17513 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17514
17515
17516
17517 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17518 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17519 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17520
17521
17522
17523 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17524 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17525 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17526
17527
17528
17529 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17530 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17531 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17532 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17533 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17534 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17535 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17536 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17537 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17538
17539 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17540 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17541 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17542 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17543 transport for further details.
17544
17545
17546 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17547 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17548 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17549 .cindex "transport" "local"
17550 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17551 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17552 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17553 process.
17554 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17555 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17556 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17557 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17558 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17559
17560
17561
17562 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17563 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17564 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17565 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17566 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17567 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17568 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17569 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17570 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17571 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17572 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17573 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17574 &"see"& the added header lines.
17575
17576 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17577 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17578 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17579 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17580
17581 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17582 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17583
17584 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17585 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17586
17587 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17588 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17589 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17590 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17591 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17592 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17593 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17594 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17595 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17596 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17597
17598
17599
17600 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17601 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17602 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17603 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17604 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17605 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17606 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17607 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17608 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17609 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17610 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17611 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17612 &"see"& the original header lines.
17613
17614 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17615 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17616 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17617 errors.
17618
17619 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17620 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17621
17622 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17623 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17624
17625 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17626 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17627 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17628 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17629
17630 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17631 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17632 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17633
17634
17635
17636 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17637 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17638 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17639 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17640 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17641 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17642 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17643 like
17644 .code
17645 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17646 .endd
17647 by setting
17648 .code
17649 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17650 .endd
17651 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17652 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17653 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17654 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17655 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17656 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17657
17658 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17659 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17660 .code
17661 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17662 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17663 .endd
17664 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17665 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17666
17667 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17668 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17669 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17670 domain that is being routed.
17671
17672 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17673 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17674 checked.
17675
17676 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17677 .cindex "additional groups"
17678 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17679 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17680 .cindex "transport" "local"
17681 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17682 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17683 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17684 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17685 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17686
17687
17688
17689 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17690 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17691 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17692 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17693 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17694 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17695 evaluated.
17696
17697 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17698 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17699 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17700 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17701 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17702 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17703 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17704 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17705 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17706
17707 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17708 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17709 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17710 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17711 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17712 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17713 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17714 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17715 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17716 the relevant transport.
17717
17718 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17719 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17720 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17721 callout.
17722
17723 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17724 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17725 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17726 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17727 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17728 .code
17729 real_localuser:
17730 driver = accept
17731 local_part_prefix = real-
17732 check_local_user
17733 transport = local_delivery
17734 .endd
17735 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17736 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17737 .code
17738 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17739 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17740 .endd
17741
17742 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17743 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17744 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17745 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17746
17747
17748 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17749 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17750
17751
17752
17753 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17754 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17755 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17756 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17757 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17758 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17759 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17760 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17761 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17762 &%username-foo%&.
17763
17764
17765 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17766 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17767
17768
17769
17770 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17771 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17772 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17773 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17774 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17775 are evaluated, and
17776 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17777 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17778 example:
17779 .code
17780 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17781 .endd
17782 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17783 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17784 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17785 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17786 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17787 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17788 each virtual domain:
17789 .code
17790 postmaster:
17791 driver = redirect
17792 local_parts = postmaster
17793 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17794 .endd
17795
17796
17797 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17798 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17799 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17800 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17801 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17802 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17803 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17804 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17805 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17806 redirect addresses.
17807
17808
17809
17810 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17811 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17812 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17813 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17814 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17815 delivery to be deferred.
17816
17817 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17818 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17819 .oindex "&%self%&"
17820 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17821 means of the setting
17822 .code
17823 self = pass
17824 .endd
17825 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17826 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17827 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17828
17829 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17830 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17831 controls what happens next.
17832
17833
17834 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17835 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17836 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17837 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17838 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17839 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17840 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17841 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17842
17843 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17844 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17845 applies to all of them.
17846
17847
17848
17849 .option pass_router routers string unset
17850 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17851 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17852 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17853 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17854 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17855 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17856 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17857 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17858 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17859 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17860
17861
17862
17863 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17864 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17865 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17866 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17867 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17868 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17869
17870 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17871 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17872 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17873 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17874
17875
17876
17877 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17878 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17879 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17880 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17881 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17882 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17883 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17884
17885 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17886 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17887 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17888 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17889
17890 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17891 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17892 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17893 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17894 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17895
17896 .cindex "NFS"
17897 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17898 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17899 unavailable.
17900
17901 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17902 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17903 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17904 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17905 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17906 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17907 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17908 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17909
17910 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17911 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17912 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17913 operates as follows:
17914
17915 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17916 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17917 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17918 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17919 used. For example:
17920 .code
17921 require_files = mail:/some/file
17922 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17923 .endd
17924 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17925 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17926
17927 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17928 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17929 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17930 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17931
17932 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17933 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17934 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17935 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17936 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17937
17938 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17939 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17940 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17941 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17942 check again in that process.
17943
17944 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17945 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17946 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17947 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17948 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17949 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17950 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17951 .code
17952 require_files = +/some/file
17953 .endd
17954 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17955 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17956 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17957
17958
17959
17960 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17961 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17962 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17963 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17964 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17965 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17966 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17967 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17968 latter kind.
17969
17970 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17971 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17972 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17973 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17974 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17975 same name.
17976
17977 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17978 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17979 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17980
17981
17982
17983 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17984 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17985 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17986 .vindex "&$home$&"
17987 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17988 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17989 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17990 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17991 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17992 cause the router to defer.
17993
17994 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17995 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17996 place.
17997 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17998 are evaluated.)
17999 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18000 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18001
18002 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18003 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18004 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18005 of these values that is set:
18006
18007 .ilist
18008 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18009 .next
18010 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18011 .next
18012 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18013 .next
18014 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18015 .endlist
18016
18017 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18018 router, but not for the transport.
18019
18020
18021
18022 .option self routers string freeze
18023 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18024 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18025 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18026 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18027 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18028 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18029 of remote hosts.
18030 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18031 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18032 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18033 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18034 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18035
18036 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18037 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18038 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18039 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18040 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18041 cases:
18042
18043 .vlist
18044 .vitem &%defer%&
18045 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18046
18047 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18048 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18049 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18050 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18051
18052 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18053 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18054 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18055 rewritten.
18056
18057 .vitem &%pass%&
18058 .oindex "&%more%&"
18059 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18060 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18061 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18062 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18063 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18064 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18065 combination
18066 .code
18067 self = pass
18068 no_more
18069 .endd
18070 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18071 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18072 be passed to the next router.
18073
18074 .vitem &%fail%&
18075 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18076
18077 .vitem &%send%&
18078 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18079 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18080 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18081 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18082 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18083 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18084 .endlist
18085
18086
18087
18088 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18089 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18090 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18091 address matches something on the list.
18092 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18093 are evaluated.
18094
18095 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18096 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18097 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18098 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18099 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18100 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18101 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18102 matters.
18103
18104
18105 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18106 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18107 .cindex "packet radio"
18108 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18109 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18110 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18111 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18112 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18113 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18114 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18115 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18116
18117 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18118 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18119 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18120 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18121 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18122 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18123 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18124 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18125 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18126 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18127 .code
18128 translate_ip_address = \
18129 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18130 {$value}fail}}
18131 .endd
18132 The file would contain lines like
18133 .code
18134 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18135 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18136 .endd
18137 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18138 are doing.
18139
18140
18141
18142 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18143 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18144 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18145 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18146 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18147 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18148 delivery is deferred.
18149
18150 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18151 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18152 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18153
18154
18155
18156 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18157 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18158 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18159 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18160 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18161 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18162 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18163 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18164 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18165 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18166 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18167 environment.
18168
18169
18170
18171
18172 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18173 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18174 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18175 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18176 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18177 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18178 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18179 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18180 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18181 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18182
18183 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18184 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18185 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18186 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18187 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18188
18189 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18190 environment.
18191
18192
18193
18194
18195 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18196 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18197 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18198 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18199 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18200 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18201 delivery to be deferred.
18202
18203 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18204 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18205 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18206 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18207 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18208 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18209
18210 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18211 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18212 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18213 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18214 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18215 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18216 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18217 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18218
18219 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18220 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18221 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18222 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18223 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18224 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18225 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18226 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18227 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18228 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18229
18230 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18231 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18232 subsequent routers.
18233
18234
18235 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18236 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18237 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18238 .cindex "transport" "local"
18239 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18240 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18241 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18242 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18243 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18244 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18245 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18246 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18247 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18248 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18249 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18250 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18251
18252
18253
18254 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18255 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18256 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18257
18258
18259 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18260 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18261 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18262 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18263 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18264 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18265 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18266 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18267 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18268 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18269
18270 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18271 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18272 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18273 user or group.
18274
18275
18276 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18277 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18278 addresses,
18279 delivering in cutthrough mode
18280 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18281 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18282 are evaluated.
18283 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18284
18285
18286 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18287 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18288 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18289 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18290 are evaluated.
18291 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18292 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18293 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18294
18295
18296
18297
18298
18299
18300 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18301 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18302
18303 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18304 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18305 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18306 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18307 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18308 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18309 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18310 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18311 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18312 .code
18313 localusers:
18314 driver = accept
18315 domains = mydomain.example
18316 check_local_user
18317 transport = local_delivery
18318 .endd
18319 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18320 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18321 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18322 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18323
18324
18325
18326
18327
18328
18329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18331
18332 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18333 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18334 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18335 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18336 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18337 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18338
18339 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18340 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18341 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18342 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18343 records.
18344
18345 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18346 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18347 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18348 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18349 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18350 generic option, the router declines.
18351
18352 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18353 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18354 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18355
18356 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18357 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18358 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18359 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18360 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18361 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18362
18363
18364 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18365 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18366 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18367 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18368 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18369 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18370
18371 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18372 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18373 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18374 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18375 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18376 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18377 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18378 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18379 case routing fails.
18380
18381
18382 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18383 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18384 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18385 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18386 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18387
18388 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18389 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18390
18391 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18392 .ilist
18393 The domain does not exist in DNS
18394 .next
18395 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18396 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18397 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18398 .next
18399 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18400 .next
18401 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18402 .next
18403 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18404 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18405 .next
18406 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18407 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18408 .next
18409 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18410 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18411 .next
18412 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18413 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18414 .endlist
18415
18416
18417
18418
18419 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18420 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18421 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18422
18423 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18424 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18425 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18426 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18427 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18428 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18429 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18430
18431
18432 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18433 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18434 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18435 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18436 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18437 required. For example,
18438 .code
18439 check_srv = smtp
18440 .endd
18441 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18442 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18443 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18444 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18445 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18446 normal way.
18447
18448 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18449 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18450 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18451 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18452 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18453 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18454
18455 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18456 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18457 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18458 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18459 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18460 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18461 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18462 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18463
18464 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18465 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18466
18467
18468
18469
18470 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18471 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18472 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18473 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18474 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18475 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18476 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18477 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18478 also being queued.
18479
18480
18481 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18482 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18483 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18484 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18485 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18486 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18487 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18488 setting:
18489 .code
18490 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18491 .endd
18492 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18493 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18494 the address record.
18495
18496
18497 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18498 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18499 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18500 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18501
18502
18503
18504
18505 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18506 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18507 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18508 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18509 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18510 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18511 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18512 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18513 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18514 &'resolv.conf'&.
18515
18516
18517
18518 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18519 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18520 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18521 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18522 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18523 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18524 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18525 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18526 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18527 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18528 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18529
18530 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18531 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18532 sense.
18533
18534 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18535 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18536 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18537 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18538 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18539 header rewriting.
18540
18541
18542 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18543 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18544 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18545 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18546 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18547 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18548 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18549 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18550
18551 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18552 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18553 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18554 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18555 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18556 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18557 without processing them independently,
18558 provided the following conditions are met:
18559
18560 .ilist
18561 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18562 &%headers_remove%&.
18563 .next
18564 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18565 the domain.
18566 .endlist
18567
18568
18569
18570
18571 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18572 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18573 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18574 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18575 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18576 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18577 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18578 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18579 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18580 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18581
18582 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18583 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18584 local wildcard.
18585
18586
18587
18588 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18589 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18590 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18591 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18592
18593
18594
18595
18596 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18597 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18598 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18599 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18600 if
18601 .code
18602 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18603 .endd
18604 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18605 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18606 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18607 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18608 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18609 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18610
18611
18612 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18613 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18614 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18615 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18616 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18617
18618 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18619 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18620 such as that implied by
18621 .code
18622 domains = @mx_any
18623 .endd
18624 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18625 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18626 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18627 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18628
18629
18630
18631
18632
18633
18634
18635
18636
18637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18639
18640 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18641 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18642 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18643 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18644 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18645 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18646 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18647 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18648 router handles the address
18649 .code
18650 root@[192.168.1.1]
18651 .endd
18652 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18653 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18654 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18655 .code
18656 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18657 .endd
18658 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18659 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18660
18661 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18662 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18663 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18664 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18665
18666 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18667 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18668 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18669 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18670
18671
18672
18673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18675
18676 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18677 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18678 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18679 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18680 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18681 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18682 must set
18683 .code
18684 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18685 .endd
18686 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18687
18688 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18689 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18690 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18691 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18692 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18693 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18694 must not be specified for it.
18695
18696 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18697 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18698 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18699 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18700 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18701 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18702 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18703
18704
18705 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18706 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18707 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18708 delivery to the address is deferred.
18709
18710
18711 .option port iplookup integer 0
18712 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18713 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18714 call.
18715
18716
18717 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18718 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18719 protocols is to be used.
18720
18721
18722 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18723 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18724 default value is:
18725 .code
18726 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18727 .endd
18728 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18729 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18730
18731
18732 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18733 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18734 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18735 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18736 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18737 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18738 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18739 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18740
18741
18742 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18743 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18744 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18745 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18746 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18747 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18748 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18749 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18750 following could be used:
18751 .code
18752 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18753 reroute = $local_part@$1
18754 .endd
18755
18756 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18757 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18758 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18759 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18760
18761
18762
18763
18764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18765 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18766
18767 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18768 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18769 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18770 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18771 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18772 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18773 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18774 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18775 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18776 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18777
18778 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18779 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18780 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18781 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18782 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18783 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18784 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18785
18786 .vindex "&$host$&"
18787 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18788 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18789 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18790 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18791 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18792 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18793 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18794 text string.
18795
18796 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18797 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18798 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18799 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18800 below, following the list of private options.
18801
18802
18803 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18804
18805 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18806 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18807
18808 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18809 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18810
18811 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18812 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18813 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18814 of the following values:
18815 .code
18816 decline
18817 defer
18818 fail
18819 freeze
18820 ignore
18821 pass
18822 .endd
18823 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18824 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18825 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18826 &%pass_router%&),
18827 .oindex "&%more%&"
18828 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18829 router only if &%more%& is true.
18830
18831 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18832 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18833 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18834 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18835
18836 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18837 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18838 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18839
18840
18841 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18842 .cindex "randomized host list"
18843 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18844 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18845 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18846 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18847 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18848 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18849 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18850 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18851
18852 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18853 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18854 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18855 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18856 .code
18857 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18858 .endd
18859 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18860 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18861 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18862 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18863 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18864
18865
18866 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18867 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18868 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18869 example:
18870 .code
18871 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18872 .endd
18873 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18874 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18875 deferred.
18876
18877
18878 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18879 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18880 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18881 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18882
18883
18884 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18885 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18886 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18887 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18888 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18889 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18890 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18891 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18892
18893 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18894 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18895 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18896 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18897 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18898 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18899 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18900 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18901
18902
18903
18904
18905 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18906 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18907 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18908 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18909 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18910 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18911 .display
18912 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18913 .endd
18914 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18915 no options:
18916 .code
18917 route_list = \
18918 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18919 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18920 .endd
18921 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18922 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18923 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18924 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18925 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18926 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18927 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18928 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18929 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18930 in a &%route_list%&).
18931
18932 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18933 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18934 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18935 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18936
18937
18938
18939 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18940 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18941 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18942 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18943 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18944 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18945 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18946 like this:
18947 .code
18948 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18949 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18950 .endd
18951 This data can be accessed by setting
18952 .code
18953 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18954 .endd
18955 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18956 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18957 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18958 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18959 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18960
18961
18962
18963
18964 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18965 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18966 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18967 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18968 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18969 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18970 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18971
18972 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18973 variables are set during its expansion:
18974
18975 .ilist
18976 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18977 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18978 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18979 .code
18980 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18981 .endd
18982 .next
18983 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18984 .next
18985 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18986
18987 .next
18988 .vindex "&$value$&"
18989 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18990 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18991 .code
18992 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18993 .endd
18994 .endlist
18995
18996 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18997 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18998
18999
19000
19001 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19002 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19003 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19004 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19005 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19006 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19007
19008 .ilist
19009 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19010 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19011 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19012 .code
19013 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19014 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19015 .endd
19016 .next
19017 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19018 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19019 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19020 number follows. For example:
19021 .code
19022 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19023 .endd
19024 .endlist
19025
19026 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19027 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19028 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19029 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19030 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19031 transport.
19032
19033 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19034 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19035 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19036 records in the DNS. For example:
19037 .code
19038 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19039 .endd
19040 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19041 example:
19042 .code
19043 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19044 .endd
19045 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19046 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19047 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19048 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19049 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19050 happens is controlled by the
19051 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19052 &%self%& option of the router.
19053
19054 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19055 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19056 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19057 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19058 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19059 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19060 defined by MX preferences.
19061
19062 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19063 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19064 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19065
19066 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19067 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19068 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19069 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19070
19071 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19072 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19073 router.
19074
19075 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19076 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19077 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19078
19079 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19080 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19081
19082
19083
19084 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19085 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
19086 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19087 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19088 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19089 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19090 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19091
19092 .ilist
19093 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19094 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19095 .next
19096 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19097 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19098 .next
19099 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19100 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19101 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19102 .next
19103 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19104 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19105 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19106 .endlist
19107
19108 For example:
19109 .code
19110 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19111 domain2 host4:host5
19112 .endd
19113 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19114 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19115 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19116 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19117 call.
19118
19119 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19120 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19121 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19122 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19123 function called.
19124
19125
19126
19127 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19128 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19129
19130 .vindex "&$host$&"
19131 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19132 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19133
19134
19135
19136 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19137 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19138 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19139
19140 .ilist
19141 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19142 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19143 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19144 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19145 .code
19146 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19147 .endd
19148 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19149 your first router something like this:
19150 .code
19151 smart_route:
19152 driver = manualroute
19153 domains = !+local_domains
19154 transport = remote_smtp
19155 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19156 .endd
19157 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19158 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19159 they are tried in order
19160 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19161 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19162 .code
19163 smart_route:
19164 driver = manualroute
19165 transport = remote_smtp
19166 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19167 .endd
19168 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19169 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19170 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19171 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19172 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19173 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19174 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19175 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19176
19177 .next
19178 .cindex "mail hub example"
19179 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19180 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19181 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19182 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19183 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19184 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19185 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19186 lookup is easier to manage.
19187
19188 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19189 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19190 example:
19191 .code
19192 hub_route:
19193 driver = manualroute
19194 transport = remote_smtp
19195 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19196 .endd
19197 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19198 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19199 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19200 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19201 domain can be used to find the host:
19202 .code
19203 through_firewall:
19204 driver = manualroute
19205 transport = remote_smtp
19206 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19207 .endd
19208 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19209 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19210 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19211 next router.
19212
19213 .next
19214 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19215 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19216 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19217 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19218 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19219 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19220 .code
19221 save_in_file:
19222 driver = manualroute
19223 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19224 route_list = saved.domain.example
19225 .endd
19226 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19227 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19228 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19229 .code
19230 save_in_file:
19231 driver = manualroute
19232 route_list = \
19233 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19234 *.saved.domain2.example \
19235 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19236 batch_pipe
19237 .endd
19238 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19239 .vindex "&$host$&"
19240 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19241 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19242 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19243 the address if the lookup fails.
19244
19245 .next
19246 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19247 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19248 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19249 one way it can be done:
19250 .code
19251 # Transport
19252 uucp:
19253 driver = pipe
19254 user = nobody
19255 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19256 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19257 return_fail_output = true
19258
19259 # Router
19260 uucphost:
19261 transport = uucp
19262 driver = manualroute
19263 route_data = \
19264 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19265 .endd
19266 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19267 .code
19268 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19269 .endd
19270 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19271 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19272 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19273 .endlist
19274 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19275 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19276
19277
19278
19279
19280
19281
19282
19283
19284 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19285 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19286
19287 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19288 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19289 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19290 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19291 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19292 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19293 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19294 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19295 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19296 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19297 options:
19298 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19299
19300 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19301 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19302 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19303 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19304 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19305
19306
19307 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19308 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19309 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19310 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19311 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19312 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19313
19314
19315 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19316 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19317 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19318 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19319 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19320 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19321 not set, a value for the gid also.
19322
19323 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19324 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19325 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19326 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19327 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19328 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19329 gid.
19330
19331
19332 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19333 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19334 before running the command.
19335
19336
19337 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19338 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19339 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19340 timeout.
19341
19342
19343 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19344 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19345 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19346 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19347 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19348
19349 .ilist
19350 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19351 below).
19352 .next
19353 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19354 &%no_more%& is set.
19355 .next
19356 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19357 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19358 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19359 included in the SMTP response.
19360 .next
19361 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19362 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19363 included in any SMTP response.
19364 .next
19365 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19366 .next
19367 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19368 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19369 .next
19370 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19371 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19372 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19373 .endlist
19374
19375 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19376 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19377 the page):
19378 .code
19379 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19380 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19381 .endd
19382 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19383 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19384 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19385 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19386
19387 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19388 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19389 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19390 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19391 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19392
19393 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19394 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19395 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19396 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19397 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19398
19399 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19400 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19401 variable. For example, this return line
19402 .code
19403 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19404 .endd
19405 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19406 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19407 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19408 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19409
19410
19411
19412
19413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19414 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19415
19416 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19417 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19418 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19419 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19420 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19421 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19422 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19423 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19424 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19425 redirected in several different ways:
19426
19427 .ilist
19428 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19429 independently.
19430 .next
19431 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19432 .next
19433 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19434 .next
19435 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19436 .next
19437 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19438 .next
19439 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19440 .next
19441 It can be discarded.
19442 .endlist
19443
19444 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19445 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19446 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19447 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19448
19449 If success DSNs have been requested
19450 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19451 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19452 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19453
19454
19455
19456 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19457 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19458 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19459 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19460 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19461 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19462 .code
19463 system_aliases:
19464 driver = redirect
19465 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19466 .endd
19467 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19468 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19469 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19470 cause delivery to be deferred.
19471
19472 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19473 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19474 .code
19475 userforward:
19476 driver = redirect
19477 check_local_user
19478 file = $home/.forward
19479 no_verify
19480 .endd
19481 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19482 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19483 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19484 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19485 comments.
19486
19487
19488
19489 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19490 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19491 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19492 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19493
19494 .ilist
19495 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19496 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19497 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19498 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19499 .next
19500 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19501 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19502 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19503 saves some resources.
19504 .endlist
19505
19506
19507
19508
19509
19510
19511 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19512 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19513 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19514 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19515 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19516
19517 .ilist
19518 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19519 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19520 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19521 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19522 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19523 document is intended for use by end users.
19524 .next
19525 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19526 described in the next section.
19527 .endlist
19528
19529 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19530 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19531 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19532 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19533 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19534
19535
19536
19537 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19538 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19539 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19540 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19541 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19542 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19543 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19544 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19545 commas or newlines.
19546 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19547 quotes.
19548
19549 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19550 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19551 next newline character is ignored.
19552
19553 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19554 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19555 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19556 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19557 removed.
19558
19559 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19560 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19561 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19562 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19563 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19564 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19565 setting:
19566 .code
19567 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19568 .endd
19569
19570
19571 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19572 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19573 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19574 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19575 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19576 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19577 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19578 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19579 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19580 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19581 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19582
19583 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19584 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19585 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19586 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19587 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19588 .code
19589 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19590 .endd
19591 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19592 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19593 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19594 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19595 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19596 synonymously.
19597
19598 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19599 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19600 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19601 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19602 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19603
19604 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19605 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19606 contains:
19607 .code
19608 Sam.Reman: spqr
19609 .endd
19610 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19611 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19612 this forward file:
19613 .code
19614 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19615 .endd
19616 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19617 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19618 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19619 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19620 should really contain
19621 .code
19622 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19623 .endd
19624 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19625 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19626 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19627
19628
19629
19630 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19631 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19632 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19633
19634 .ilist
19635 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19636 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19637 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19638 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19639 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19640 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19641 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19642
19643 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19644 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19645 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19646 in double quotes, for example:
19647 .code
19648 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19649 .endd
19650 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19651 quote just the command. An item such as
19652 .code
19653 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19654 .endd
19655 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19656
19657 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19658 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19659 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19660 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19661 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19662 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19663 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19664 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19665 an &%accept%& router.
19666
19667 .next
19668 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19669 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19670 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19671 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19672 .code
19673 /home/world/minbari
19674 .endd
19675 is treated as a file name, but
19676 .code
19677 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19678 .endd
19679 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19680 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19681 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19682 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19683
19684 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19685 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19686
19687 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19688 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19689 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19690 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19691
19692 .next
19693 .cindex "included address list"
19694 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19695 If an item is of the form
19696 .code
19697 :include:<path name>
19698 .endd
19699 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19700 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19701 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19702 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19703 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19704 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19705 .code
19706 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19707 .endd
19708 It must be given as
19709 .code
19710 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19711 .endd
19712 .next
19713 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19714 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19715 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19716 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19717 .cindex "black hole"
19718 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19719 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19720 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19721 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19722
19723 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19724 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19725 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19726 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19727 &_/dev/null_&.
19728
19729 .next
19730 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19731 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19732 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19733 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19734 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19735 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19736 redirection items of the form
19737 .code
19738 :defer:
19739 :fail:
19740 .endd
19741 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19742 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19743 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19744 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19745 .code
19746 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19747 .endd
19748 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19749 of a
19750 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19751 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19752 default.
19753 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19754 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19755 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19756
19757 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19758 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19759 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19760 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19761 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19762 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19763 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19764 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19765 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19766 ignored.
19767
19768 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19769 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19770 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19771 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19772
19773 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19774 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19775 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19776 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19777 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19778
19779 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19780 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19781 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19782 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19783 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19784 rules still apply.
19785
19786 .next
19787 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19788 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19789 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19790 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19791 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19792 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19793 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19794 .endlist
19795
19796
19797 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19798 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19799 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19800 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19801 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19802 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19803 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19804 aliasing scheme of the type
19805 .code
19806 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19807 localpart1: pipe
19808 localpart2: pipe
19809 .endd
19810 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19811 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19812 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19813 such as
19814 .code
19815 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19816 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19817 .endd
19818 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19819 the pipes are distinct.
19820
19821
19822
19823 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19824 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19825 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19826 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19827 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19828 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19829 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19830 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19831 can be used to avoid this.
19832
19833
19834 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19835 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19836 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19837 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19838 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19839 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19840 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19841
19842
19843
19844 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19845
19846 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19847 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19848
19849
19850 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19851 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19852 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19853
19854
19855 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19856 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19857 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19858 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19859
19860
19861 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19862 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19863 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19864 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19865 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19866 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19867 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19868
19869 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19870 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19871
19872
19873 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19874 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19875 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19876 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19877 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19878
19879
19880
19881 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19882 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19883 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19884 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19885 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19886 let ordinary users do.
19887
19888
19889
19890 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19891 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19892 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19893 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19894 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19895 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19896
19897 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19898 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19899 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19900 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19901 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19902 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19903 .code
19904 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19905 .endd
19906 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19907 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19908 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19909 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19910 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19911 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19912 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19913 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19914
19915
19916 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19917 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19918 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19919 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19920 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19921 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19922 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19923 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19924
19925
19926
19927 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19928 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19929 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19930 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19931 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19932 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19933
19934
19935 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19936 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19937 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19938 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19939 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19940 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19941
19942 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19943 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19944 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19945 .code
19946 data = #Exim filter\n\
19947 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19948 .endd
19949 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19950 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19951 choice into a newline.
19952
19953
19954 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19955 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19956 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19957 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19958 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19959
19960
19961 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19962 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19963 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19964 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19965 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19966 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19967 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19968 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19969
19970 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19971 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19972 runs a check on the containing directory,
19973 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19974 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19975 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19976 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19977 not, the router declines.
19978
19979
19980 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19981 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19982 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19983 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19984 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19985 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19986 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19987
19988
19989 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19990 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19991 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19992 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19993 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19994
19995
19996 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19997 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19998 redirection list.
19999
20000
20001 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20002 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20003 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20004
20005
20006
20007
20008 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20009 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20010 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20011 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20012 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20013 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20014 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20015 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20016 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20017
20018
20019 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20020 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20021 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20022 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20023 functions.
20024
20025 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20026 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20027 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20028 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20029
20030 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20031 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20032 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20033 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20034 &_.forward_& files).
20035
20036
20037 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20038 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20039 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20040
20041
20042 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20043 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20044 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20045 of the embedded Perl support.
20046
20047
20048 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20049 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20050 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20051
20052
20053 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20054 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20055 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20056
20057
20058 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20059 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20060 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20061 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20062 &%one_time%& is set.
20063
20064
20065 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20066 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20067 to make use of &%run%& items.
20068
20069
20070 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20071 If this option is true, items of the form
20072 .code
20073 :include:<path name>
20074 .endd
20075 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20076
20077
20078 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20079 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20080 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20081 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20082 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20083
20084
20085 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20086 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20087 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20088
20089
20090 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20091 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20092 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20093 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20094 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20095
20096
20097
20098
20099 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20100 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20101 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20102 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20103 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20104 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20105 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20106
20107
20108 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20109 .cindex "EACCES"
20110 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20111 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20112 file did not exist.
20113
20114
20115 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20116 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
20117 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20118 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20119 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20120
20121 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20122 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20123 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20124 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20125 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20126 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20127 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20128 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20129
20130
20131
20132 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20133 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20134 redirection list must start with this directory.
20135
20136
20137 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20138 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20139 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20140
20141
20142 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20143 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20144 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20145 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20146 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20147 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20148 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20149 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20150 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20151 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20152 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20153 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20154 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20155 before they subscribed.
20156
20157 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20158 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20159 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20160 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20161 attempt.
20162
20163 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20164 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20165 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20166 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20167
20168 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20169 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20170 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20171
20172 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20173 &%one_time%&.
20174
20175 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20176 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20177 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20178 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20179 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20180 expansion.
20181
20182
20183 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20184 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20185 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20186 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20187 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20188 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20189 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20190 See &%check_owner%& above.
20191
20192
20193 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20194 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20195 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20196 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20197
20198
20199 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20200 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20201 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20202 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20203 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20204 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20205 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20206
20207
20208 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20209 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20210 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20211 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20212 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20213 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20214 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20215 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20216
20217 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20218 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20219 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20220 addresses.
20221
20222 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20223 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20224 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20225 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20226 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20227 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20228 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20229 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20230 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20231 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20232
20233
20234 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20235 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20236 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20237 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20238 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20239 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20240
20241
20242 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20243 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20244 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20245 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20246 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20247 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20248
20249
20250 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20251 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20252 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20253 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20254 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20255
20256
20257 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20258 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20259 :subaddress part of an address.
20260
20261 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20262 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20263 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20264 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20265
20266
20267 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20268 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20269 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20270 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20271 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20272 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20273 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20274
20275
20276
20277 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20278 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20279 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20280 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20281 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20282 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20283 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20284 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20285 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20286 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20287 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20288 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20289 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20290 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20291 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20292 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20293
20294 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20295 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20296 the following routers.
20297
20298 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20299 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20300 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20301 so it is passed to the following routers.
20302
20303 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20304 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20305 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20306 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20307
20308 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20309 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20310 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20311 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20312 .code
20313 userforward:
20314 driver = redirect
20315 allow_filter
20316 check_local_user
20317 file = $home/.forward
20318 file_transport = address_file
20319 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20320 reply_transport = address_reply
20321 no_verify
20322 skip_syntax_errors
20323 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20324 syntax_errors_text = \
20325 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20326 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20327 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20328 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20329 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20330 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20331 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20332 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20333 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20334 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20335 .endd
20336 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20337 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20338 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20339 .code
20340 real_localuser:
20341 driver = accept
20342 check_local_user
20343 local_part_prefix = real-
20344 transport = local_delivery
20345 .endd
20346 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20347 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20348 .code
20349 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20350 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20351 .endd
20352
20353
20354 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20355 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20356
20357
20358 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20359 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20360 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20361 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20362
20363
20364
20365
20366
20367
20368 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20369 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20370
20371 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20372 "Environment for local transports"
20373 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20374 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20375 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20376 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20377 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20378 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20379 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20380
20381 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20382 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20383 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20384 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20385
20386 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20387 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20388 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20389 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20390 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20391
20392
20393
20394 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20395 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20396 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20397 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20398 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20399 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20400 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20401 time.
20402
20403 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20404 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20405 .code
20406 my_transport:
20407 driver = pipe
20408 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20409 .endd
20410 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20411 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20412 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20413 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20414
20415
20416
20417
20418 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20419 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20420 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20421 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20422 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20423 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20424 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20425 group (set by the transport). For example:
20426 .code
20427 # Routers ...
20428 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20429 local_users:
20430 driver = accept
20431 check_local_user
20432 transport = group_delivery
20433
20434 # Transports ...
20435 # This transport overrides the group
20436 group_delivery:
20437 driver = appendfile
20438 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20439 group = mail
20440 .endd
20441 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20442 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20443 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20444 set.
20445
20446 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20447 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20448 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20449 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20450 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20451 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20452
20453 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20454 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20455 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20456 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20457 original gid is also used.
20458
20459 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20460 following that is set is used:
20461
20462 .ilist
20463 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20464 .next
20465 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20466 .next
20467 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20468 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20469 .next
20470 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20471 .next
20472 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20473 the uid is the creator's uid;
20474 .next
20475 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20476 .endlist
20477
20478 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20479 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20480 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20481 The first of the following that is set is used:
20482
20483 .ilist
20484 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20485 .next
20486 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20487 .next
20488 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20489 .next
20490 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20491 .next
20492 The Exim uid.
20493 .endlist
20494
20495 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20496 &%never_users%& list.
20497
20498
20499
20500
20501
20502 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20503 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20504 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20505 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20506 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20507 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20508 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20509 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20510 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20511 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20512
20513 .ilist
20514 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20515 .next
20516 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20517 .next
20518 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20519 .next
20520 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20521 .endlist
20522
20523 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20524
20525 .ilist
20526 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20527 .next
20528 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20529 .endlist
20530
20531
20532 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20533 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20534 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20535
20536
20537
20538 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20539 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20540 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20541 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20542 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20543 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20544 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20545 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20546 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20547 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20548 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20549 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20550 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20551 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20552
20553
20554
20555
20556
20557
20558
20559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20561
20562 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20563 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20564 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20565 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20566 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20567
20568
20569 .option body_only transports boolean false
20570 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20571 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20572 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20573 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20574 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20575 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20576 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20577 automatically suppress them.
20578
20579
20580 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20581 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20582 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20583 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20584 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20585 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20586
20587
20588 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20589 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20590 deliveries by the transport or for any
20591 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20592 what you are doing.
20593
20594
20595 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20596 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20597 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20598 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20599 transport is run.
20600 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20601 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20602 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20603 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20604 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20605 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20606 one.
20607 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20608 transport and the router that called it.
20609
20610 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20611 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20612 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20613 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20614 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20615 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20616 safely be resent to other recipients.
20617
20618
20619 .option driver transports string unset
20620 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20621 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20622
20623
20624 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20625 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20626 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20627 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20628 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20629 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20630 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20631 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20632 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20633 resent to other recipients.
20634
20635
20636 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
20637 .cindex events
20638 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
20639 For details see &<<CHAPevents>>&.
20640 .wen
20641
20642
20643 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20644 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20645 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20646 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20647 &%user%& (see below).
20648
20649
20650 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20651 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20652 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20653 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20654 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20655 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20656 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20657 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20658 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20659 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20660 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20661
20662 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20663 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20664
20665
20666 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20667 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20668 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20669 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20670 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20671 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20672 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20673 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20674
20675
20676 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20677 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20678 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20679 This option specifies a list of header names,
20680 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20681 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20682 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20683 routers.
20684 Each list item is separately expanded.
20685 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20686 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20687 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20688
20689 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20690 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20691
20692 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20693 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20694 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20695
20696
20697
20698 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20699 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20700 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20701 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20702 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20703 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20704 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20705 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20706 example,
20707 .code
20708 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20709 x@y w@z
20710 .endd
20711 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20712 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20713 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20714 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20715 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20716 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20717 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20718 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20719 change envelope recipients at this time.
20720
20721
20722 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20723 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20724 .vindex "&$home$&"
20725 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20726 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20727 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20728 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20729 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20730 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20731 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20732 deferred.
20733
20734
20735 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20736 .cindex "additional groups"
20737 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20738 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20739 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20740 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20741 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20742
20743
20744 .new
20745 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20746 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20747 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
20748 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20749 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20750 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20751 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20752 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20753
20754 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20755 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20756 incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20757 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20758 Obviously there is scope for
20759 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20760 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20761
20762 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20763 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20764 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20765 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20766 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20767 .wen
20768
20769
20770 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20771 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20772 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20773 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20774 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20775 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20776 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20777 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20778 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20779 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20780 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20781 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20782 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20783 delivered.
20784
20785
20786
20787 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20788 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20789 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20790 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20791 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20792 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20793 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20794 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20795 that contains
20796 .code
20797 local_part_prefix = *-
20798 .endd
20799 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20800 is delivered with
20801 .code
20802 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20803 .endd
20804 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20805 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20806 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20807 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20808 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20809
20810
20811 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20812 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20813 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20814 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20815 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20816 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20817 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20818 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20819 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20820
20821 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20822 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20823 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20824 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20825
20826 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20827 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20828 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20829
20830
20831 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20832 .cindex "envelope sender"
20833 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20834 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20835 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20836 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20837 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20838 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20839 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20840 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20841 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20842
20843 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20844 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20845
20846 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20847 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20848 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20849 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20850 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20851 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20852 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20853
20854 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20855 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20856 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20857 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20858 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20859
20860
20861
20862 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20863 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20864 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20865 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20866 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20867 have easy access to it.
20868
20869 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20870 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20871 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20872 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20873 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20874 recipients.
20875
20876
20877 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20878 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20879
20880
20881 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20882 .cindex "shadow transport"
20883 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20884 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20885 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20886
20887 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20888 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20889 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20890 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20891 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20892 cause a log line to be written.
20893
20894 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20895 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20896 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20897 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20898 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20899 of the form
20900 .code
20901 ST=<shadow transport name>
20902 .endd
20903 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20904 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20905 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20906 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20907 headers that some sites insist on.
20908
20909
20910 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20911 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20912 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20913 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20914 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20915 individual users or via a system filter.
20916 .new
20917 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20918 .wen
20919
20920 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20921 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20922 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20923 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20924 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20925
20926 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20927 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20928 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20929 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20930 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20931 &(pipe)& transports.
20932
20933 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20934 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20935 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20936 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20937 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20938
20939 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20940 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20941 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20942 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20943
20944 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20945 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20946 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20947 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20948 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20949 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20950
20951 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20952 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20953 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20954 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20955 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20956 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20957 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20958 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20959
20960 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20961 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20962 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20963 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20964 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20965 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20966 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20967 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20968 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20969 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20970
20971 .vindex "&$host$&"
20972 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20973 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20974 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20975 which the message is being sent. For example:
20976 .code
20977 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20978 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20979 .endd
20980
20981 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20982 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20983 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20984 .ilist
20985 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20986 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20987 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20988 example:
20989 .code
20990 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20991 .endd
20992 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20993 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20994 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20995 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20996 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20997 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20998 .next
20999 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21000 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21001 arguments. Consider this example:
21002 .code
21003 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21004 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21005 .endd
21006 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21007 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21008 .code
21009 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21010 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21011 .endd
21012 .endlist
21013
21014 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21015 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21016 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21017 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21018 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21019 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21020 bounced from a transport filter.
21021
21022 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21023 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21024 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21025
21026
21027 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21028 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21029 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21030 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21031 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21032 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21033 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21034 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21035 becomes a temporary error.
21036
21037
21038 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21039 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21040 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21041 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21042 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21043 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21044 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21045 option is not set.
21046
21047 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21048 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21049 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21050
21051 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21052 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21053 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21054 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21055 retry data.
21056 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21057 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21058 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21059
21060
21061
21062
21063
21064
21065 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21067
21068 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21069 "Address batching"
21070 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21071 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21072 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21073 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21074 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21075 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21076 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21077
21078 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21079 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21080 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21081 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21082 local transport, for example:
21083
21084 .ilist
21085 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21086 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21087 recipients saves space.
21088 .next
21089 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21090 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21091 .next
21092 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21093 to a scanner program or
21094 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21095 acceptable.
21096 .endlist
21097
21098 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21099 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21100 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21101
21102 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21103 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21104 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21105 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21106 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21107 to certain conditions:
21108
21109 .ilist
21110 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21111 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21112 batching is possible.
21113 .next
21114 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21115 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21116 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21117 .next
21118 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21119 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21120 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21121 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21122 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21123 from taking place.
21124 .next
21125 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21126 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21127 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21128 be the same.
21129 .endlist
21130
21131 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21132 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21133 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21134 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21135 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21136 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21137 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21138 .code
21139 check_string = "."
21140 escape_string = ".."
21141 .endd
21142 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21143 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21144 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21145
21146 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21147 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21148 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21149 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21150 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21151 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21152
21153 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21154 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21155 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21156 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21157 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21158 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21159 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21160 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21161 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21162
21163
21164
21165
21166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21168
21169 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21170 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21171 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21172 .cindex "directory creation"
21173 .cindex "creating directories"
21174 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21175 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21176 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21177 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21178 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21179 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21180 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21181 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21182 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21183 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21184
21185 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21186 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21187 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21188 included.
21189
21190 .cindex "quota" "system"
21191 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21192 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21193 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21194
21195 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21196 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21197 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21198 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21199
21200 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21201 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21202 private options.
21203
21204 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21205 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21206 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21207 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21208 option).
21209
21210
21211
21212 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21213 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21214 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21215 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21216 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21217
21218 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21219 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21220 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21221 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21222 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21223 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21224 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21225 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21226 operation. There are two cases:
21227
21228 .ilist
21229 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21230 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21231 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21232 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21233 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21234 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21235 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21236 .next
21237 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21238 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21239 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21240 .endlist
21241
21242
21243 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21244 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21245 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21246 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21247 form:
21248 .code
21249 save folder23
21250 .endd
21251 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21252 .code
21253 require "fileinto";
21254 fileinto "folder23";
21255 .endd
21256 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21257 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21258 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21259 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21260 way of handling this requirement:
21261 .code
21262 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21263 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21264 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21265 {$address_file} \
21266 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21267 }} \
21268 }
21269 .endd
21270 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21271 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21272 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21273
21274 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21275 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21276 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21277 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21278 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21279 path to the transport.
21280
21281 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21282 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21283
21284
21285
21286
21287 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21288 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21289
21290
21291
21292 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21293 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21294 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21295 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21296 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21297 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21298 delivery is deferred.
21299
21300
21301 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21302 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21303 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21304 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21305 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21306 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21307 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21308 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21309
21310
21311 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21312 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21313 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21314 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21315 file.
21316
21317
21318 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21319 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21320
21321
21322 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21323 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21324 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21325 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21326 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21327
21328
21329 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21330 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21331 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21332 process is running.
21333
21334
21335 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21336 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21337 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21338 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21339 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21340 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21341 contains is significant.
21342
21343 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21344 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21345 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21346 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21347 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21348
21349 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21350 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21351 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21352 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21353 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21354 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21355 .code
21356 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21357 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21358 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21359 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21360 .endd
21361 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21362 .cindex "directory creation"
21363 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21364 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21365 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21366
21367 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21368 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21369 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21370 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21371 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21372
21373
21374
21375 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21376 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21377 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21378 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21379 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21380 beneath.
21381
21382 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21383 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21384 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21385 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21386 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21387 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21388 &%file_must_exist%&.
21389
21390
21391 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21392 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21393 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21394 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21395
21396 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21397 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21398 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21399 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21400 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21401
21402
21403 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21404 .cindex "base62"
21405 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21406 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21407 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21408 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21409 .code
21410 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21411 .endd
21412 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21413 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21414 option.
21415
21416
21417 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21418 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21419 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21420
21421
21422 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21423 See &%check_string%& above.
21424
21425
21426 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21427 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21428 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21429 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21430 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21431 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21432 &%file%&.
21433
21434 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21435 .cindex "locking files"
21436 .cindex "lock files"
21437 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21438 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21439
21440 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21441 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21442 examples:
21443 .code
21444 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21445 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21446 file = $home/inbox
21447 .endd
21448 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21449 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21450 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21451 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21452 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21453 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21454
21455
21456
21457 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21458 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21459 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21460 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21461 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21462 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21463 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21464 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21465 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21466 this added to it:
21467 .code
21468 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21469 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21470 .endd
21471 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21472 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21473 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21474 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21475 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21476 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21477 delivery is deferred.
21478
21479
21480 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21481 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21482 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21483 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21484
21485
21486 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21487 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21488 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21489 .cindex "locking files"
21490 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21491 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21492 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21493 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21494 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21495 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21496 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21497 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21498
21499 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21500 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21501 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21502 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21503
21504 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21505 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21506 retries is
21507 .code
21508 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21509 .endd
21510 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21511 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21512 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21513
21514 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21515 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21516 .code
21517 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21518 .endd
21519
21520 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21521 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21522 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21523 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21524
21525
21526 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21527 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21528 for details of locking.
21529
21530
21531 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21532 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21533 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21534
21535
21536 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21537 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21538 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21539
21540
21541 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21542 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21543 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21544 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21545 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21546
21547
21548 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21549 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21550 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21551 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21552 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21553 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21554 external source that maintains the data.
21555
21556
21557 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21558 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21559 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21560 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21561 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21562 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21563 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21564 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21565
21566
21567
21568 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21569 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21570 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21571 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21572 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21573 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21574 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21575 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21576 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21577 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21578
21579
21580 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21581 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21582 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21583 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21584 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21585 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21586 calculation. The default value is:
21587 .code
21588 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21589 .endd
21590 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21591 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21592 &_Trash_&
21593 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21594 .code
21595 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21596 .endd
21597 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21598 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21599 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21600 directly into that directory.
21601
21602
21603 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21604 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21605 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21606
21607
21608 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21609 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21610 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21611
21612
21613 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21614 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21615 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21616 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21617 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21618 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21619 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21620 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21621
21622 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21623 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21624 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21625 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21626 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21627 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21628 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21629 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21630 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21631 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21632
21633
21634 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21635 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21636 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21637 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21638 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21639 below for further details.
21640
21641
21642 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21643 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21644 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21645
21646
21647 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21648 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21649 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21650
21651
21652 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21653 .cindex "locking files"
21654 .cindex "file" "locking"
21655 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21656 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21657 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21658 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21659 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21660 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21661 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21662
21663 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21664 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21665 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21666 combination:
21667 .code
21668 mbx_format = true
21669 message_prefix =
21670 message_suffix =
21671 .endd
21672 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21673 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21674 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21675 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21676 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21677 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21678 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21679 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21680
21681 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21682 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21683 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21684 append messages to it.
21685
21686
21687 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21688 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21689 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21690 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21691 in which case it is:
21692 .code
21693 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21694 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21695 .endd
21696 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21697 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21698
21699 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21700 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21701 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21702 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21703 setting
21704 .code
21705 message_suffix =
21706 .endd
21707 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21708 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21709
21710 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21711 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21712 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21713 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21714 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21715 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21716 value, and this option is ignored.
21717
21718
21719 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21720 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21721 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21722 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21723 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21724
21725
21726 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21727 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21728 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21729 on users about incoming mail.
21730
21731
21732 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21733 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21734 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21735 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21736 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21737 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21738 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21739 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21740 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21741
21742 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21743 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21744 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21745
21746 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21747 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21748 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21749 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21750 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21751 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21752
21753 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21754 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21755 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21756 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21757 be handled.
21758
21759 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21760
21761 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21762 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21763 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21764 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21765 system quota failures.
21766
21767 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21768 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21769 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21770 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21771 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21772 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21773 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21774 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21775 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21776 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21777
21778
21779 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21780 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21781 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21782 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21783 delivery directory.
21784
21785
21786 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21787 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21788 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21789 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21790 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21791 &"no quota"&.
21792
21793
21794 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21795 See &%quota%& above.
21796
21797
21798 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21799 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21800 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21801 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21802 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21803 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21804 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21805
21806 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21807 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21808 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21809 the file length to the file name. For example:
21810 .code
21811 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21812 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21813 .endd
21814 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21815 number of lines in the message.
21816
21817 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21818 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21819 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21820
21821 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21822
21823
21824 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21825 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21826 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21827 .code
21828 quota_warn_message = "\
21829 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21830 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21831 This message is automatically created \
21832 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21833 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21834 a warning threshold that is\n\
21835 set by the system administrator.\n"
21836 .endd
21837
21838
21839 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21840 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21841 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21842 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21843 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21844 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21845 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21846 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21847 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21848 sign. For example:
21849 .code
21850 quota = 10M
21851 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21852 .endd
21853 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21854 percent sign is ignored.
21855
21856 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21857 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21858 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21859 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21860 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21861 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21862 .code
21863 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21864 .endd
21865 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21866 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21867 option.
21868
21869 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21870 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21871 percentage.
21872
21873
21874 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21875 .cindex "envelope sender"
21876 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21877 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21878 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21879 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21880 for details of batch SMTP.
21881
21882
21883 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21884 .cindex "carriage return"
21885 .cindex "linefeed"
21886 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21887 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21888 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21889 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21890
21891 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21892 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21893 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21894 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21895 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21896 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21897
21898
21899 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21900 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21901 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21902 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21903 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21904 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21905
21906
21907 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21908 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21909 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21910 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21911 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21912
21913 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21914 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21915 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21916 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21917
21918 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21919 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21920 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21921 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21922 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21923 error.
21924
21925 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21926 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21927
21928
21929 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21930 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21931 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21932 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21933 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21934 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21935 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21936
21937 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21938 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21939 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21940 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21941 file corruption.
21942
21943 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21944 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21945 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21946
21947
21948 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21949 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21950 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21951 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21952 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21953 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21954 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21955 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21956 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21957
21958 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21959 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21960 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21961 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21962
21963
21964
21965
21966 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21967 .cindex "appending to a file"
21968 .cindex "file" "appending"
21969 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21970
21971 .ilist
21972 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21973 return is given.
21974
21975 .next
21976 .cindex "directory creation"
21977 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21978 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21979 &%directory_mode%& option.
21980
21981 .next
21982 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21983 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21984 transport.
21985
21986 .next
21987 .cindex "file" "locking"
21988 .cindex "locking files"
21989 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21990 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21991 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21992
21993 .olist
21994 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21995 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21996 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21997 .next
21998 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21999 .next
22000 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22001 Unlink the hitching post name.
22002 .next
22003 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22004 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22005 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22006 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22007 .next
22008 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22009 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22010 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22011 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22012 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22013 it before trying again.
22014 .endlist olist
22015
22016 .next
22017 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22018 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22019 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22020
22021 .next
22022 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22023 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22024 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22025 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22026 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22027 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22028 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22029 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22030 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22031 checked.
22032
22033 .next
22034 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22035 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22036 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22037 delivery is deferred.
22038
22039 .next
22040 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22041 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22042 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22043 permissions.
22044
22045 .next
22046 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22047 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22048 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22049
22050 .next
22051 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22052 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22053 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22054
22055 .next
22056 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22057 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22058 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22059 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22060 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22061 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22062 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22063 that prevents link following.
22064
22065 .next
22066 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22067 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22068 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22069 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22070 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22071
22072 .next
22073 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22074
22075 .next
22076 .cindex "file" "locking"
22077 .cindex "locking files"
22078 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22079 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22080 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22081 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22082 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22083 .code
22084 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22085 .endd
22086 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22087 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22088 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22089
22090 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22091 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22092 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22093
22094 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22095 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22096 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22097 delivery is deferred.
22098
22099 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22100 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22101 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22102 immediately. It retries up to
22103 .code
22104 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22105 .endd
22106 times (rounded up).
22107 .endlist
22108
22109 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22110 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22111
22112
22113 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22114 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22115 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22116 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22117 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22118 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22119 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22120 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22121 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22122 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22123
22124 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22125 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22126 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22127 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22128 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22129 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22130 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22131
22132 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22133 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22134 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22135 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22136
22137
22138 .cindex "maildir format"
22139 .cindex "mailstore format"
22140 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22141 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22142 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22143 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22144 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22145
22146 .cindex "directory creation"
22147 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22148 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22149 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22150 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22151 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22152 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22153 deferred.
22154
22155
22156
22157 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22158 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22159 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22160 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22161 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22162 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22163 &_new_& subdirectory.
22164
22165 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22166 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22167 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22168 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22169 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22170 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22171 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22172
22173 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22174 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22175 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22176 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22177 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22178 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22179 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22180 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22181
22182 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22183 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22184 folders. Consider this example:
22185 .code
22186 maildir_format = true
22187 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22188 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22189 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22190 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22191 .endd
22192 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22193 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22194 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22195 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22196 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22197 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22198
22199 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22200 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22201 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22202 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22203 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22204
22205 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22206 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22207 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22208
22209 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22210 .cindex "maildir++"
22211 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22212 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22213 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22214 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22215 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22216 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22217 amount of space used.
22218
22219 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22220 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22221 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22222 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22223 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22224 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22225
22226
22227
22228
22229 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22230 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22231 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22232 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22233 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22234 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22235
22236
22237 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22238 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22239 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22240 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22241 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22242 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22243 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22244 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22245 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22246 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22247 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22248 backwards compatibility).
22249
22250 For one common implementation, you might set:
22251 .code
22252 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22253 .endd
22254 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22255
22256 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22257 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22258 &[stat()]& each message file.
22259
22260
22261 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22262 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22263 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22264 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22265 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22266 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22267 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22268 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22269 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22270
22271 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22272 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22273 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22274 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22275 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22276 need to know the quota.
22277
22278 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22279 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22280
22281 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22282 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22283 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22284 details.
22285
22286
22287 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22288 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22289 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22290 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22291 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22292 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22293 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22294 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22295
22296 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22297 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22298 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22299 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22300 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22301 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22302
22303 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22304 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22305 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22306 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22307 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22308 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22309
22310 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22311 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22312 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22313 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22314
22315
22316 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22317 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22318 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22319 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22320 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22321 .code
22322 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22323 .endd
22324 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22325 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22326 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22327 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22328 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22329
22330
22331
22332
22333
22334
22335 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22336 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22337
22338 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22339 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22340 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22341 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22342 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22343 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22344 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22345 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22346
22347 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22348 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22349 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22350 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22351 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22352
22353
22354 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22355 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22356 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22357 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22358 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22359
22360 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22361 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22362 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22363 transport is run as a consequence of a
22364 &%mail%&
22365 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22366 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22367 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22368 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22369 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22370 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22371
22372 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22373 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22374 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22375 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22376
22377 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22378 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22379 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22380 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22381 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22382 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22383 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22384
22385 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22386 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22387 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22388 the transport defers.
22389 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22390 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22391
22392 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22393 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22394 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22395 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22396
22397 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22398 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22399 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22400 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22401 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22402 problems. They are just discarded.
22403
22404
22405
22406 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22407 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22408
22409 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22410 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22411 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22412
22413
22414 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22415 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22416 when the message is specified by the transport.
22417
22418
22419 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22420 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22421 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22422 string comes first.
22423
22424
22425 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22426 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22427 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22428
22429
22430 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22431 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22432 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22433
22434
22435 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22436 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22437 specified by the transport.
22438
22439
22440 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22441 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22442 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22443 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22444
22445
22446 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22447 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22448 the message is specified by the transport.
22449
22450
22451 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22452 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22453 used.
22454
22455
22456 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22457 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22458 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22459 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22460 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22461
22462
22463
22464 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22465 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22466 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22467 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22468
22469 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22470 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22471 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22472 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22473 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22474 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22475 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22476 infinity.
22477
22478 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22479 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22480 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22481 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22482 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22483
22484 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22485 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22486 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22487 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22488 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22489 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22490
22491
22492 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22493 See &%once%& above.
22494
22495
22496 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22497 See &%once%& above.
22498 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22499
22500
22501 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22502 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22503 specified by the transport.
22504
22505
22506 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22507 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22508 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22509 configuration option.
22510
22511
22512 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22513 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22514 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22515 automatic responses. For example:
22516 .code
22517 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22518 .endd
22519 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22520 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22521 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22522 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22523 small.
22524
22525
22526
22527 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22528 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22529 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22530 the text comes first.
22531
22532
22533 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22534 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22535 when the message is specified by the transport.
22536 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22537 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22538
22539
22540
22541
22542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22543 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22544
22545 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22546 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22547 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22548 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22549 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22550 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22551 specified command
22552 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22553 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22554 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22555 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22556 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22557 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22558 .code
22559 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22560 .endd
22561 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22562 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22563 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22564 as follows:
22565
22566 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22567 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22568
22569
22570 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22571 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22572 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22573 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22574 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22575
22576
22577 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22578 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22579 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22580 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22581 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22582 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22583 LMTP protocol.
22584
22585 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22586 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22587 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22588 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22589 in its response to the LHLO command.
22590
22591 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22592 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22593 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22594 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22595
22596
22597 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22598 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22599 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22600 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22601 LMTP transport:
22602 .code
22603 lmtp:
22604 driver = lmtp
22605 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22606 batch_max = 20
22607 user = exim
22608 .endd
22609 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22610 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22611
22612
22613
22614 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22616
22617 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22618 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22619 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22620 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22621 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22622 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22623 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22624 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22625 following ways:
22626
22627 .ilist
22628 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22629 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22630 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22631 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22632 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22633 .next
22634 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22635 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22636 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22637 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22638 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22639 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22640 that are routed to the transport.
22641 .next
22642 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22643 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22644 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22645 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22646 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22647 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22648 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22649 .endlist
22650
22651
22652 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22653 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22654 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22655
22656 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22657 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22658 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22659 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22660 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22661 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22662 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22663
22664
22665 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22666 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22667 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22668 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22669 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22670 .new
22671 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22672 of "1" to enforce serialization.
22673 .wen
22674
22675
22676
22677
22678 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22679 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22680 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22681 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22682 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22683 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22684 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22685 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22686 &"local delivery failed"&.
22687
22688 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22689 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22690 will be sent as normal.
22691
22692 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22693 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22694 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22695 apply in this case.
22696
22697 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22698 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22699 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22700 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22701
22702 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22703 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22704 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22705 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22706 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22707 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22708 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22709 &%temp_errors%&.
22710
22711
22712
22713 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22714 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22715 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22716 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22717 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22718 run.
22719
22720 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22721 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22722 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22723 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22724
22725 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22726 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22727 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22728 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22729 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22730 .code
22731 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22732 .endd
22733 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22734 arguments. You have to write
22735 .code
22736 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22737 .endd
22738 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22739 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22740 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22741 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22742 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22743 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22744 example:
22745 .code
22746 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22747 .endd
22748
22749 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22750 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22751 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22752 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22753 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22754 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22755 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22756 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22757 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22758 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22759
22760 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22761 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22762 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22763 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22764 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22765 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22766 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22767 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22768
22769 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22770 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22771 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22772 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22773 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22774 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22775 control what is done with it.
22776
22777 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22778 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22779 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22780 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22781 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22782 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22783 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22784 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22785 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22786 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22787 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22788
22789
22790
22791 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22792 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22793 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22794 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22795 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22796 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22797 environment.
22798 .display
22799 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22800 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22801 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22802 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22803 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22804 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22805 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22806 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22807 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22808 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22809 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22810 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22811 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22812 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22813 &`USER `& see below
22814 .endd
22815 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22816 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22817 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22818 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22819 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22820 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22821 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22822
22823 .cindex "HOST"
22824 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22825 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22826 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22827 the router.
22828
22829 .cindex "HOME"
22830 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22831 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22832 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22833 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22834
22835
22836 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22837 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22838
22839
22840
22841 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22842 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22843 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22844 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22845 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22846 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22847 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22848 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22849 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22850 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22851 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22852 example, if
22853 .code
22854 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22855 .endd
22856 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22857 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22858 &%use_shell%& is set.
22859
22860
22861 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22862 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22863
22864
22865 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22866 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22867 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22868
22869
22870 .option check_string pipe string unset
22871 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22872 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22873 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22874 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22875 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22876 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22877 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22878 ignored.
22879
22880
22881 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22882 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22883 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22884 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22885 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22886 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22887 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22888
22889
22890 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22891 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22892 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22893 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22894 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22895 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22896 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22897
22898
22899 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22900 See &%check_string%& above.
22901
22902
22903 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22904 .cindex "exec failure"
22905 .cindex "failure of exec"
22906 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22907 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22908 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22909 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22910 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22911
22912
22913 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22914 .cindex "signal exit"
22915 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22916 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22917 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22918 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22919
22920
22921 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22922 .cindex "force command"
22923 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22924 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22925 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22926 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22927 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22928 command. For example:
22929 .code
22930 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22931 force_command
22932 .endd
22933
22934 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22935 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22936 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22937
22938
22939 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22940 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22941 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22942 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22943 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22944 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22945
22946 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22947 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22948
22949
22950 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22951 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22952 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22953 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22954 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22955 written to the main log.
22956
22957
22958 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22959 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22960 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22961 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22962 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22963 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22964 be set.
22965
22966
22967 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22968 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22969 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22970 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22971 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22972
22973
22974 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22975 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22976 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22977 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22978 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22979 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22980 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22981 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22982
22983
22984 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22985 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22986 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22987 .code
22988 message_prefix = \
22989 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22990 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22991 .endd
22992 .cindex "Cyrus"
22993 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22994 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22995 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22996 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22997 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22998 setting
22999 .code
23000 message_prefix =
23001 .endd
23002 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23003 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23004
23005
23006 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23007 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23008 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23009 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23010 .code
23011 message_suffix =
23012 .endd
23013 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23014 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23015
23016
23017 .option path pipe string "see below"
23018 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23019 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
23020 .code
23021 /bin:/usr/bin
23022 .endd
23023 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23024 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23025 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23026
23027
23028 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23029 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23030 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23031 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23032 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23033 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23034 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23035 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23036 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23037
23038
23039 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23040 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23041 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23042 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23043 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23044 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23045 accept the message is used.
23046
23047
23048 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23049 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23050 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23051 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23052 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23053 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23054
23055
23056 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23057 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23058 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23059 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23060 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23061 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23062 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23063
23064
23065
23066 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23067 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23068 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23069 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23070 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23071 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23072 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23073 of them may be set.
23074
23075
23076
23077 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23078 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23079 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23080 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23081 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23082 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23083 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23084 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23085 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23086 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23087 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23088 and 73, respectively.
23089
23090
23091 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23092 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23093 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23094 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23095 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23096 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23097 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23098
23099 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23100 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23101 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23102 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23103 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23104 delivery to be deferred.
23105
23106 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23107 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23108
23109
23110 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23111 .cindex "envelope sender"
23112 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23113 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23114 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23115 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23116 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23117
23118 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23119 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23120 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23121 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23122 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23123 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23124 class database.
23125
23126
23127 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23128 .cindex "carriage return"
23129 .cindex "linefeed"
23130 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23131 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23132 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23133 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23134
23135 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23136 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23137 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23138 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23139 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23140
23141
23142 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23143 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23144 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23145 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23146 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23147 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23148 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23149 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23150 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23151 its &%-c%& option.
23152
23153
23154
23155 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23156 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23157 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23158 .cindex "external local delivery"
23159 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23160 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23161 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23162 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23163 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23164 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23165 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23166 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23167 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23168 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23169 .code
23170 # transport
23171 procmail_pipe:
23172 driver = pipe
23173 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23174 return_path_add
23175 delivery_date_add
23176 envelope_to_add
23177 check_string = "From "
23178 escape_string = ">From "
23179 umask = 077
23180 user = $local_part
23181 group = mail
23182
23183 # router
23184 procmail:
23185 driver = accept
23186 check_local_user
23187 transport = procmail_pipe
23188 .endd
23189 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23190 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23191 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23192 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23193 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23194 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23195
23196 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23197 .code
23198 IFS=" "
23199 .endd
23200 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23201 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23202
23203 .cindex "Cyrus"
23204 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23205 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23206 .code
23207 # transport
23208 local_delivery_cyrus:
23209 driver = pipe
23210 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23211 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23212 user = cyrus
23213 group = mail
23214 return_output
23215 log_output
23216 message_prefix =
23217 message_suffix =
23218
23219 # router
23220 local_user_cyrus:
23221 driver = accept
23222 check_local_user
23223 local_part_suffix = .*
23224 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23225 .endd
23226 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23227 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23228 sender.
23229 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23230 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23231
23232
23233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23235
23236 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23237 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23238 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23239 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23240 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23241 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23242 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23243 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23244
23245
23246 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23247 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23248 two ways:
23249
23250 .ilist
23251 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23252 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23253 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23254 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23255 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23256 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23257 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23258 .next
23259 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23260 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23261 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23262 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23263 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23264 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23265 process.
23266 .endlist
23267
23268
23269 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23270 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23271 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23272
23273
23274
23275 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23276 .vindex "&$host$&"
23277 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23278 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23279 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23280 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23281 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23282 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23283 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23284 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23285
23286
23287 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23288 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23289 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23290 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23291 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23292 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23293 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23294 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23295 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23296 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23297 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23298 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23299 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23300 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23301
23302 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23303 and will be removed in a future release.
23304
23305
23306 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23307 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23308 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23309
23310
23311 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23312 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23313 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23314 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23315 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23316 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23317 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23318 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23319
23320 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23321 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23322 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23323 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23324 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23325 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23326 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23327 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23328 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23329
23330
23331 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23332 .cindex "Cyrus"
23333 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23334 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23335 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23336 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23337 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23338 ignored.
23339
23340 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23341 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23342 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23343 particular connection.
23344
23345 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23346 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23347 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23348 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23349
23350 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23351 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23352 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23353 .code
23354 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23355 .endd
23356 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23357 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23358
23359 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23360 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23361 value.
23362
23363
23364 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23365 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23366 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23367 authenticated as a client.
23368
23369
23370 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23371 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23372 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23373 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23374
23375
23376 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23377 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23378 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23379 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23380 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23381 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23382 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23383
23384
23385 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23386 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23387 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23388 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23389 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23390 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23391 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23392 option.
23393
23394
23395 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23396 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23397 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23398 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23399
23400
23401 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23402 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23403 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23404 cutoff times.
23405
23406 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23407 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23408 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23409 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23410 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23411 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23412
23413 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23414 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23415 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23416 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23417 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23418 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23419 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23420 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23421 to them.
23422
23423
23424 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23425 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23426 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23427 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23428 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23429
23430
23431 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23432 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23433 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23434 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23435 details.
23436
23437
23438 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23439 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23440 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23441 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23442 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23443 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23444 the dnssec request bit set.
23445 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23446
23447
23448
23449 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23450 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23451 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23452 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23453 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23454 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23455 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23456 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23457 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23458
23459
23460
23461 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23462 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23463 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23464 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23465 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23466 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23467 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23468
23469 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23470 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23471 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23472 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23473 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23474
23475
23476 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23477 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23478 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23479 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23480 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23481 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23482 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23483 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23484
23485 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23486 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23487 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23488 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23489 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23490 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23491
23492 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23493 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23494 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23495 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23496 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23497
23498 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23499 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23500 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23501 copy of the message is sent.
23502
23503 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23504 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23505 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23506 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23507 fails"& facility.
23508
23509
23510 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23511 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23512 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23513 zero.
23514
23515 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23516 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23517 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23518 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23519 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23520 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23521
23522 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23523 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23524 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23525 implementations of TLS.
23526
23527 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23528 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23529 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23530 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23531 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23532 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23533 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23534 option is:
23535 .code
23536 $primary_hostname
23537 .endd
23538 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23539 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23540 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23541 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23542 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23543 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23544 interface address, you could use this:
23545 .code
23546 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23547 {$primary_hostname}}
23548 .endd
23549 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23550 callouts.
23551
23552 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23553 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23554 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23555 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23556 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23557 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23558
23559 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23560 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23561 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23562 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23563
23564 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23565 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23566 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23567 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23568 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23569 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23570 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23571
23572 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23573 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23574 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23575 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23576 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23577 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23578 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23579 address are used.
23580
23581 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23582 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23583
23584
23585 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23586 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23587 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23588 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23589 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23590 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23591 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23592 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23593 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23594 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23595
23596
23597 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23598 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23599 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23600 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23601
23602
23603 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23604 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23605 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23606 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23607
23608 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23609 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23610 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23611 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23612 to any host that matches this list.
23613
23614
23615 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23616 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23617 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23618 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23619 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23620 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23621 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23622 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23623
23624
23625 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23626 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23627 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23628 why it exists.
23629
23630
23631
23632 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23633 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23634 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23635 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23636 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23637 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23638 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23639 explanation of when this might be needed.
23640
23641
23642 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23643 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23644 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23645 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23646 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23647
23648
23649 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23650 .cindex "randomized host list"
23651 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23652 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23653 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23654 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23655 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23656 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23657 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23658 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23659
23660 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23661 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23662 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23663 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23664 .code
23665 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23666 .endd
23667 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23668 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23669 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23670
23671 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23672 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23673 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23674 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23675 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23676 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23677 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23678 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23679 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23680
23681
23682 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23683 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23684 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23685 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23686 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23687
23688 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23689 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23690 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23691 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23692 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23693
23694 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23695 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23696 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23697 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23698 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23699 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23700
23701 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23702 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23703 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23704 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23705 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23706 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23707 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23708
23709 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23710 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23711 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23712 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23713 for multi-recipient messages.
23714 The option can usually be left as default.
23715
23716 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23717 .cindex "bind IP address"
23718 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23719 .vindex "&$host$&"
23720 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23721 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23722 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23723 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23724 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23725 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23726 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23727 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23728 unknown.
23729
23730 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23731 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23732 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23733 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23734 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23735 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23736 .code
23737 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23738 .endd
23739 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23740 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23741 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23742 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23743
23744
23745 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23746 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23747 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23748 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23749 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23750 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23751 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23752 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23753 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23754 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23755 unreachable hosts.
23756
23757
23758 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23759 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23760 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23761 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23762 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23763
23764 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23765 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23766 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23767 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23768 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23769 permits this.
23770
23771
23772 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23773 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23774 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23775 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23776 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23777 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23778 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23779 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23780
23781 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23782 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23783 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23784
23785 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23786 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23787 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23788 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23789 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23790 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23791 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23792 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23793
23794 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23795 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23796 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23797 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23798 is deferred.
23799
23800
23801
23802 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23803 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23804 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23805 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23806 .vindex "&$port$&"
23807 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23808 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23809 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23810 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23811 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23812
23813 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23814 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23815 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23816 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23817
23818
23819 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23820 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23821 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23822 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23823 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23824 addresses is not affected.
23825
23826 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23827 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23828 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23829 Exim to use only the host name.
23830 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23831
23832
23833 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23834 .cindex "serializing connections"
23835 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23836 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23837 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23838 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23839 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23840 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23841 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23842
23843 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23844 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23845 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23846 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23847 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23848 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23849
23850 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23851 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23852 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23853 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23854 are used for ETRN serialization.
23855
23856 .new
23857 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23858 .wen
23859
23860
23861 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23862 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23863 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23864 .cindex "size" "of message"
23865 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23866 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23867 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23868 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23869 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23870 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23871 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23872 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23873
23874 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23875 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23876
23877
23878 .new
23879 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
23880 .cindex proxy SOCKS
23881 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
23882 transport. For details see &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
23883 .wen
23884
23885
23886 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23887 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23888 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23889 .vindex "&$host$&"
23890 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23891 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23892 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23893 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23894 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23895 details of TLS.
23896
23897 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23898 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23899 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23900 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23901 client.
23902
23903
23904 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23905 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23906 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23907 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23908 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23909
23910
23911 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23912 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23913 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23914 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23915 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23916 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23917 will fail.
23918
23919 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23920
23921
23922 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23923 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23924 .vindex "&$host$&"
23925 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23926 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23927 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23928 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23929 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23930 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23931 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23932 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23933
23934
23935 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23936 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23937 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23938 .vindex "&$host$&"
23939 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23940 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23941 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23942 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23943 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23944 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23945 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23946 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23947 ciphers is a preference order.
23948
23949
23950
23951 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23952 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23953 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23954 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23955 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23956 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23957 certificate and private key for the session.
23958
23959 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23960
23961 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23962 TLS extensions.
23963
23964
23965
23966
23967 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23968 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23969 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23970 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23971 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23972 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23973 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23974 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23975 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23976 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23977 in clear.
23978
23979
23980 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23981 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23982 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23983 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23984 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23985 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23986 Note that unless the host is in this list
23987 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23988 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23989 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23990 certificate verification succeeds.
23991
23992
23993 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23994 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23995 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23996 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23997 while verifying the server certificate,
23998 checks will be included on the host name
23999 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24000 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24001 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24002
24003 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24004
24005
24006 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24007 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24008 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24009 .vindex "&$host$&"
24010 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24011 The value of this option must be either the
24012 word "system"
24013 or the absolute path to
24014 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24015 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24016
24017 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24018 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24019 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24020 must be specified.
24021
24022 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24023 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24024
24025 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24026 explicitly
24027 either by file or directory
24028 are added to those given by the system default location.
24029
24030 The values of &$host$& and
24031 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24032 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24033
24034 For back-compatibility,
24035 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24036 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24037 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24038
24039
24040 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24041 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24042 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24043 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
24044 certificate verification must succeed.
24045 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24046 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24047 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24048
24049
24050
24051
24052 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24053 "SECTvalhosmax"
24054 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24055 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24056 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24057 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24058 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24059
24060
24061 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24062 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24063 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24064 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24065 retrying.
24066
24067 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24068 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24069 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24070
24071 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24072 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24073 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24074 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24075 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24076
24077 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24078 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24079 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24080 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24081 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24082 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24083 see below for an exception).
24084
24085 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24086 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24087 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24088 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24089 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24090
24091 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24092 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24093 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24094 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24095 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24096 reached their retry times.
24097
24098 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24099 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24100 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24101 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24102 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24103 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24104 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24105 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24106 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24107 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24108 reached.
24109
24110 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24111 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24112 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24113 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24114 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24115 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24116
24117 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24118 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24119 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24120 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24121 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24122 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24123
24124
24125
24126
24127
24128 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24129 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24130
24131 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24132 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24133 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24134 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24135 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24136 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24137
24138 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24139 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24140 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24141 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24142 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24143 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24144 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24145
24146 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24147 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24148 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24149 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24150
24151
24152 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24153 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24154 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24155 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24156
24157 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24158 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24159 facility; you do not have to use it.
24160
24161 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24162 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24163 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24164 address to which it applies.
24165
24166 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24167 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24168 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24169 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24170 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24171 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24172 rules.
24173
24174 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24175 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24176 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24177 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24178
24179
24180 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24181 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24182 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24183 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24184 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24185 discouraged.
24186
24187 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24188 illustrated by these examples:
24189
24190 .ilist
24191 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24192 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24193 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24194 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24195 .next
24196 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24197 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24198 .endlist
24199
24200
24201
24202 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24203 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24204 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24205 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24206 message's processing.
24207
24208 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24209 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24210 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24211 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24212 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24213 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24214 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24215 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24216 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24217
24218 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24219 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24220 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24221 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24222 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24223 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24224 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24225 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24226 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24227 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24228
24229 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24230 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24231 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24232 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24233 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24234 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24235
24236 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24237 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24238 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24239
24240 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24241 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24242 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24243 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24244 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24245 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24246 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24247 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24248 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24249
24250 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24251 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24252 transport time.
24253
24254
24255
24256
24257 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24258 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24259 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24260 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24261 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24262 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
24263 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24264 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24265 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24266 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24267 .code
24268 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24269 .endd
24270 might produce the output
24271 .code
24272 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24273 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24274 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24275 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24276 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24277 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24278 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24279 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24280 .endd
24281 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24282 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24283 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24284 set for a particular transport.
24285
24286
24287 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24288 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24289 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24290 rules in the form
24291 .display
24292 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24293 .endd
24294 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24295 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24296 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24297 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24298
24299 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24300 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24301 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24302 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24303 ignored.
24304
24305 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24306 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24307 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24308
24309 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24310 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24311 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24312 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24313 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24314 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24315 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24316
24317 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24318 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24319 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24320 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24321 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24322 .code
24323 *@* ${lookup ...
24324 .endd
24325 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24326 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24327
24328
24329 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24330 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24331 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24332 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24333 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24334 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24335 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24336 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24337 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24338
24339 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24340 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24341 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24342
24343 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24344 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24345 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24346 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24347 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24348 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24349 of pattern they are set as follows:
24350
24351 .ilist
24352 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24353 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24354 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24355 pattern
24356 .code
24357 *queen@*.fict.example
24358 .endd
24359 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24360 .code
24361 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24362 $1 = hearts-
24363 $2 = wonderland
24364 .endd
24365 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24366 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24367
24368 .next
24369 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24370 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24371 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24372 rewriting rule of the form
24373 .display
24374 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24375 .endd
24376 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24377 .code
24378 $1 = foo
24379 $2 = bar
24380 $3 = baz.example
24381 .endd
24382 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24383 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24384 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24385 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24386 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24387 .endlist
24388
24389
24390 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24391 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24392 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24393 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24394 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24395 .code
24396 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24397 .endd
24398 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24399 &'From:'& headers.
24400
24401 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24402 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24403 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24404 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24405 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24406 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24407 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24408 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24409 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24410 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24411 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24412 entry written to the panic log.
24413
24414
24415
24416 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24417 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24418
24419 .ilist
24420 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24421 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24422 .next
24423 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24424 .next
24425 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24426 .endlist
24427
24428 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24429 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24430
24431
24432
24433 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24434 "SECID154"
24435 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24436 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24437 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24438 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24439 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24440 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24441 .display
24442 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24443 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24444 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24445 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24446 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24447 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24448 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24449 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24450 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24451 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24452 .endd
24453 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24454 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24455 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24456
24457 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24458 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24459
24460
24461 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24462 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24463 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24464 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24465 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24466 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24467 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24468 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24469 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24470
24471 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24472 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24473 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24474 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24475 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24476 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24477 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24478 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24479
24480
24481 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24482 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24483 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24484 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24485
24486 .ilist
24487 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24488 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24489 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24490 .next
24491 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24492 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24493 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24494 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24495 .next
24496 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24497 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24498 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24499 .next
24500 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24501 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24502 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24503 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24504 .code
24505 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24506 .endd
24507 into
24508 .code
24509 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24510 .endd
24511 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24512 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24513 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24514 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24515 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24516 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24517 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24518 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24519 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
24520
24521 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24522 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24523 .endlist
24524
24525
24526 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24527 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24528 .code
24529 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24530 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24531 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24532 .endd
24533 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24534 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24535 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24536 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24537 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24538 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24539 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24540 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24541
24542 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24543 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24544 .code
24545 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24546 .endd
24547 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24548 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24549
24550 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24551 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24552 messages that originate outside the local host:
24553 .code
24554 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24555 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24556 .endd
24557 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24558 space.
24559
24560 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24561 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24562 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24563 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24564 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24565 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24566 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24567 components. For example, the rule
24568 .code
24569 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24570 .endd
24571 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24572 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24573 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24574 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24575 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24576 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24577 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24578 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24579
24580
24581
24582
24583
24584 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24586
24587 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24588 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24589 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24590 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24591 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24592 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24593 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24594 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24595 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24596 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24597 address, domain and error.
24598
24599 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24600 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24601 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24602 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24603 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24604 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24605 log selector is set, the message
24606 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24607 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24608 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24609 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24610
24611 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24612 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24613 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24614 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24615 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24616 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24617 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24618 domain are maintained independently.
24619
24620 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24621 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24622 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24623 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24624 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24625 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24626 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24627 the local address is reached.
24628
24629 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24630 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24631 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24632 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24633 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24634
24635 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24636 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24637 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24638 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24639 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24640 messages that it should now be retaining.
24641
24642
24643
24644 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24645 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24646 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24647 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24648 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24649 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24650 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24651 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24652 message's sender, respectively.
24653
24654
24655 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24656 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24657 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24658 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24659 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24660 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24661 example,
24662 .code
24663 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24664 .endd
24665 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24666 whereas
24667 .code
24668 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24669 .endd
24670 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24671 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24672 part.
24673
24674 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24675 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24676 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24677 expressions work in address lists.
24678 .display
24679 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24680 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24681 .endd
24682
24683
24684 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24685 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24686 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24687 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24688 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24689 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24690 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24691 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24692 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24693
24694 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24695 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24696 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24697 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24698 local transports).
24699
24700 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24701 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24702 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24703 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24704 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24705 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24706 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24707 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24708 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24709 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24710 commands.
24711
24712
24713
24714 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24715 "SECID160"
24716 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24717 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24718 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24719 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24720 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24721 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24722 .code
24723 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24724 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24725 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24726 .endd
24727 and the retry rules are
24728 .code
24729 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24730 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24731 .endd
24732 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24733 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24734 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24735 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24736 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24737 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24738
24739 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24740 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24741 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24742 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24743
24744 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24745 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24746 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24747 .code
24748 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24749 .endd
24750 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24751 textual form of the IP address.
24752
24753 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24754 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24755 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24756 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24757
24758 .vlist
24759 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24760 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24761 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24762
24763 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24764 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24765 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24766
24767 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24768 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24769
24770 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24771 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24772 .endlist
24773
24774 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24775 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24776 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24777 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24778 retry rule of this form:
24779 .code
24780 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24781 .endd
24782 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24783 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24784
24785 .vlist
24786 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24787 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24788 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24789 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24790
24791 .vitem &%lookup%&
24792 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24793 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24794 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24795 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24796 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24797
24798 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24799 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24800
24801 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24802 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24803
24804 .vitem &%refused%&
24805 A connection was refused.
24806
24807 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24808 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24809
24810 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24811 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24812
24813 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24814 A connection attempt timed out.
24815
24816 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24817 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24818 obtained from an MX record.
24819
24820 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24821 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24822 obtained from an MX record.
24823
24824 .vitem &%timeout%&
24825 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24826
24827 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24828 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24829 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24830 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24831
24832 .vitem &%quota%&
24833 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24834 transport.
24835
24836 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24837 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24838 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24839 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24840 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24841 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24842 for four days.
24843 .endlist
24844
24845 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24846 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24847 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24848 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24849 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24850 heuristic rules:
24851
24852 .ilist
24853 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24854 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24855 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24856 .next
24857 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24858 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24859 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24860 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24861 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24862 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24863 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24864 .next
24865 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24866 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24867 .endlist
24868
24869 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24870 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24871 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24872 error).
24873
24874
24875
24876 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24877 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24878 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24879 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24880 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24881 form:
24882 .display
24883 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24884 .endd
24885 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24886 .code
24887 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24888 .endd
24889 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24890 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24891 For example:
24892 .code
24893 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24894 .endd
24895 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24896 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24897 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24898 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24899 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24900
24901 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24902 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24903 .code
24904 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24905 .endd
24906 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24907 list is never matched.
24908
24909
24910
24911
24912
24913 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24914 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24915 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24916 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24917 .display
24918 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24919 .endd
24920 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24921 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24922 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24923 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24924 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24925
24926 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24927 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24928 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24929 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24930 The available algorithms are:
24931
24932 .ilist
24933 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24934 the interval.
24935 .next
24936 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24937 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24938 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24939 .next
24940 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24941 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24942 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24943 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24944 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24945 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24946 queue processing times.
24947 .endlist
24948
24949 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24950 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24951 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24952 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24953 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24954 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24955 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24956 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24957 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24958 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24959 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24960 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24961
24962 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24963 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24964 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24965 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24966 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24967 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24968 time.
24969
24970 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24971 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24972 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24973 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24974 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24975 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24976 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24977 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24978 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24979 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24980 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24981 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24982
24983 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24984 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24985 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24986 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24987 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24988 deliveries that have been deferred.
24989
24990
24991 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24992 Here are some example retry rules:
24993 .code
24994 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24995 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24996 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24997 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24998 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24999 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25000 .endd
25001 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25002 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25003 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25004 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25005 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25006 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25007 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25008 days.
25009
25010 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25011 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25012 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25013 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25014 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25015
25016 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25017 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25018 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25019 were not obtained from an MX record.
25020
25021 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25022 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25023 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25024 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25025 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25026
25027
25028
25029 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25030 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25031 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25032 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25033 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25034 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25035 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25036 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25037 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25038 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25039 failing for the first time.
25040
25041 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25042 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25043 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25044 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25045
25046 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25047 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25048 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25049
25050
25051
25052
25053 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25054 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25055 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25056 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25057 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25058 default retry rule:
25059 .code
25060 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25061 .endd
25062 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25063 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25064 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25065
25066 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25067 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25068 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25069 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25070 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25071
25072 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25073 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25074 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25075
25076 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25077 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25078 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25079 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25080 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25081 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25082 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25083 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25084
25085 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25086 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25087 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25088 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25089 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25090 notice.
25091
25092 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25093 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25094 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25095 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25096 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25097 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25098 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25099 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25100 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25101 true.
25102
25103 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25104 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25105 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25106 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25107 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25108 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25109 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25110 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25111 reached.
25112
25113 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25114 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25115 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25116 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25117 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25118 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25119 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25120 time out the address.
25121
25122 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25123 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25124 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25125 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25126 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25127 considered immediately.
25128 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25129 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25130
25131
25132
25133
25134
25135
25136 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25137 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25138
25139 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25140 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25141 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25142 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25143 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25144 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25145 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25146 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25147 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25148 other.
25149
25150 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25151 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25152
25153 .ilist
25154 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25155 the client's EHLO command.
25156 .next
25157 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25158 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25159 .next
25160 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25161 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25162 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25163 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25164 with the AUTH command.
25165 .next
25166 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25167 .next
25168 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25169 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25170 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25171 connection.
25172 .next
25173 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25174 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25175 unauthenticated connection.
25176 .endlist
25177
25178 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25179 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25180 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25181 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25182 .display
25183 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25184 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25185 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25186 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25187 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25188 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25189 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25190 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25191 &`250-PIPELINING`&
25192 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25193 &`250 HELP`&
25194 .endd
25195 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25196 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25197 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25198 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25199 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25200 included by setting
25201 .code
25202 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25203 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25204 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25205 AUTH_GSASL=yes
25206 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25207 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25208 AUTH_SPA=yes
25209 AUTH_TLS=yes
25210 .endd
25211 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25212 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25213 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25214 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25215 work via a socket interface.
25216 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25217 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25218 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25219 supporting setting a server keytab.
25220 The sixth can be configured to support
25221 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25222 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25223 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25224 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25225 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25226
25227 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25228 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25229 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25230 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25231 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25232 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25233 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25234
25235 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25236 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25237 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25238 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25239 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25240 both sets of options, is required. For example:
25241 .code
25242 cram:
25243 driver = cram_md5
25244 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25245 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25246 client_name = ph10
25247 client_secret = secret2
25248 .endd
25249 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25250 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25251
25252 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25253 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25254 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25255 in Exim.
25256
25257 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25258 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25259 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25260 authenticating data.
25261
25262 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25263 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25264 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25265 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25266 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25267 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25268 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25269 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25270 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25271 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25272 choose to honour.
25273
25274 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25275 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25276 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25277 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25278
25279
25280
25281 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25282 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25283 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25284
25285 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25286 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25287 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25288 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25289 encrypted by a setting such as:
25290 .code
25291 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25292 .endd
25293
25294
25295 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25296 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25297 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25298 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25299
25300
25301 .option driver authenticators string unset
25302 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25303 authenticators is to be used.
25304
25305
25306 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25307 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25308 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25309 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25310 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25311 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25312
25313
25314 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25315 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25316 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25317 mechanism is not advertised.
25318 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25319 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25320 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25321
25322
25323 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25324 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25325 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25326 for details.
25327
25328 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25329 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25330
25331 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25332 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25333 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25334 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25335 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25336 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25337 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25338 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25339 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25340 the error text.
25341
25342
25343 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25344 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25345 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25346 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25347 out the values of variables.
25348 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25349 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25350
25351
25352 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25353 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25354 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25355 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25356 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25357 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25358 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25359 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25360 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25361
25362
25363 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25364 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25365 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25366 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25367 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25368 remembered for later use.
25369 How it is used is described in the following section.
25370
25371
25372
25373
25374
25375 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25376 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25377 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25378 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25379 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25380 message:
25381
25382 .ilist
25383 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25384 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25385 .next
25386 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25387 .next
25388 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25389 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25390 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25391 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25392 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25393 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25394 given for the MAIL command.
25395 .next
25396 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25397 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25398 authenticated.
25399 .next
25400 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25401 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25402 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25403 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25404 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25405 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25406 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25407 message.
25408 .endlist
25409
25410
25411 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25412 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25413 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25414 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25415
25416 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25417 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25418 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25419 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25420 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25421 ACL is run.
25422
25423
25424
25425 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25426 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25427 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25428 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25429 conditions:
25430
25431 .ilist
25432 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25433 .next
25434 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25435 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25436 .endlist
25437
25438 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25439 the mechanisms are advertised.
25440
25441 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25442 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25443 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25444 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25445 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25446 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25447 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25448 .code
25449 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25450 .endd
25451 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25452
25453 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25454 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25455 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25456 such as:
25457 .code
25458 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25459 .endd
25460 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25461 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25462 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25463
25464 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25465 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25466 command. This is the case if
25467
25468 .ilist
25469 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25470 .next
25471 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25472 .next
25473 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25474 server authenticators.
25475 .endlist
25476
25477
25478 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25479 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25480 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25481
25482 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25483 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25484 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25485 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25486 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25487 rejected with a 504 error.
25488
25489 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25490 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25491 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25492 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25493 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25494 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25495 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25496 no successful authentication.
25497
25498
25499
25500
25501 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25502 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25503 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25504 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25505 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25506 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25507 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25508 script:
25509 .code
25510 use MIME::Base64;
25511 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25512 .endd
25513 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25514 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25515 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25516 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25517 command line to run this script on such data might be
25518 .code
25519 encode '\0user\0password'
25520 .endd
25521 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25522 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25523 whose code value is zero.
25524
25525 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25526 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25527 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25528 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25529
25530 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25531 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25532 example, a command such as
25533 .code
25534 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25535 .endd
25536 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25537
25538 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25539 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25540 .code
25541 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25542 .endd
25543 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25544 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25545 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25546 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25547
25548
25549
25550 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25551 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25552 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25553 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25554 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25555 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25556
25557 .ilist
25558 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25559 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25560 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25561 of the authenticator.
25562 .next
25563 .vindex "&$host$&"
25564 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25565 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25566 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25567 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25568 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25569 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25570 delivery to be deferred.
25571 .next
25572 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25573 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25574 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25575 usual way.
25576 .next
25577 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25578 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25579 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25580 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25581 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25582 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25583 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25584 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25585 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25586 .endlist
25587
25588 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25589 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25590 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25591 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25592 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25593 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25594 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25595 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25596 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25597 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25598 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25599 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25600 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25601
25602
25603
25604
25605
25606
25607 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25609
25610 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25611 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25612 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25613 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25614 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25615 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25616 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25617 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25618 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25619 connections as you do for login accounts.
25620
25621 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25622 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25623 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25624
25625 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25626 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25627 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25628
25629 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25630 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25631 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25632 given.
25633
25634 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25635 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25636 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25637 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25638 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25639 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25640 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25641
25642 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25643 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25644 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25645 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25646 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25647 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25648 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25649
25650 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25651 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25652 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25653 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25654
25655 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25656 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25657 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25658
25659 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25660 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25661 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25662 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25663 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25664 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25665 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25666 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25667 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25668 string as the error text
25669
25670 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25671 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25672 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25673
25674
25675
25676 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25677 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25678 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25679 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25680 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25681 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25682 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25683 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25684
25685 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25686 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25687 configured as follows:
25688 .code
25689 fixed_plain:
25690 driver = plaintext
25691 public_name = PLAIN
25692 server_prompts = :
25693 server_condition = \
25694 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25695 server_set_id = $auth2
25696 .endd
25697 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25698 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25699 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25700 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25701
25702 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25703 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25704 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25705 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25706 .code
25707 250-AUTH PLAIN
25708 .endd
25709 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25710 .code
25711 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25712 .endd
25713 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25714 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25715 .code
25716 AUTH PLAIN
25717 .endd
25718 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25719 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25720
25721 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25722 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25723 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25724 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25725 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25726
25727 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25728 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25729 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25730
25731 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25732 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25733 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25734 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25735 This is an incorrect example:
25736 .code
25737 server_condition = \
25738 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25739 .endd
25740 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25741 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25742 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25743 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25744 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25745 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25746 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25747 .code
25748 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25749 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25750 .endd
25751 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25752 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25753 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25754 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25755 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25756
25757
25758 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25759 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25760 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25761 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25762 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25763 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25764 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25765 .code
25766 fixed_login:
25767 driver = plaintext
25768 public_name = LOGIN
25769 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25770 server_condition = \
25771 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25772 server_set_id = $auth1
25773 .endd
25774 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25775 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25776 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25777 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25778
25779 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25780 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25781 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25782 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25783 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25784 .code
25785 login:
25786 driver = plaintext
25787 public_name = LOGIN
25788 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25789 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25790 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25791 ldapauth{\
25792 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25793 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25794 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25795 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25796 .endd
25797 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25798 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25799 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25800 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25801 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25802 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25803 uninterpreted string.
25804
25805
25806 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25807 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25808 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25809 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25810 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25811 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25812
25813
25814
25815
25816 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25817 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25818 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25819
25820 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25821 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25822 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25823 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25824 usual.
25825
25826 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25827 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25828 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25829 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25830 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25831 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25832 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25833 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25834 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25835 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25836 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25837 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25838
25839 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25840 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25841
25842 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25843 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25844 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25845 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25846 the string.
25847
25848 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25849 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25850 .code
25851 fixed_plain:
25852 driver = plaintext
25853 public_name = PLAIN
25854 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25855 .endd
25856 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25857 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25858 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25859 .code
25860 fixed_login:
25861 driver = plaintext
25862 public_name = LOGIN
25863 client_send = : username : mysecret
25864 .endd
25865 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25866 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25867 prompts.
25868 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25869 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25870
25871
25872
25873
25874 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25876
25877 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25878 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25879 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25880 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25881 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25882 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25883 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25884 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25885 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25886 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25887 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25888 available in plain text at either end.
25889
25890
25891 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25892 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25893 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25894 authenticator as a server:
25895
25896 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25897 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25898 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25899 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25900 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25901 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25902 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25903 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25904 returned to the client.
25905
25906 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25907 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25908 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25909 numeric variables for other things.
25910
25911 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25912 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25913 user name, authentication fails.
25914 .code
25915 fixed_cram:
25916 driver = cram_md5
25917 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25918 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25919 server_set_id = $auth1
25920 .endd
25921 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25922 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25923 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25924 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25925 .code
25926 lookup_cram:
25927 driver = cram_md5
25928 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25929 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25930 {$value}fail}
25931 server_set_id = $auth1
25932 .endd
25933 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25934 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25935
25936 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25937 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25938 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25939 realm, with:
25940 .code
25941 cyrusless_crammd5:
25942 driver = cram_md5
25943 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25944 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25945 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25946 server_set_id = $auth1
25947 .endd
25948
25949 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25950 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25951 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25952
25953
25954
25955 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25956 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25957 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25958
25959
25960 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25961 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25962 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25963
25964
25965 .vindex "&$host$&"
25966 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25967 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25968 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25969 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25970 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25971 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25972 send the message to the current server.
25973
25974 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25975 strings, is:
25976 .code
25977 fixed_cram:
25978 driver = cram_md5
25979 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25980 client_name = ph10
25981 client_secret = secret
25982 .endd
25983 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25984 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25985
25986
25987
25988 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25990
25991 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25992 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25993 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25994 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25995 .cindex "Kerberos"
25996 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25997 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25998
25999 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26000 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26001 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26002 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26003 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26004
26005 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26006 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26007 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26008 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26009
26010 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26011 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26012 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26013 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26014 depending on the driver you are using.
26015
26016 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26017 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26018 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26019 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26020 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26021 implementation.
26022
26023 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26024 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26025 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26026 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26027 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26028 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26029 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26030 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26031
26032
26033 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26034 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26035 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26036 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26037 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26038 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26039 things.
26040
26041
26042 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26043 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26044 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26045 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26046
26047
26048 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26049 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26050 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26051 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26052 example:
26053 .code
26054 sasl:
26055 driver = cyrus_sasl
26056 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26057 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26058 server_set_id = $auth1
26059 .endd
26060
26061 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26062 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26063
26064
26065 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26066 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26067
26068
26069 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26070 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26071 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26072 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26073 .code
26074 sasl_cram_md5:
26075 driver = cyrus_sasl
26076 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26077 server_set_id = $auth1
26078
26079 sasl_plain:
26080 driver = cyrus_sasl
26081 public_name = PLAIN
26082 server_set_id = $auth2
26083 .endd
26084 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26085 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26086 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26087 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26088 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26089
26090
26091
26092
26093 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26094 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26095 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26096 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26097 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26098 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26099 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26100 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26101 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26102 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26103 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26104
26105 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26106
26107 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26108 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26109 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26110 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26111 .code
26112 dovecot_plain:
26113 driver = dovecot
26114 public_name = PLAIN
26115 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26116 server_set_id = $auth1
26117
26118 dovecot_ntlm:
26119 driver = dovecot
26120 public_name = NTLM
26121 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26122 server_set_id = $auth1
26123 .endd
26124 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26125 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26126 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26127 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26128 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26129 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26130 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26131 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26132
26133
26134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26136 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26137 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26138 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26139 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26140 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26141 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26142 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26143 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26144 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26145 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26146 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26147 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26148 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26149 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26150 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26151 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26152 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26153 without code changes in Exim.
26154
26155
26156 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26157 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26158 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26159 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26160 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26161 context.
26162
26163 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
26164 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
26165 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26166
26167 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26168 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26169 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26170
26171 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26172 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26173 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26174
26175
26176 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26177 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26178 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26179 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26180
26181
26182 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26183 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26184 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26185 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26186 example:
26187 .code
26188 sasl:
26189 driver = gsasl
26190 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26191 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26192 server_set_id = $auth1
26193 .endd
26194
26195
26196 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26197 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26198 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26199 the password itself.
26200
26201 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26202 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26203 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26204 if available, else the empty string.
26205 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26206 else the empty string.
26207
26208 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26209
26210 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26211 option to be simply "true".
26212
26213
26214 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26215 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26216 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26217
26218
26219 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26220 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26221 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26222 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26223
26224
26225 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26226 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26227 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26228 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26229
26230
26231 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26232 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26233 Some mechanisms will use this data.
26234
26235
26236 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26237 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26238 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26239 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26240
26241 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26242 meanings for these variables:
26243
26244 .ilist
26245 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26246 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26247 .next
26248 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26249 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26250 .next
26251 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
26252 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26253 .endlist
26254
26255 On a per-mechanism basis:
26256
26257 .ilist
26258 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26259 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26260 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26261 .next
26262 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26263 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26264 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26265 .next
26266 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26267 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26268 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26269 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26270 .endlist
26271
26272 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26273 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26274 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26275
26276
26277 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26278 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26279 .code
26280 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26281 driver = gsasl
26282 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26283 server_realm = imap.example.org
26284 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26285 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26286 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26287 server_condition = yes
26288 .endd
26289
26290
26291 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26292 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26293
26294 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26295 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26296 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26297 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26298 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26299 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26300 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26301 reliably.
26302
26303 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26304 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26305 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26306 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26307
26308 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26309 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26310 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26311 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26312
26313 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26314 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26315 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26316 from the keytab.
26317
26318
26319 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26320 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26321 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26322 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26323
26324 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26325 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26326 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26327 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26328
26329 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26330 .ilist
26331 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26332 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26333 .next
26334 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26335 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26336 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26337 GSS Display Name.
26338 .endlist
26339
26340
26341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26343
26344 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26345 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26346 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26347 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26348 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26349 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26350 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26351 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26352 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26353 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26354 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26355 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26356 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26357 follows:
26358
26359 .ilist
26360 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26361 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26362 .next
26363 The server sends back a challenge.
26364 .next
26365 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26366 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26367 .endlist
26368
26369 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26370
26371
26372
26373 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26374 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26375 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26376
26377 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26378 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26379 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26380 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26381 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26382 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26383 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26384 for other things. For example:
26385 .code
26386 spa:
26387 driver = spa
26388 public_name = NTLM
26389 server_password = \
26390 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26391 .endd
26392 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26393 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26394
26395
26396
26397
26398
26399 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26400 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26401 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26402
26403
26404
26405 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26406 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26407
26408
26409 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26410 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26411
26412
26413 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26414 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26415 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26416 &'msn.com'&:
26417 .code
26418 msn:
26419 driver = spa
26420 public_name = MSN
26421 client_username = msn/msn_username
26422 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26423 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26424 .endd
26425 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26426 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26427
26428
26429
26430
26431
26432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26434
26435 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26436 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26437 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26438 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26439 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26440 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26441 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26442 authentication based on client certificates.
26443
26444 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26445 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26446 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26447 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26448 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26449 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26450
26451 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26452 for which it must have been requested via the
26453 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26454 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26455
26456 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26457 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26458 and can authenticate the connection.
26459 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26460
26461 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26462
26463
26464 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26465 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26466
26467 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26468 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26469 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26470 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26471 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26472 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26473
26474 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26475 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26476 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26477
26478 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26479
26480
26481 Example:
26482 .code
26483 tls:
26484 driver = tls
26485 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26486 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26487 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26488 {!= {0} \
26489 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26490 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26491 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26492 } } } }
26493 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26494 .endd
26495 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
26496 of your configured trust-anchors
26497 which usually means the full set of public CAs)
26498 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
26499 Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
26500 whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
26501
26502 . An alternative might use
26503 . .code
26504 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
26505 . .endd
26506 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
26507 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
26508 . This would help for per-device use.
26509 .
26510 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
26511 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
26512
26513 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26514 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26515
26516
26517 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26518 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26519 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26520
26521
26522
26523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26525
26526 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26527 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26528 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26529 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26530 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26531 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26532 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26533 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26534 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26535 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26536 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26537 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26538 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26539 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26540 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26541 certificates are used.
26542
26543 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26544 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26545 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26546 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26547 between them is encrypted.
26548
26549 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26550 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26551 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26552 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26553 encryption state.
26554
26555 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26556 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26557 in order to get TLS to work.
26558
26559
26560
26561 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26562 "SECID284"
26563 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26564 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26565 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26566 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26567 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26568 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26569 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26570 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26571 allocated for this purpose.
26572
26573 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26574 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26575 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26576 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26577 .code
26578 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26579 .endd
26580 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26581 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26582 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26583 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26584 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26585 defined elsewhere.
26586
26587 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26588 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26589
26590
26591
26592
26593
26594
26595 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26596 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26597 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26598 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26599 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26600 .code
26601 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26602 .endd
26603 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26604 .code
26605 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26606 .endd
26607 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26608 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26609
26610 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26611
26612 .ilist
26613 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26614 cannot be the path of a directory
26615 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26616 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26617 .next
26618 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26619 .next
26620 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26621 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26622 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26623 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26624 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26625 .next
26626 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26627 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26628 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26629 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26630 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26631 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26632 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26633 option).
26634 .next
26635 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26636 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26637 .next
26638 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26639 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26640 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26641 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26642 .next
26643 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26644 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26645 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26646 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26647 .endlist
26648
26649
26650 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26651 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26652 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26653 but not the chosen filename.
26654 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26655 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26656
26657 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26658 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26659 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26660 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26661 of bits requested.
26662 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26663 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26664 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26665 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26666 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26667 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26668 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26669
26670 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26671 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26672 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26673 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26674 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26675
26676 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26677 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26678 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26679 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26680 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26681 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26682
26683 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26684 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26685 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26686
26687 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26688 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26689 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26690 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26691 .code
26692 # ls
26693 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26694 # rm -f new-params
26695 # touch new-params
26696 # chown exim:exim new-params
26697 # chmod 0600 new-params
26698 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26699 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26700 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26701 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26702 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26703 # chmod 0400 new-params
26704 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26705 .endd
26706 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26707 stalling is removed.
26708
26709 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26710 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26711 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26712 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26713 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26714 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26715 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26716 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26717 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26718 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26719 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26720
26721 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26722 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26723 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26724 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26725
26726 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26727 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26728 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26729 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26730 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26731
26732
26733 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26734 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26735 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26736 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26737 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26738 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26739 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26740 directly to this function call.
26741 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26742 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26743 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26744 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26745
26746 .ilist
26747 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26748 .next
26749 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26750 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26751 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26752 SSL v3 algorithms.
26753 .next
26754 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26755 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26756 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26757 algorithms.
26758 .endlist
26759
26760 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26761 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26762 .ilist
26763 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26764 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26765 stated.
26766 .next
26767 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26768 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26769 .next
26770 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26771 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26772 .endlist
26773
26774 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26775 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26776 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26777 not be moved to the end of the list.
26778 .endlist
26779
26780 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26781 string:
26782 .code
26783 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26784 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26785 .endd
26786
26787 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26788 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26789 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26790 choice of clients used:
26791 .code
26792 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26793 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26794 {DEFAULT}\
26795 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26796 .endd
26797
26798
26799
26800 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26801 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26802 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26803 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26804 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26805 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26806 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26807 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26808 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26809 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26810 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26811 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26812
26813 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26814 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26815
26816 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26817 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26818 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26819 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26820 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26821 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26822
26823 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26824 "Priority strings". This is online as
26825 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26826 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26827 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26828 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26829 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26830
26831 For example:
26832 .code
26833 # Disable older versions of protocols
26834 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26835 .endd
26836
26837 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26838 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26839 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26840
26841 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26842 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26843 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26844 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26845 used:
26846 .code
26847 # GnuTLS variant
26848 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26849 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26850 {SECURE128}}
26851 .endd
26852
26853
26854 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26855 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26856 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26857 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26858 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26859 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26860 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26861 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26862
26863 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26864 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26865 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26866 with the error
26867 .code
26868 554 Security failure
26869 .endd
26870 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26871 rejected with a 554 error code.
26872
26873 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26874 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26875 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26876 without some further configuration at the server end.
26877
26878 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26879 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26880 .code
26881 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26882 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26883 .endd
26884 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26885 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26886 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26887 that goes with it. These files need to be
26888 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26889 always be given as full path names.
26890 The key must not be password-protected.
26891 They can be the same file if both the
26892 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26893 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26894 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26895 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26896 the server's certificate.
26897
26898 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26899 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26900 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26901
26902 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26903 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26904 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26905 transport.
26906
26907 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26908 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26909 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26910 .code
26911 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26912 .endd
26913 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26914 with the parameters contained in the file.
26915 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26916 available:
26917 .code
26918 tls_dhparam = none
26919 .endd
26920 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26921 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26922 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26923 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26924
26925 See the command
26926 .code
26927 openssl dhparam
26928 .endd
26929 for a way of generating file data.
26930
26931 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26932 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26933 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26934 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26935 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26936
26937 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26938 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26939 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26940 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26941 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26942 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26943 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26944 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26945 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26946
26947 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26948 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26949 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26950 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26951 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26952 documentation for more details.
26953
26954 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26955 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26956
26957
26958 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26959 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26960 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26961 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26962 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26963 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26964 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26965 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26966 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26967 expected certificates.
26968 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26969 an explicit file or,
26970 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26971 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26972
26973 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26974 directory is used
26975 (OpenSSL only),
26976 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26977 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26978 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26979 .code
26980 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26981 .endd
26982 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26983
26984 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26985 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26986 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26987 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26988 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26989 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26990 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26991 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26992 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26993 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26994
26995 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26996 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26997 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26998 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26999
27000 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27001 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27002 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27003 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27004 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27005 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27006
27007
27008 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27009 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27010 .cindex "revocation list"
27011 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27012 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27013 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27014 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27015 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27016 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27017 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27018 CRL in PEM format.
27019 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27020 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27021
27022 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27023 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27024 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27025 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27026 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27027 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27028
27029 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27030 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27031 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27032 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27033
27034 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27035 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27036 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27037 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27038 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27039 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27040 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27041 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27042
27043 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27044 .new
27045 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27046 .wen
27047 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27048
27049 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27050 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27051 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27052 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27053 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27054
27055 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27056 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27057 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27058 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27059 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27060 next connection.
27061
27062 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27063 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27064 ignored.
27065
27066 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27067 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27068 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27069 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27070 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27071 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27072
27073 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27074 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27075
27076 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27077
27078 .code
27079 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27080 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27081 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27082
27083 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27084 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27085 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27086 .endd
27087
27088
27089
27090
27091 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27092 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27093 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27094 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27095 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27096 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27097 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27098 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27099 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27100
27101 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27102 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27103 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27104 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27105 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27106
27107 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27108 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27109 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27110 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27111 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27112 usual way.
27113
27114 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27115 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27116 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27117 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27118 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27119 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27120 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27121 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27122 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27123 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27124 unencrypted.
27125
27126 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27127 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27128 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27129 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27130
27131 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27132 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27133 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27134 a file or,
27135 depending on library version, a directory,
27136 must name a file or,
27137 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
27138 The client verifies the server's certificate
27139 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27140 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27141 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27142 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27143
27144 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27145 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27146 or need not succeed respectively.
27147
27148 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27149 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27150 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27151 value is empty.
27152 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27153 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27154 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27155 otherwise.
27156
27157 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27158 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27159 for OCSP to be relevant.
27160
27161 If
27162 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27163 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27164 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27165 alternative hosts, if any.
27166
27167 &*Note*&:
27168 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27169 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27170 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27171 client.
27172
27173 .vindex "&$host$&"
27174 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27175 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27176 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27177 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27178 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27179
27180 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27181 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27182 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27183 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27184 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27185 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27186 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27187 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27188 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27189 outgoing connection.
27190
27191
27192
27193 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27194 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27195 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27196 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27197 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27198 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27199 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27200 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27201 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27202 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27203 for this session.
27204
27205 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27206 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27207 address.
27208
27209 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27210 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27211 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27212 be of limited use in that environment.
27213
27214 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27215 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27216 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27217 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27218 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27219
27220 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27221 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27222 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27223 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27224 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27225
27226 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27227 received from a client.
27228 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27229
27230 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27231 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27232 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27233
27234 .ilist
27235 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27236 &%tls_certificate%&
27237 .next
27238 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27239 &%tls_crl%&
27240 .next
27241 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27242 &%tls_privatekey%&
27243 .next
27244 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27245 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
27246 .next
27247 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27248 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
27249 .endlist
27250
27251 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27252 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27253 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27254 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27255
27256 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27257 are re-expanded.
27258
27259 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27260 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27261 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27262 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27263
27264 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
27265 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27266 built, then you have SNI support).
27267
27268
27269
27270 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27271 "SECTmulmessam"
27272 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27273 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27274 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27275 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27276 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27277 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27278 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27279 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27280 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27281 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27282 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27283
27284 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27285 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27286 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27287 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27288 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27289 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27290 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27291 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27292 and delay other deliveries to that host.
27293
27294 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27295 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27296 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27297 information is recorded.
27298
27299 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27300 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27301 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27302
27303
27304
27305
27306 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27307 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27308 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27309 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27310 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27311 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27312 to Apache, currently at
27313 .display
27314 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27315 .endd
27316 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27317 links to further files.
27318 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27319 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27320 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27321 .display
27322 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27323 .endd
27324
27325
27326 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27327 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27328 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27329 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27330 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27331 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27332 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27333 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27334 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27335 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27336 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27337 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27338 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27339
27340 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27341 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27342 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27343 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27344
27345
27346
27347 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27348 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27349 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27350 with OpenSSL, like this:
27351 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27352 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27353 .code
27354 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27355 -days 9999 -nodes
27356 .endd
27357 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27358 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27359 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27360 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27361 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27362 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27363 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27364
27365 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27366 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27367 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27368 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27369 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27370 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27371 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27372 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27373 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27374 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27375 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27376 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27377 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27378 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27379 be a sensible resolution).
27380
27381 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27382 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27383 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27384
27385 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27386 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27387 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27388 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27389 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27390 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27391
27392 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27393 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27394 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27395 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27396 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27397 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27398
27399
27400
27401 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27402 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27403
27404 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27405 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27406 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27407 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27408 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27409 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27410 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27411 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27412 one very small ACL:
27413 .code
27414 begin acl
27415 small_acl:
27416 accept hosts = one.host.only
27417 .endd
27418 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27419 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27420
27421 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27422 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27423 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27424 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27425 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27426 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27427 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27428 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27429
27430
27431 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27432 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27433 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27434 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27435 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27436
27437
27438
27439 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27440 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27441 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27442 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27443 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27444 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27445 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27446 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27447 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27448 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27449 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27450 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27451 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27452 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27453 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27454 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27455 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27456 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27457 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27458 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27459
27460 .table2 140pt
27461 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27462 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27463 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27464 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27465 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27466 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27467 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27468 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27469 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27470 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27471 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27472 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27473 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27474 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27475 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27476 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27477 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27478 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27479 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27480 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27481 .endtable
27482
27483 For example, if you set
27484 .code
27485 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27486 .endd
27487 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27488 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27489 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27490 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27491 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27492 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27493 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27494
27495
27496 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27497 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27498 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27499 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27500 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27501 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27502 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27503 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27504 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27505 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27506 in any of these ACLs.
27507
27508 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27509 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27510 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27511 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27512 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27513 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27514 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27515 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27516 .code
27517 control = suppress_local_fixups
27518 .endd
27519 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27520 run, it is too late.
27521
27522 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27523 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27524
27525 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27526 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27527 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27528
27529
27530 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27531 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27532 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27533 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27534 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27535 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27536 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27537 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27538 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27539
27540
27541 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27542 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27543 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27544 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27545 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27546 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27547 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27548 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27549 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27550
27551 .new
27552 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
27553 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
27554 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
27555 .wen
27556
27557 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27558 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27559 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27560 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27561 an EHLO response.
27562
27563
27564 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27565 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27566 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27567 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27568 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27569 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27570 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27571 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27572 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27573 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27574
27575 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27576 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27577 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27578 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27579 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27580 associated with the DATA command.
27581
27582 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27583 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27584 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27585 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27586 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27587 your resources.
27588
27589 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27590 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27591 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27592 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27593
27594 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27595 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27596 enabled (which is the default).
27597
27598 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27599 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27600 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27601
27602 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27603
27604 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27605
27606
27607 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27608 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27609 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27610
27611 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27612
27613
27614 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27615 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27616 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27617 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27618 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27619 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27620 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27621 has been accepted.
27622
27623 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27624 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27625 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27626 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27627 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27628 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27629 for some or all recipients.
27630
27631 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27632 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27633 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27634 .new
27635 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27636 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27637 is &"yes"&.
27638 .wen
27639 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27640 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27641 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27642
27643 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27644 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27645
27646 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27647 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27648 the feature was not requested by the client.
27649
27650 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27651 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27652 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27653 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27654 does not in fact control any access.
27655 For this reason, it may only accept
27656 or warn as its final result.
27657
27658 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27659 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27660 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27661 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27662
27663 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27664 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27665
27666 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27667 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27668 response to QUIT.
27669
27670 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27671 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27672 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27673 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27674 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27675
27676
27677 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27678 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27679 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27680 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27681 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27682 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27683 situation even worse.
27684
27685 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27686 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27687 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27688 and &%warn%&.
27689
27690 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27691 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27692 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27693 connection. The possible values are:
27694 .table2
27695 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27696 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27697 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27698 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27699 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27700 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27701 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27702 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27703 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27704 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27705 .endtable
27706 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27707 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27708 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27709 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27710 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27711 used.
27712
27713
27714 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27715 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27716 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27717 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27718 .code
27719 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27720 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27721 .endd
27722 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27723 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27724 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27725 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27726 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27727
27728 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27729 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27730 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27731
27732 .ilist
27733 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27734 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27735 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27736 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27737 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27738 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27739 .code
27740 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27741 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27742 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27743 .endd
27744 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27745 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27746 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27747 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27748 .next
27749 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27750 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27751 matches the string.
27752 .next
27753 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27754 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27755 want to have something like
27756 .code
27757 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27758 .endd
27759 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27760 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27761 .endlist
27762
27763
27764
27765
27766 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27767 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27768 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27769 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27770 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27771 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27772 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27773 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27774 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27775
27776 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27777 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27778 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27779
27780
27781 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27782 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27783 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27784 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27785
27786 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27787 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27788 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27789 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27790 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27791 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27792 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27793
27794
27795 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27796 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27797 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27798
27799
27800
27801 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27802 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27803 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27804 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27805 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27806 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27807
27808 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27809 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27810 used to accept or reject anything.
27811
27812 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27813 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27814 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27815 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27816
27817 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27818 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27819 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27820 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27821 configuration file.
27822
27823
27824
27825
27826 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27827 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27828 .vindex &$domain$&
27829 .vindex &$local_part$&
27830 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27831 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27832 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27833 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27834 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27835 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27836 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27837 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27838 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27839
27840 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27841 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27842 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27843 how it is used.
27844
27845 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27846 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27847 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27848 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27849 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27850 received).
27851
27852 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27853 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27854 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27855 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27856 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27857 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27858 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27859 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27860
27861
27862
27863
27864
27865 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27866 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27867 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27868 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27869 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27870 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27871 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27872 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27873 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27874 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27875 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27876 unencrypted connections.
27877 .code
27878 acl_check_auth:
27879 accept encrypted = *
27880 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27881 {CRAM-MD5}}
27882 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27883 .endd
27884 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27885 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27886 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27887 option to do this.)
27888
27889
27890
27891 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27892 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27893 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27894 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27895 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27896 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27897 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27898
27899 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27900 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27901 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27902 example:
27903 .code
27904 deny dnslists = list1.example
27905 dnslists = list2.example
27906 .endd
27907 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27908 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27909 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27910 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27911 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27912
27913
27914 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27915 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27916
27917 .ilist
27918 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27919 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27920 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27921 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27922 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27923 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27924 check a RCPT command:
27925 .code
27926 accept domains = +local_domains
27927 endpass
27928 verify = recipient
27929 .endd
27930 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27931 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27932 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27933 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27934 &%endpass%&.
27935
27936 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27937 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27938 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27939 configuration.
27940
27941 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27942 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27943 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27944 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27945 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27946 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27947 .display
27948 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27949 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27950 .endd
27951 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27952 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27953 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27954
27955 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27956 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27957 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27958 of &%endpass%&.
27959
27960
27961 .next
27962 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27963 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27964 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27965 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27966 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27967 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27968 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27969
27970
27971 .next
27972 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27973 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27974 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27975 example,
27976 .code
27977 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27978 .endd
27979 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27980
27981
27982 .next
27983 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27984 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27985 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27986 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27987 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27988 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27989 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27990 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27991 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27992
27993 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27994 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27995 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27996
27997
27998 .next
27999 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
28000 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
28001 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
28002 .code
28003 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
28004 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
28005 .endd
28006 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
28007 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
28008
28009 .next
28010 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
28011 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
28012 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
28013 example, when checking a RCPT command,
28014 .code
28015 require message = Sender did not verify
28016 verify = sender
28017 .endd
28018 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
28019 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
28020 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
28021 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
28022
28023 .next
28024 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28025 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
28026 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
28027 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
28028 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
28029 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
28030 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
28031
28032 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
28033 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
28034 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
28035 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
28036 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28037
28038 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
28039 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
28040 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
28041 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
28042 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
28043 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
28044 onwards.
28045
28046
28047 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28048 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
28049 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
28050 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
28051 .code
28052 warn !verify = sender
28053 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
28054 .endd
28055 .endlist
28056
28057 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
28058
28059 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
28060 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
28061 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
28062 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
28063 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
28064
28065
28066
28067 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
28068 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
28069 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
28070 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
28071 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
28072 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
28073 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
28074 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
28075 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
28076 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
28077 .ilist
28078 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
28079 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
28080 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
28081 on the same SMTP connection.
28082 .next
28083 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
28084 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
28085 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
28086 .endlist
28087
28088 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
28089 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
28090 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
28091 .code
28092 accept hosts = whatever
28093 set acl_m4 = some value
28094 accept authenticated = *
28095 set acl_c_auth = yes
28096 .endd
28097 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
28098 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
28099 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
28100
28101 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
28102 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
28103 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
28104 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
28105 error is generated.
28106
28107 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
28108 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
28109
28110
28111 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
28112 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
28113 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
28114 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
28115 .code
28116 deny domains = *.dom.example
28117 !verify = recipient
28118 .endd
28119 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
28120 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
28121 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
28122 two statements are equivalent:
28123 .code
28124 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
28125 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
28126 .endd
28127 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
28128 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
28129
28130 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
28131 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
28132 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
28133 .code
28134 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28135 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
28136 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
28137 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
28138 .endd
28139 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
28140 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
28141 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
28142 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
28143 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
28144 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
28145 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
28146
28147 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
28148 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
28149 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
28150 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
28151 message is handled.
28152
28153 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
28154 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
28155 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
28156 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
28157 .code
28158 require message = Can't verify sender
28159 verify = sender
28160 message = Can't verify recipient
28161 verify = recipient
28162 message = This message cannot be used
28163 .endd
28164 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
28165 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
28166 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
28167 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
28168 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
28169 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
28170
28171 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
28172 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
28173 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
28174 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
28175 .code
28176 deny hosts = ...
28177 !senders = *@my.domain.example
28178 message = Invalid sender from client host
28179 .endd
28180 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
28181 by which time Exim has set up the message.
28182
28183
28184
28185 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
28186 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
28187 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
28188
28189 .vlist
28190 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28191 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
28192 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
28193 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
28194
28195 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28196 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28197 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28198 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28199 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28200 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28201 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28202 write rather ugly lines like this:
28203 .display
28204 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28205 .endd
28206 Instead, all you need is
28207 .display
28208 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28209 .endd
28210
28211 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28212 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28213 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28214 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28215 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28216 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28217 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28218 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28219
28220 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28221 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28222 in several different ways. For example:
28223
28224 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28225 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28226 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28227 . ==== way.
28228
28229 .ilist
28230 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28231 .code
28232 accept ...some conditions
28233 control = queue_only
28234 .endd
28235 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28236 other words, when the conditions are all true.
28237
28238 .next
28239 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28240 .code
28241 accept ...some conditions...
28242 control = queue_only
28243 ...some more conditions...
28244 .endd
28245 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28246 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28247 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28248 to be relevant.
28249
28250 .next
28251 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28252 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28253 example:
28254 .code
28255 warn ...some conditions...
28256 control = freeze
28257 accept ...
28258 .endd
28259 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28260 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28261 log entry.
28262
28263 .next
28264 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28265 &%require%& verb. For example:
28266 .code
28267 require control = no_multiline_responses
28268 .endd
28269 .endlist
28270
28271 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28272 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28273 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
28274 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28275 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28276 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28277 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28278 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28279 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28280
28281 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28282 example:
28283 .code
28284 deny ...some conditions...
28285 delay = 30s
28286 .endd
28287 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28288 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
28289 .code
28290 deny delay = 30s
28291 ...some conditions...
28292 .endd
28293 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28294 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28295 .code
28296 warn ...some conditions...
28297 delay = 2m
28298 control = freeze
28299 accept ...
28300 .endd
28301
28302 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28303 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28304 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28305 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28306 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28307 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28308 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28309
28310
28311 .vitem &*endpass*&
28312 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28313 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28314 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28315 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28316 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28317 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28318 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28319
28320
28321 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28322 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28323 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28324 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28325 .code
28326 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28327 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28328 .endd
28329 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28330 example:
28331 .display
28332 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28333 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28334 .endd
28335 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28336 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28337 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28338 message.
28339
28340 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28341 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28342 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28343 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28344 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28345 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28346 ignored.
28347
28348 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28349 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28350 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28351 error message.
28352
28353 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28354 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28355 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28356 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28357 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28358 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28359
28360 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28361 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28362 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28363 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28364 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28365 logging rejections.
28366
28367
28368 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28369 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28370 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28371 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28372 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28373 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28374 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28375 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28376 .display
28377 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28378 &` log_reject_target =`&
28379 .endd
28380 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28381 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28382 current ACL.
28383
28384
28385 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28386 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28387 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28388 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28389 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28390 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28391 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28392 ACLs. For example:
28393 .display
28394 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28395 &` control = freeze`&
28396 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28397 .endd
28398 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28399 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28400 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28401 example:
28402 .code
28403 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28404 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28405 .endd
28406
28407
28408 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28409 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28410 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28411 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28412 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28413 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28414 &%accept%& for details.)
28415
28416 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28417 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28418 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28419 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28420 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28421 .code
28422 require message = Host not recognized
28423 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28424 .endd
28425 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28426 processed.)
28427
28428 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28429 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28430 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28431 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28432 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28433 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28434 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28435 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28436 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28437 EHLO options.
28438
28439 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28440 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28441 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28442 .code
28443 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28444 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28445 .endd
28446 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28447 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28448 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28449 2&'xx'&.
28450
28451 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28452 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28453
28454 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28455 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28456 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28457 response.
28458
28459 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28460 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28461 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28462
28463 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28464 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28465 However, the original message is available in the variable
28466 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28467 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28468 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28469 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28470
28471 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28472 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28473 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28474 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28475 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28476 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28477 effect.
28478
28479
28480 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28481 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28482 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28483 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28484
28485
28486 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28487 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28488 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28489 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28490
28491
28492 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28493 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28494 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28495 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28496 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28497 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28498 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28499 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28500 when:
28501 .code
28502 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28503 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28504 .endd
28505 .endlist
28506
28507
28508
28509
28510 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28511 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28512 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28513
28514 .vlist
28515 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28516 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28517 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28518 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28519 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28520 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28521 not work without it. For example:
28522 .code
28523 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28524 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28525 .endd
28526 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28527 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28528 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28529 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28530 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28531
28532
28533 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28534 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28535 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28536 .cindex "case of local parts"
28537 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28538 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28539 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28540 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28541 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28542 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28543 is encountered.
28544
28545 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28546 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28547 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28548 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28549 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28550
28551 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28552 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28553 spam score:
28554 .code
28555 warn control = caseful_local_part
28556 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28557 $acl_m4 + \
28558 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28559 }
28560 control = caselower_local_part
28561 .endd
28562 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28563 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28564
28565
28566 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28567 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28568 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28569 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28570
28571 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28572 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28573 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28574 is used for all recipients of the message,
28575 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28576 and data is copied from one to the other.
28577
28578 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28579 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28580 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28581 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28582 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28583 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28584
28585 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28586 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28587 Note also that headers cannot be
28588 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28589 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28590
28591 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28592 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28593 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28594 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28595
28596 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28597 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28598 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28599 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28600 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28601 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28602
28603 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28604 (possibly faked)
28605 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28606
28607
28608 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28609 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28610 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28611 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28612 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28613 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28614 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28615 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28616 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28617 contexts):
28618 .code
28619 control = debug
28620 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28621 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28622 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28623 .endd
28624
28625
28626 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28627 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28628 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28629 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28630 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28631
28632
28633 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28634 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28635 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28636 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28637 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28638 strings or to numeric value.
28639 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28640 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28641 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28642
28643 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28644 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28645 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28646 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28647 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28648
28649
28650 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28651 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28652 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28653 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28654 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28655 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28656 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28657 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28658
28659 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28660 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28661 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28662 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28663 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28664 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28665 work with.
28666
28667
28668 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28669 .cindex "fake defer"
28670 .cindex "defer, fake"
28671 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28672 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28673 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28674 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28675 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28676
28677 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28678 .cindex "fake rejection"
28679 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28680 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28681 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28682 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28683 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28684 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28685 the same SMTP connection.
28686
28687 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28688 message is supplied, the following is used:
28689 .code
28690 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28691 550-kept for evaluation.
28692 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28693 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28694 .endd
28695 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28696
28697 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28698 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28699 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28700 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28701 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28702 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28703 SMTP connection.
28704
28705 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28706 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28707 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28708 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28709
28710 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28711 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28712 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28713 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28714 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28715 disables such output flushing.
28716
28717 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28718 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28719 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28720 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28721 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28722 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28723
28724 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28725 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28726 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28727 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28728 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28729 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28730 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28731 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28732 to be useful in production.
28733
28734 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28735 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28736 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28737 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28738 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28739
28740 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28741 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28742 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28743 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28744 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28745 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28746
28747 .ilist
28748 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28749 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28750 verification failed"&) is sent.
28751 .next
28752 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28753 line is output.
28754 .endlist
28755
28756 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28757 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28758
28759 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28760 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28761 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28762 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28763 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28764 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28765 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28766
28767 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28768 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28769 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28770 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28771 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28772 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28773 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28774 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28775 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28776 same SMTP connection.
28777
28778 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28779 .cindex "message" "submission"
28780 .cindex "submission mode"
28781 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28782 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28783 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28784 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28785 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28786 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28787 late (the message has already been created).
28788
28789 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28790 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28791 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28792 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28793 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28794
28795 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28796 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28797 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28798 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28799 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28800
28801 .ilist
28802 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28803 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28804 .next
28805 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28806 .next
28807 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28808 .endlist ilist
28809
28810 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28811 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28812 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28813 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28814 data is read.
28815
28816 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28817 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28818
28819 .new
28820 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
28821 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
28822 to a-label form.
28823 For details see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
28824 .wen
28825 .endlist vlist
28826
28827
28828 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28829 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28830
28831 .ilist
28832 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28833 .next
28834 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28835 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28836 .next
28837 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28838 .next
28839 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28840 .endlist
28841
28842
28843
28844 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28845 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28846 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28847 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28848 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28849 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28850 .code
28851 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28852 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28853 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28854 .endd
28855 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28856 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28857 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28858 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28859 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28860 RCPT ACL).
28861
28862 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28863 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28864
28865 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28866 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28867 contains one or more newlines that
28868 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28869 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28870 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28871
28872 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28873 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28874 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28875 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28876 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28877 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28878 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28879 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28880 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28881 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28882 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28883
28884 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28885 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28886 of message headers
28887 until they are added to the
28888 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28889 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28890 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28891 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28892 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28893 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28894 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28895
28896 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28897
28898 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28899 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28900 .display
28901 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28902 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28903
28904 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28905 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28906 .endd
28907 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28908 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28909 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28910 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28911 honoured.
28912
28913 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28914 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28915 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28916 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28917 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28918 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28919 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28920 specifications.
28921
28922 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28923 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28924 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28925 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28926 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28927
28928 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28929 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28930 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28931 to be a header name first.) For example:
28932 .code
28933 warn add_header = \
28934 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28935 .endd
28936 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28937 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28938 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28939 up in reverse order.
28940
28941 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28942 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28943 system filter or in a router or transport.
28944
28945
28946
28947 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28948 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28949 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28950 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28951 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28952 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28953 .code
28954 warn message = Remove internal headers
28955 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28956 .endd
28957 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28958 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28959 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28960 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28961 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28962 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28963
28964 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28965 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28966
28967 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28968 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28969 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28970 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28971 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28972 .code
28973 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28974 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28975 warn message = Remove internal headers
28976 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28977 .endd
28978 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28979 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28980 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28981 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28982 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28983 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28984 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28985 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28986 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28987 would have been removed.
28988
28989 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28990 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28991 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28992 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28993 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28994 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28995 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28996 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28997 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28998
28999 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29000 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29001 .display
29002 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
29003 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
29004
29005 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29006 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
29007 .endd
29008 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
29009 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
29010 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
29011 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
29012 are honoured.
29013
29014 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29015 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
29016 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
29017
29018
29019
29020
29021 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
29022 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
29023 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
29024 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
29025 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
29026 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29027
29028 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
29029 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
29030 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
29031 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
29032 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
29033 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
29034 The conditions are as follows:
29035
29036
29037 .vlist
29038 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
29039 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
29040 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
29041 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
29042 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
29043 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
29044 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
29045 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
29046 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
29047 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
29048 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
29049 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
29050
29051 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
29052 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
29053 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
29054 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
29055 The name and values are expanded separately.
29056 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
29057 will act as argument separators.
29058
29059 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
29060 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
29061 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
29062 conditions are tested.
29063
29064 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
29065 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
29066 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
29067 for different local users or different local domains.
29068
29069 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29070 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
29071 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
29072 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
29073 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
29074 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
29075 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
29076 .code
29077 authenticated = *
29078 .endd
29079
29080 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
29081 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
29082 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
29083 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
29084 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
29085 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
29086 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
29087 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
29088 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
29089 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
29090 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
29091 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
29092 negative.
29093
29094 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
29095 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
29096 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29097 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29098 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
29099 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
29100 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
29101 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29102
29103 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
29104 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
29105 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29106 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
29107 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
29108
29109 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
29110 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
29111 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29112 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29113 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29114 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
29115 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
29116 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
29117 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
29118 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
29119
29120 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29121 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
29122 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
29123 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
29124 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
29125 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
29126 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
29127 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
29128 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
29129 &%domains%& test.
29130
29131 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
29132 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
29133
29134
29135 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
29136 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
29137 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
29138 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
29139 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
29140 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
29141 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
29142 .code
29143 encrypted = *
29144 .endd
29145
29146
29147 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
29148 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
29149 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
29150 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
29151 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
29152 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
29153 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
29154 .code
29155 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29156 .endd
29157 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
29158 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
29159 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
29160
29161 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
29162 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
29163 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
29164 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
29165 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
29166 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
29167
29168 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
29169 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
29170 .code
29171 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
29172 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
29173 .endd
29174 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
29175 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
29176 statement can then check the IP address.
29177
29178 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
29179 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
29180 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
29181 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
29182 .code
29183 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
29184 message = $host_data
29185 .endd
29186 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
29187
29188 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
29189 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
29190 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
29191 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
29192 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
29193 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
29194 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
29195 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
29196 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
29197 the next &%local_parts%& test.
29198
29199 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
29200 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
29201 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
29202 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29203 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29204 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29205 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29206
29207 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29208 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29209 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29210 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29211 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29212 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29213 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29214 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29215
29216 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29217 .cindex "rate limiting"
29218 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29219 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29220
29221 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29222 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29223 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29224 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29225 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29226 recipient address against a list of recipients.
29227
29228 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29229 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29230 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29231 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29232 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29233 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29234 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29235
29236 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29237 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29238 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29239 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29240 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29241 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29242 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29243 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29244 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29245 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29246 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29247 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29248 influence the sender checking.
29249
29250 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29251 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29252
29253 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29254 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29255 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29256 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29257 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29258 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29259 .code
29260 senders = :
29261 .endd
29262 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29263 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29264
29265 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29266 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29267 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29268 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29269 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29270 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29271
29272 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29273 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29274 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29275 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29276 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29277 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29278 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29279 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29280 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29281 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29282
29283 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29284 .cindex "CSA verification"
29285 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29286 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29287 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29288
29289 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29290 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29291 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29292 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29293 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29294 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29295 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29296 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29297 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29298 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29299
29300 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29301 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29302 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29303
29304 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29305 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29306 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29307 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29308 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29309 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29310 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29311 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29312 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29313 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29314 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29315 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29316 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29317 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29318 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29319
29320 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29321 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29322 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29323 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29324 .code
29325 deny senders = :
29326 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29327 !verify = header_sender
29328 .endd
29329
29330 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29331 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29332 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29333 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29334 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29335 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29336 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29337 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29338 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29339 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29340 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29341 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29342 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29343 appropriate.
29344
29345 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29346 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29347 .code
29348 To: @
29349 .endd
29350 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29351 common as they used to be.
29352
29353 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29354 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29355 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29356 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29357 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29358 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29359 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29360 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29361 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29362 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29363 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29364 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29365 independently of this condition.
29366
29367 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29368 option), this condition is always true.
29369
29370
29371 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29372 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29373 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29374 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29375 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29376 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29377 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29378 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29379 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29380
29381 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29382 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29383
29384
29385 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29386 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29387 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29388 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29389 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29390 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29391 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29392 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29393 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29394 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29395 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29396 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29397 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29398 value for the child address.
29399
29400 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29401 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29402 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29403 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29404 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29405 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29406 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29407 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29408 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29409 original IP address.
29410
29411 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29412 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29413
29414 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29415 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29416
29417 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29418 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29419 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29420 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29421 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29422 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29423 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29424 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29425 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29426
29427 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29428 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29429 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29430 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29431 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29432 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29433 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29434
29435 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29436 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29437 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29438
29439 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29440 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29441 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29442 verified as a sender.
29443 .endlist
29444
29445
29446
29447 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29448 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29449 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29450 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29451 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29452 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29453 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29454 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29455 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29456 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29457 .code
29458 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29459 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29460 .endd
29461 the following records are looked up:
29462 .code
29463 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29464 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29465 .endd
29466 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29467 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29468 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29469 use two separate conditions:
29470 .code
29471 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29472 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29473 .endd
29474 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29475 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29476 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29477 processed.
29478
29479 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29480 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29481 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29482 following special items in the list:
29483 .display
29484 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29485 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29486 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29487 .endd
29488 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29489 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29490 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29491 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29492 .code
29493 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29494 .endd
29495 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29496 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29497 .code
29498 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29499 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29500 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29501 .endd
29502 .cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29503 .cindex DNS TTL
29504 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29505 .new
29506 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29507 .wen
29508 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29509 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29510 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29511 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29512
29513
29514
29515 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29516 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29517 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29518 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29519 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29520 .code
29521 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29522 .endd
29523 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29524 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29525 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29526 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29527
29528
29529
29530
29531 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29532 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29533 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29534 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29535 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29536 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29537 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29538 .code
29539 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29540 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29541 .endd
29542 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29543 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29544 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29545 up by this example is
29546 .code
29547 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29548 .endd
29549 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29550 addresses. For example:
29551 .code
29552 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29553 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29554 .endd
29555 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29556 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29557
29558
29559
29560
29561 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29562 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29563 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29564 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29565 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29566 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29567 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29568 either to double the separators like this:
29569 .code
29570 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29571 .endd
29572 or to change the separator character, like this:
29573 .code
29574 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29575 .endd
29576 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29577 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29578 occurs. Consider this condition:
29579 .code
29580 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29581 .endd
29582 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29583 .code
29584 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29585 a.domain.black.list.tld
29586 .endd
29587 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29588 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29589 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29590 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29591 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29592 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29593 error for a previous item.
29594
29595 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29596 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29597 .code
29598 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29599 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29600 .endd
29601 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29602 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29603 .code
29604 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29605 $sender_address_domain \
29606 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29607 see $dnslist_text.
29608 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29609 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29610 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29611 .endd
29612 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29613 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29614 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29615 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29616 .code
29617 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29618 .endd
29619 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29620 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29621
29622 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29623 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29624
29625
29626
29627
29628 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29629 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29630 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29631 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29632 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29633 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29634 .display
29635 127.1.0.1 RBL
29636 127.1.0.2 DUL
29637 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29638 127.1.0.4 RSS
29639 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29640 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29641 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29642 .endd
29643 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29644 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29645 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29646
29647
29648 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29649 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29650 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29651 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29652 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29653 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29654 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29655 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29656 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29657 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29658 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29659 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29660 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29661 cases, for example:
29662 .code
29663 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29664 .endd
29665 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29666 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29667 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29668 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29669 .code
29670 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29671 .endd
29672 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29673 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29674
29675 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29676 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29677 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29678 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29679 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29680 information.
29681
29682 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29683 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29684 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29685 .code
29686 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29687 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29688 at $dnslist_domain
29689 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29690 .endd
29691
29692
29693
29694 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29695 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29696 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29697 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29698 For example,
29699 .code
29700 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29701 .endd
29702 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29703 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29704 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29705 describes how multiple records are handled.
29706
29707 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29708 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29709 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29710 .code
29711 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29712 .endd
29713 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29714 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29715 first. For example:
29716 .code
29717 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29718 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29719 .endd
29720
29721 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29722 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29723 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29724 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29725 tested. For example:
29726 .code
29727 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29728 .endd
29729 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29730 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29731 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29732 .code
29733 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29734 .endd
29735 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29736 an odd number.
29737
29738
29739
29740 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29741 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29742 condition. Whereas
29743 .code
29744 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29745 .endd
29746 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29747 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29748 .code
29749 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29750 .endd
29751 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29752 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29753 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29754 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29755
29756 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29757 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29758
29759 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29760 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29761 .code
29762 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29763 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29764 .endd
29765 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29766 Consider this example:
29767 .code
29768 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29769 list.dsbl.org : \
29770 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29771 relays.ordb.org
29772 .endd
29773 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29774 .code
29775 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29776 list.dsbl.org
29777 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29778 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29779 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29780 .endd
29781 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29782
29783
29784
29785
29786 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29787 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29788 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29789 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29790 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29791 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29792 .code
29793 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29794 .endd
29795 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29796 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29797 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29798 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29799 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29800 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29801
29802 .ilist
29803 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29804 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29805 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29806 .next
29807 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29808 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29809 changed to:
29810 .code
29811 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29812 .endd
29813 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29814 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29815 .code
29816 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29817 .endd
29818 for the condition to be true.
29819 .endlist
29820
29821 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29822 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29823 .ilist
29824 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29825 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29826 .code
29827 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29828 .endd
29829 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29830 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29831 .next
29832 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29833 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29834 .code
29835 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29836 .endd
29837 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29838 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29839 .code
29840 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29841 .endd
29842 for the condition to be false.
29843 .endlist
29844 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29845 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29846
29847
29848
29849
29850 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29851 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29852 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29853 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29854 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29855 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29856 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29857 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29858 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29859 lists.
29860
29861 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29862 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29863 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29864 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29865 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29866 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29867 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29868 .code
29869 reject message = \
29870 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29871 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29872 dnslists = \
29873 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29874 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29875 .endd
29876 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29877 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29878 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29879 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29880 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29881 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29882
29883 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29884 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29885 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29886 .code
29887 reject dnslists = \
29888 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29889 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29890 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29891 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29892 .endd
29893 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29894 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29895 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29896
29897
29898
29899 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29900 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29901 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29902 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29903 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29904 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29905 .code
29906 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29907 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29908 .endd
29909 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29910 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29911 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29912 .code
29913 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29914 .endd
29915 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29916 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29917
29918 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29919 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29920 .code
29921 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29922 dnslists = some.list.example
29923 .endd
29924
29925 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29926 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29927 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29928 .code
29929 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29930 .endd
29931
29932 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29933 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29934 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29935 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29936 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29937 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29938 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29939 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29940 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29941 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29942 .display
29943 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29944 .endd
29945 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29946 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29947
29948 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29949 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29950 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29951 of &'p'&.
29952
29953 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29954 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29955 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29956 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29957 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29958 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29959 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29960 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29961 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29962
29963 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29964 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29965 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29966 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29967
29968 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29969 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29970 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29971 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29972 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29973 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29974 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29975 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29976 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29977 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29978
29979 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29980 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29981 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29982 ACL.
29983
29984 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29985 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29986 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29987 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29988 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29989 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29990
29991 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29992 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29993 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29994 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29995 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29996 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29997 the &%count=%& option.
29998
29999
30000 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
30001 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
30002 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
30003 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
30004 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
30005
30006 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
30007 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
30008 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
30009 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
30010
30011 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
30012 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
30013 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
30014 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
30015 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
30016 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
30017 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
30018
30019 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
30020 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30021 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
30022 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
30023 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
30024 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
30025 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
30026
30027 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
30028 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
30029 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
30030 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
30031 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
30032
30033 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
30034 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
30035 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
30036 multiple different commands.
30037
30038 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
30039 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
30040 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
30041 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
30042 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
30043
30044 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
30045
30046
30047 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
30048 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
30049 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
30050 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
30051 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
30052
30053 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
30054 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
30055
30056 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
30057 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
30058 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
30059 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
30060 new rate.
30061 .code
30062 acl_check_connect:
30063 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
30064 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30065 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30066 # ...
30067 acl_check_mail:
30068 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
30069 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
30070 (max $sender_rate_limit)
30071 .endd
30072
30073 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
30074 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
30075 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
30076 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
30077 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
30078 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
30079 checks.
30080
30081 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
30082 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
30083 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
30084 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
30085 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
30086
30087
30088 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
30089 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
30090 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
30091 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
30092 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
30093 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
30094 rest of the ACL.
30095
30096 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
30097 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
30098 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
30099 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
30100 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
30101 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
30102 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
30103 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
30104 from getting any email through.
30105
30106 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
30107 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
30108 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
30109 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
30110 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
30111 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
30112 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
30113 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
30114 .code
30115 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
30116 .endd
30117
30118
30119 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
30120 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
30121 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
30122 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
30123 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
30124 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
30125 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
30126 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
30127 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
30128
30129 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
30130 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
30131 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
30132 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
30133 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
30134 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
30135
30136 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
30137 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
30138 rate.
30139
30140 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
30141 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
30142 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
30143 required increases with larger limits.
30144
30145 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
30146 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
30147 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
30148 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
30149 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
30150 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
30151 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
30152 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
30153 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
30154 as intended.
30155
30156
30157 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
30158 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
30159 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
30160 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
30161 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
30162 message. For example:
30163 .code
30164 # Log all senders' rates
30165 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
30166 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
30167
30168 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
30169 # at the decimal point.
30170 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
30171 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
30172 $sender_rate_limit }s
30173
30174 # Keep authenticated users under control
30175 deny authenticated = *
30176 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
30177
30178 # System-wide rate limit
30179 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
30180 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
30181
30182 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
30183 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
30184 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
30185 messages per $sender_rate_period
30186 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
30187 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
30188 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
30189 .endd
30190 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
30191 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
30192 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
30193 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
30194 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
30195 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
30196 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
30197
30198
30199
30200 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
30201 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
30202 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30203 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30204 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30205 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30206 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30207 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30208 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30209 .code
30210 verify = sender/callout
30211 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30212 .endd
30213 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30214 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30215 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30216 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30217 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30218 The available options are as follows:
30219
30220 .ilist
30221 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30222 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30223 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30224 .next
30225 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30226 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30227 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30228 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30229 .next
30230 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30231 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30232 .next
30233 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30234 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30235 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30236 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30237 .endlist
30238
30239 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30240 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30241 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30242 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30243 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30244 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30245 coding like this:
30246 .code
30247 warn !verify = sender
30248 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30249 .endd
30250 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30251 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30252 verification failure.
30253
30254 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30255 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30256
30257 .ilist
30258 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30259 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30260 .next
30261 &%route%&: Routing failed.
30262 .next
30263 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30264 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30265 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30266 .next
30267 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30268 .next
30269 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30270 .endlist
30271
30272 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30273 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30274
30275
30276
30277
30278 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30279 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30280 .cindex "callout" "verification"
30281 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30282 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30283 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30284 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30285 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30286 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30287 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30288 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30289 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30290 sender's domain.
30291
30292 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30293 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30294 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30295 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30296 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30297 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30298
30299 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30300 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30301 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30302 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30303 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30304
30305 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30306 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30307 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30308 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30309 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30310 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30311 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30312 supplies a host list.
30313 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30314
30315 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30316 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30317 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30318 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30319 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30320 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30321 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30322
30323 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30324 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30325 following SMTP commands are sent:
30326 .display
30327 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30328 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30329 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30330 &`QUIT`&
30331 .endd
30332 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30333 set to &"lmtp"&.
30334
30335 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30336 settings.
30337
30338 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30339 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30340 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30341 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30342 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30343 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30344
30345 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30346 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30347 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30348 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30349 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30350
30351 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30352 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30353 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30354 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30355 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30356
30357
30358
30359
30360 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30361 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30362 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30363 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30364 .code
30365 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30366 .endd
30367 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30368 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30369 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30370
30371
30372 .vlist
30373 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30374 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30375 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30376 For example:
30377 .code
30378 verify = sender/callout=5s
30379 .endd
30380 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30381 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30382 the &%connect%& parameter.
30383
30384
30385 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30386 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30387 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30388 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30389 .code
30390 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30391 .endd
30392 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30393
30394 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30395 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30396 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30397 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30398 updated in this circumstance.
30399
30400 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30401 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30402 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30403 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30404 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30405 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30406
30407
30408 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30409 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30410 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30411 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30412 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30413 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30414 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30415 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30416 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30417 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30418 .code
30419 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30420 .endd
30421 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30422
30423
30424 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30425 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30426 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30427 For example:
30428 .code
30429 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30430 .endd
30431 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30432 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30433 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30434 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30435 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30436
30437
30438 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30439 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30440 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30441 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30442
30443 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30444 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30445 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30446 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30447 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30448 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30449 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30450 made, until the cache record expires.
30451
30452 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30453 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30454 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30455 For example:
30456 .code
30457 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30458 .endd
30459 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30460 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30461 .code
30462 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30463 .endd
30464 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30465 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30466 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30467 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30468
30469
30470 .vitem &*random*&
30471 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30472 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30473 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30474 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30475 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30476 .code
30477 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30478 .endd
30479 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30480 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30481 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30482 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30483 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30484
30485 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30486 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30487 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30488 .code
30489 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30490 .endd
30491 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30492 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30493 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30494 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30495 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30496
30497 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30498 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30499 .code
30500 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30501 .endd
30502 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30503 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30504 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30505 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30506 usefulness of callout caching.
30507 .endlist
30508
30509 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30510 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30511 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30512 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30513 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30514 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30515 these circumstances.
30516
30517 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30518 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30519 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30520 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30521 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30522 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30523 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30524
30525 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30526 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30527 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30528 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30529
30530
30531
30532
30533 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30534 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30535 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30536 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30537 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30538 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30539 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30540 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30541 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30542 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30543
30544 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30545 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30546 is not available.
30547
30548 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30549 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30550 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30551
30552 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30553 commands up to and including
30554 .code
30555 MAIL FROM:<>
30556 .endd
30557 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30558 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30559 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30560 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30561 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30562 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30563 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30564
30565 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30566 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30567 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30568 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30569 will eventually be noticed.
30570
30571 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30572 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30573 behaviour will be the same.
30574
30575
30576
30577 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30578 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30579 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30580 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30581 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30582 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30583 you might see:
30584 .code
30585 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30586 250 OK
30587 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30588 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30589 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30590 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30591 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30592 550 Sender verification failed
30593 .endd
30594 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30595 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30596 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30597 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30598 example:
30599 .code
30600 verify = sender/no_details
30601 .endd
30602
30603 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30604 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30605 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30606 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30607 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30608 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30609 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30610
30611 .ilist
30612 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30613 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30614 verification also fails.
30615 .next
30616 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30617 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30618 .endlist
30619
30620 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30621 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30622 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30623 .code
30624 A.Wol: aw123
30625 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30626 .endd
30627 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30628 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30629 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30630 verification to succeed.
30631
30632 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30633 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30634 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30635 option. For example:
30636 .code
30637 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30638 .endd
30639 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30640 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30641
30642 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30643 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30644 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30645 address and a report is output for each of them.
30646
30647
30648
30649 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30650 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30651 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30652 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30653 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30654 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30655 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30656 .code
30657 verify = csa
30658 .endd
30659 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30660 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30661 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30662 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30663 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30664 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30665
30666 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30667 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30668 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30669 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30670
30671 .ilist
30672 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30673 .next
30674 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30675 .next
30676 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30677 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30678 .next
30679 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30680 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30681 .endlist
30682
30683 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30684 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30685 .code
30686 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30687 .endd
30688 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30689 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30690 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30691 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30692 meaningful to say:
30693 .code
30694 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30695 .endd
30696 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30697 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30698 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30699
30700 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30701 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30702 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30703 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30704 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30705 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30706 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30707 of legitimate HELO domains.
30708
30709 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30710 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30711 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30712 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30713 lookup such as:
30714 .code
30715 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30716 .endd
30717 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30718 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30719 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30720
30721
30722
30723
30724 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30725 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30726 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30727 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30728 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30729 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30730 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30731 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30732
30733 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30734 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30735 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30736 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30737 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30738 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30739 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30740
30741 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30742 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30743 like this:
30744 .code
30745 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30746 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30747 }{$value}}
30748 .endd
30749 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30750 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30751 use this:
30752 .code
30753 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30754 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30755 senders = :
30756 recipients = +batv_senders
30757
30758 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30759 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30760 senders = :
30761 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30762 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30763 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30764 .endd
30765 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30766 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30767 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30768 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30769 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30770
30771 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30772 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30773 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30774 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30775 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30776 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30777 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30778
30779 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30780 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30781 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30782 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30783 .code
30784 batv_redirect:
30785 driver = redirect
30786 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30787 .endd
30788 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30789 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30790 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30791 local addresses.
30792
30793 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30794 can be used:
30795 .code
30796 external_smtp_batv:
30797 driver = smtp
30798 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30799 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30800 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30801 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30802 {$value}fail}}}
30803 .endd
30804 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30805
30806
30807
30808 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30809 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30810 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30811 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30812 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30813 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30814 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30815 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30816 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30817 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30818
30819 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30820 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30821 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30822 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30823 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30824 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30825 . ///
30826 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30827 . ///
30828 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30829 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30830 system to arbitrary domains.
30831
30832
30833 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30834 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30835 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30836 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30837
30838 .ilist
30839 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30840 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30841 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30842 .next
30843 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30844 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30845 .next
30846 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30847 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30848 .endlist
30849
30850
30851 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30852 .code
30853 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30854 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30855 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30856 .endd
30857 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30858 command:
30859 .code
30860 acl_check_rcpt:
30861 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30862 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30863 .endd
30864 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30865 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30866 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30867 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30868 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30869 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30870 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30871
30872
30873
30874 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30875 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30876 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30877 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30878 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30879
30880 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30881 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30882 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30883 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30884 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30885 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30886 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30887 .ecindex IIDacl
30888
30889
30890
30891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30893
30894 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30895 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30896 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30897 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30898 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30899 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30900 specification.
30901
30902 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30903 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30904 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30905 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30906 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30907
30908 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30909 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30910 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30911
30912 .ilist
30913 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30914 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30915 .next
30916 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30917 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30918 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30919 .next
30920 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30921 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30922 .next
30923 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30924 conditions.
30925 .next
30926 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30927 .endlist
30928
30929 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30930 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30931 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30932
30933 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30934 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30935 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30936 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30937 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30938 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30939
30940 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30941 temporarily created in a file called:
30942 .display
30943 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30944 .endd
30945 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30946 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30947 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30948 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30949 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30950 .code
30951 control = no_mbox_unspool
30952 .endd
30953 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30954 same directory by default.
30955
30956
30957
30958 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30959 .cindex "virus scanning"
30960 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30961 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30962 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30963 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30964 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30965 in memory and thus are much faster.
30966
30967 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30968 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30969
30970 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30971 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30972 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30973 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30974 .display
30975 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30976 .endd
30977 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30978 .code
30979 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30980 .endd
30981 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30982 before use.
30983 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30984 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30985
30986 .vlist
30987 .vitem &%avast%&
30988 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30989 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30990 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30991 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30992 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30993 This scanner type takes one option,
30994 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30995 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30996 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30997 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30998 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30999 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
31000 For example:
31001 .code
31002 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
31003 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
31004 .endd
31005 If you omit the argument, the default path
31006 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
31007 is used.
31008 If you use a remote host,
31009 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
31010 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
31011 For information about available commands and their options you may use
31012 .code
31013 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
31014 FLAGS
31015 SENSITIVITY
31016 PACK
31017 .endd
31018
31019
31020 .vitem &%aveserver%&
31021 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31022 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
31023 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
31024 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
31025 example:
31026 .code
31027 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
31028 .endd
31029
31030
31031 .vitem &%clamd%&
31032 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
31033 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
31034 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
31035 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
31036 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
31037
31038 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
31039 a UNIX socket specification,
31040 a TCP socket specification,
31041 or a (global) option.
31042
31043 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
31044 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
31045 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
31046 and the second a port number,
31047 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
31048 These per-server options are supported:
31049 .code
31050 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31051 .endd
31052
31053 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31054 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
31055
31056 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
31057
31058 Examples:
31059 .code
31060 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
31061 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
31062 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
31063 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
31064 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
31065 .endd
31066 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
31067 &`local`&
31068 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
31069 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
31070 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
31071 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
31072 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
31073 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
31074
31075 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
31076 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
31077 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
31078 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
31079 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
31080 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
31081 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
31082 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
31083 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
31084 .code
31085 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
31086 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
31087 (Connection refused)
31088 .endd
31089
31090 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
31091 contributing the code for this scanner.
31092
31093 .vitem &%cmdline%&
31094 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
31095 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
31096 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
31097 type takes 3 mandatory options:
31098
31099 .olist
31100 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
31101 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
31102
31103 .next
31104 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
31105 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
31106 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
31107 the &"trigger"& expression.
31108
31109 .next
31110 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
31111 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
31112 &"name"& expression.
31113 .endlist olist
31114
31115 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
31116 .code
31117 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
31118 .endd
31119 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
31120 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
31121 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
31122 configuration setting:
31123 .code
31124 av_scanner = cmdline:\
31125 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
31126 found in file:'(.+)'
31127 .endd
31128 .vitem &%drweb%&
31129 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
31130 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
31131 takes one option,
31132 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
31133 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
31134 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
31135 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
31136 For example:
31137 .code
31138 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
31139 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
31140 .endd
31141 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
31142 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
31143
31144 .vitem &%f-protd%&
31145 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
31146 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
31147 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
31148 (or port-range).
31149 For example:
31150 .code
31151 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
31152 .endd
31153 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
31154
31155 .vitem &%fsecure%&
31156 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
31157 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
31158 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
31159 .code
31160 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
31161 .endd
31162 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
31163 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
31164
31165 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
31166 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
31167 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
31168 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
31169 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
31170 For example:
31171 .code
31172 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
31173 .endd
31174 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
31175
31176 .vitem &%mksd%&
31177 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
31178 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
31179 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
31180 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
31181 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
31182 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
31183 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
31184 .code
31185 av_scanner = mksd:2
31186 .endd
31187 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
31188
31189 .vitem &%sock%&
31190 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
31191 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
31192 running on the local machine.
31193 There are four options:
31194 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
31195 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
31196 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
31197 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
31198 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
31199 For example:
31200 .code
31201 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
31202 .endd
31203 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31204 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31205 Both regular-expressions are required.
31206
31207 .vitem &%sophie%&
31208 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31209 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31210 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31211 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31212 client communication. For example:
31213 .code
31214 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31215 .endd
31216 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31217 the option.
31218 .endlist
31219
31220 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31221 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31222 ACL.
31223
31224 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31225 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31226 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31227 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31228 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31229 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31230 message.
31231
31232 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31233 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31234 The first element can then be one of
31235
31236 .ilist
31237 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31238 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31239 recommended usage.
31240 .next
31241 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31242 the condition fails immediately.
31243 .next
31244 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31245 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31246 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31247 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31248 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31249 .endlist
31250
31251 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31252 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31253 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31254
31255 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31256 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31257 For example:
31258 .code
31259 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31260 .endd
31261 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31262
31263 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31264 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31265 is set to record the actual address used.
31266
31267 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31268 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31269 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31270 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31271 logging data.
31272
31273 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31274 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31275 &%malware%& condition.
31276
31277 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31278 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31279
31280 Here is a very simple scanning example:
31281 .code
31282 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31283 demime = *
31284 malware = *
31285 .endd
31286 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31287 .code
31288 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31289 demime = *
31290 malware = */defer_ok
31291 .endd
31292 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31293 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31294 .code
31295 av_scanner = $acl_m0
31296 .endd
31297 in the main Exim configuration.
31298 .code
31299 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31300 set acl_m0 = sophie
31301 malware = *
31302
31303 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31304 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31305 malware = *
31306 .endd
31307
31308
31309 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31310 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31311 .cindex "spam scanning"
31312 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
31313 .cindex "Rspamd"
31314 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31315 score and a report for the message.
31316 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31317
31318 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31319 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31320 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31321
31322 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31323 .code
31324 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31325 .endd
31326 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31327 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31328 nicely, however.
31329
31330 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31331 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31332 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31333 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31334 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31335 configuration as follows (example):
31336 .code
31337 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31338 .endd
31339
31340 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31341 on TCP port 11333)
31342 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31343 .code
31344 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31345 .endd
31346
31347 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31348 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31349 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31350 .code
31351 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31352 .endd
31353 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31354 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31355 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31356 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31357 .code
31358 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31359 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31360 192.168.2.12 783
31361 .endd
31362 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31363 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31364 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31365 condition defers.
31366
31367 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31368 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31369 and changeable in the usual way.
31370
31371 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31372 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31373 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31374 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31375
31376 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31377 are options.
31378 The supported options are:
31379 .code
31380 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31381 weight=<value> Selection bias
31382 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31383 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31384 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31385 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31386 .endd
31387
31388 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31389 higher values being tried first.
31390 The default priority is 1.
31391
31392 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31393 Within a priority set
31394 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31395 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31396
31397 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31398 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31399 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31400 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31401
31402 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31403 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31404
31405 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31406 The default value is two minutes.
31407
31408 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31409 a failed connect is made.
31410 The default is to not retry.
31411
31412 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31413 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31414 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31415 expansion.
31416
31417 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31418 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31419 is set to record the actual address used.
31420
31421 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31422 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31423 .code
31424 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31425 spam = joe
31426 .endd
31427 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31428 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31429 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31430 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31431 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31432 right-hand side.
31433
31434 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31435 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31436 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31437 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31438 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31439 are not set.
31440 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31441 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31442 after the first),
31443 or the use of PRDR,
31444 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31445 are needed to use this feature.
31446
31447 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31448 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31449 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31450
31451
31452 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31453 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31454 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31455 example:
31456 .code
31457 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31458 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31459 spam = nobody
31460 .endd
31461
31462 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31463 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31464 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31465 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31466
31467 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31468 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31469 variables.
31470 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31471 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31472 available for use at delivery time.
31473
31474 .vlist
31475 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31476 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31477 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31478
31479 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31480 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31481 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31482 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31483 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31484
31485 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31486 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31487 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31488 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31489 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31490 spam bar is 50 characters.
31491
31492 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31493 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31494 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31495 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31496
31497 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31498 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31499 spam score versus threshold.
31500 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31501
31502 .endlist
31503
31504 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31505 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31506 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31507
31508 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31509 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31510 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31511 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31512 spam condition, like this:
31513 .code
31514 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31515 spam = joe/defer_ok
31516 .endd
31517 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31518
31519 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31520 condition:
31521 .code
31522 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31523 warn spam = nobody:true
31524 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31525 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31526
31527 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31528 # is over threshold
31529 warn spam = nobody
31530 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31531
31532 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31533 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31534 spam = nobody:true
31535 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31536 .endd
31537
31538
31539
31540 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31541 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31542 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31543 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31544 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31545 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31546 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31547 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31548 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31549 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31550 cases.
31551
31552 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31553 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31554 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31555 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31556 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31557 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31558 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31559
31560 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31561 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31562 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31563 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31564 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31565
31566 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31567 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31568 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31569 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31570 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31571 syntax is:
31572 .display
31573 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31574 .endd
31575 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31576 the value can be:
31577
31578 .olist
31579 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31580 .next
31581 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31582 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31583 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31584 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31585 .next
31586 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31587 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31588 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31589 the full path and file name.
31590 .next
31591 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31592 filename, and the default path is then used.
31593 .endlist
31594 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31595 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31596 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31597 .code
31598 decode = $mime_filename
31599 .endd
31600 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31601 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31602 automatically unlinked.
31603
31604 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31605 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31606 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31607 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31608 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31609
31610 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31611 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31612 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31613
31614 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31615 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31616 available in the MIME ACL:
31617
31618 .vlist
31619 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31620 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31621 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31622 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31623 contains the empty string.
31624
31625 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31626 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31627 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31628 .code
31629 us-ascii
31630 gb2312 (Chinese)
31631 iso-8859-1
31632 .endd
31633 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31634 case-insensitively.
31635
31636 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31637 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31638 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31639 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31640 only used for display purposes.
31641
31642 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31643 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31644 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31645
31646 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31647 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31648 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31649
31650 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31651 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31652 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31653 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31654 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31655
31656 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31657 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31658 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31659 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31660
31661 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31662 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31663 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31664 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31665 .code
31666 text/plain
31667 text/html
31668 application/octet-stream
31669 image/jpeg
31670 audio/midi
31671 .endd
31672 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31673 empty string.
31674
31675 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31676 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31677 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31678 containing the decoded data.
31679 .endlist
31680
31681 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31682 .vlist
31683 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31684 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31685 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31686 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31687 RFC2047
31688 or RFC2231
31689 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31690 If no filename was
31691 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31692
31693 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31694 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31695 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31696 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31697
31698 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31699 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31700 follows:
31701
31702 .olist
31703 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31704
31705 .next
31706 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31707 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31708
31709 .next
31710 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31711 and the rest are attachments.
31712
31713 .next
31714 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31715 .endlist olist
31716
31717 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31718 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31719 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31720 .code
31721 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31722 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31723 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31724 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31725 .endd
31726 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31727 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31728 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31729 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31730 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31731
31732 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31733 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31734 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31735 decoding is fully recursive.
31736
31737 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31738 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31739 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31740 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31741 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31742 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31743 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31744 .endlist
31745
31746
31747
31748 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31749 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31750 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31751 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31752 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31753
31754 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31755 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31756 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31757 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31758 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31759
31760 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31761 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31762 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31763 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31764 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31765 32K characters are checked.
31766
31767 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31768 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31769 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31770 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31771 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31772 .code
31773 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31774 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31775 .endd
31776 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31777 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31778 matching regular expression.
31779 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31780 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31781
31782 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31783 CPU-intensive.
31784
31785
31786
31787
31788 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31789 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31790 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31791 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31792 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31793 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31794 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31795 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31796 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31797 use the &%demime%& condition.
31798
31799 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31800 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31801 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31802 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31803 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31804 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31805
31806 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31807 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31808 example:
31809 .code
31810 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31811 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31812 .endd
31813 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31814 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31815 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31816 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31817
31818 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31819 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31820 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31821
31822 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31823
31824 .vlist
31825 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31826 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31827 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31828 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31829 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31830 zero, no error occurred.
31831
31832 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31833 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31834 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31835 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31836 .endlist
31837
31838 .vlist
31839 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31840 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31841 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31842 extension it found.
31843 .endlist
31844
31845 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31846 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31847
31848 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31849 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31850 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31851 facility:
31852 .code
31853 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31854 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31855 demime = *
31856 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31857
31858 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31859 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31860 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31861 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31862
31863 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31864 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31865 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31866 demime = exe:doc
31867 control = freeze
31868 .endd
31869 .ecindex IIDcosca
31870
31871
31872
31873
31874 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31875 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31876
31877 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31878 "Local scan function"
31879 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31880 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31881 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31882 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31883 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31884
31885 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31886 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31887 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31888 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31889 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31890
31891 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31892 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31893 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31894 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31895
31896 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31897 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31898 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31899 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31900
31901 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31902 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31903 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31904 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31905 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31906 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31907 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31908 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31909 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31910
31911
31912
31913 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31914 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31915 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31916 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31917 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31918 directory, so you might set
31919 .code
31920 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31921 .endd
31922 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31923 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31924 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31925 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31926 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31927 _src/local_scan.c_.
31928
31929 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31930 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31931 .code
31932 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31933 .endd
31934 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31935
31936
31937
31938
31939 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31940 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31941 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31942 .code
31943 #include "local_scan.h"
31944 .endd
31945 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31946 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31947 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31948 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31949 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31950 strings and pointers to character strings:
31951 .code
31952 #define CS (char *)
31953 #define CCS (const char *)
31954 #define CSS (char **)
31955 #define US (unsigned char *)
31956 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31957 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31958 .endd
31959 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31960 .code
31961 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31962 .endd
31963 The arguments are as follows:
31964
31965 .ilist
31966 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31967 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31968 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31969
31970 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31971 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31972 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31973 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31974 case this changes in some future version.
31975 .next
31976 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31977 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31978 .endlist
31979
31980 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31981
31982 .vlist
31983 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31984 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31985 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31986 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31987 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31988 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31989
31990 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31991 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31992 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31993
31994 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31995 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31996 queued without immediate delivery.
31997
31998 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31999 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
32000 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
32001 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
32002 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
32003 used.
32004
32005 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
32006 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
32007 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
32008 problem"& is used.
32009
32010 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32011 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
32012 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
32013 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
32014 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
32015 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
32016 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32017
32018 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
32019 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
32020 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
32021 .endlist
32022
32023 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
32024 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
32025 &%-oe%& command line options.
32026
32027
32028
32029 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
32030 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
32031 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
32032 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
32033 want to do this, you must have the line
32034 .code
32035 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32036 .endd
32037 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
32038 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
32039 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
32040 to define them.
32041
32042 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
32043 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
32044 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
32045 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
32046 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
32047 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
32048 .code
32049 static int my_integer_option = 42;
32050 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
32051
32052 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
32053 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
32054 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
32055 };
32056
32057 int local_scan_options_count =
32058 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
32059 .endd
32060 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
32061 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
32062 .code
32063 begin local_scan
32064 my_integer = 99
32065 my_string = some string of text...
32066 .endd
32067 The available types of option data are as follows:
32068
32069 .vlist
32070 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
32071 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
32072 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
32073 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
32074 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
32075 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
32076 values.)
32077
32078 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
32079 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
32080 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
32081 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
32082
32083 .vitem &*opt_int*&
32084 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
32085 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
32086 Exim.
32087
32088 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
32089 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
32090 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
32091 printed with the suffix K or M.
32092
32093 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
32094 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
32095 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
32096 always output in octal.
32097
32098 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
32099 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
32100 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
32101
32102 .vitem &*opt_time*&
32103 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
32104 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
32105 .endlist
32106
32107 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
32108 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
32109
32110
32111
32112 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
32113 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
32114 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
32115 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
32116 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
32117 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
32118 C variables are as follows:
32119
32120 .vlist
32121 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
32122 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
32123
32124 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
32125 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
32126
32127 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
32128 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
32129 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
32130 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
32131
32132 .ilist
32133 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
32134 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
32135 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
32136
32137 .next
32138 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
32139 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
32140 of debugging bits.
32141 .endlist ilist
32142
32143 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
32144 selected, you should use code like this:
32145 .code
32146 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32147 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32148 .endd
32149 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
32150 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
32151 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
32152
32153 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
32154 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
32155 discussed below.
32156
32157 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
32158 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
32159
32160 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
32161 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
32162
32163 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
32164 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
32165 &%-bh%& command line option.
32166
32167 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
32168 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
32169 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
32170
32171 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
32172 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
32173 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
32174 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
32175
32176 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
32177 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
32178 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
32179
32180 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
32181 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
32182
32183 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
32184 The number of accepted recipients.
32185
32186 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
32187 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
32188 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
32189 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
32190 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
32191 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
32192 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
32193 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
32194 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
32195 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
32196 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
32197 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
32198
32199 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
32200 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
32201
32202 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32203 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32204 locally-submitted messages.
32205
32206 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32207 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32208 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32209
32210 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32211 The name of the sending host, if known.
32212
32213 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32214 The port on the sending host.
32215
32216 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32217 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32218
32219 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32220 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32221
32222 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32223 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32224 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32225 .endlist
32226
32227
32228 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32229 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32230 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32231 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32232 their type to *.
32233
32234
32235 .vlist
32236 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32237 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32238
32239 .vitem &*int&~type*&
32240 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32241 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32242 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32243 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32244 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32245 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32246
32247 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
32248 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32249 internal newlines.
32250
32251 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32252 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32253 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32254 .endlist
32255
32256
32257
32258 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32259 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32260
32261 .vlist
32262 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32263 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32264
32265 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
32266 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32267 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32268 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32269
32270 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32271 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32272 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32273 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32274 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32275 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32276 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32277 is NULL for all recipients.
32278 .endlist
32279
32280
32281
32282 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32283 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32284 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32285 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32286 release:
32287
32288 .vlist
32289 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32290 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32291
32292 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32293 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32294 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32295 for the process in &%newumask%&.
32296
32297 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32298 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32299 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32300 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32301 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32302
32303 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32304
32305 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32306 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32307 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32308 return value is as follows:
32309
32310 .ilist
32311 >= 0
32312
32313 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32314 ending status.
32315
32316 .next
32317 < 0 and > &--256
32318
32319 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32320 signal number.
32321
32322 .next
32323 &--256
32324
32325 The process timed out.
32326 .next
32327 &--257
32328
32329 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32330 .endlist
32331
32332 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32333 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32334 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32335 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32336 forks a subprocess that is running
32337 .code
32338 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32339 .endd
32340 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32341 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32342 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32343 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32344
32345 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32346 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32347 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32348 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32349
32350
32351 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32352 *sender_authentication)*&
32353 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32354 that it runs is:
32355 .display
32356 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32357 .endd
32358 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32359
32360
32361 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32362 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32363 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32364 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32365 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32366 .code
32367 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32368 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32369 .endd
32370
32371 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32372 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32373 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32374 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32375 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32376 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32377 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32378 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32379
32380 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32381 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32382 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32383 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32384 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32385 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32386
32387 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32388 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32389 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32390 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32391
32392 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32393 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32394 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32395 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32396 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32397 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32398 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32399 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32400 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32401 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32402 .code
32403 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32404 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32405 .endd
32406 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32407 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32408
32409
32410 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32411 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32412 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32413 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32414 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32415
32416
32417 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32418 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32419 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32420 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32421 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32422 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32423 .code
32424 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32425 .endd
32426 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32427 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32428 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32429 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32430 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32431 zero-terminated.
32432
32433 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32434 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32435 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32436 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32437 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32438 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32439 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32440 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32441
32442 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32443 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32444 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32445 .display
32446 &`OK `& match succeeded
32447 &`FAIL `& match failed
32448 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32449 .endd
32450 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32451 inability to contact a database.
32452
32453 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32454 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32455 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32456 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32457 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32458
32459 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32460 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32461 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32462 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32463 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32464
32465 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32466 uschar&~*list)*&"
32467 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32468 expected to be
32469 .code
32470 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32471 .endd
32472 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32473 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32474 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32475 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32476 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32477 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32478 failed.
32479
32480 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32481 *format,&~...)*&"
32482 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32483 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32484 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32485 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32486 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32487 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32488
32489
32490 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32491 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32492 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32493 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32494
32495 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32496 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32497 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32498 value afterwards. For example:
32499 .code
32500 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32501 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32502 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32503 .endd
32504
32505 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32506 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32507 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32508 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32509 address.
32510 .endlist
32511
32512
32513 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32514 .vlist
32515 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32516 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32517 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32518 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32519 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32520 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32521 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32522 binary string is returned with an error message.
32523
32524 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32525 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32526 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32527
32528 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32529 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32530 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32531 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32532 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32533
32534 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32535 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32536 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32537
32538 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32539 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32540 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32541 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32542 with translation.
32543
32544
32545 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32546 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32547 below.
32548
32549 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32550 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32551 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32552 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32553 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32554 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32555 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32556 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32557 is involved.
32558
32559 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32560 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32561
32562 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32563 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32564 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32565 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32566 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32567 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32568 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32569 .code
32570 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32571 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32572 .endd
32573 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32574 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32575 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32576 multiple output lines.
32577
32578 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32579 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32580 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32581 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32582 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32583 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32584 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32585 is an error.
32586
32587 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32588 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32589 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32590 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32591
32592 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32593 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32594 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32595
32596 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32597 See below.
32598
32599 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32600 See below.
32601
32602 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32603 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32604 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32605 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32606 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32607 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32608 more discussion.
32609 .endlist
32610
32611
32612
32613 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32614 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32615 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32616 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32617 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32618 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32619 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32620 terminates.
32621
32622 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32623 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32624 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32625 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32626
32627 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32628 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32629 .code
32630 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32631 .endd
32632 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32633 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32634 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32635 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32636
32637 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32638 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32639 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32640 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32641 &%store_pool%&.
32642 .ecindex IIDlosca
32643
32644
32645
32646
32647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32649
32650 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32651 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32652 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32653 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32654 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32655 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32656 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32657 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32658
32659 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32660 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32661 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32662 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32663 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32664
32665 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32666 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32667 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32668 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32669 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32670 prevent it happening on retries.
32671
32672 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32673 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32674 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32675 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32676 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32677 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32678 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32679 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32680
32681
32682 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32683 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32684 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32685 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32686 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32687 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32688 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32689 .code
32690 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32691 system_filter_user = exim
32692 .endd
32693 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32694 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32695 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32696 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32697 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32698 by the &%reply%& command.
32699
32700
32701 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32702 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32703 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32704 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32705
32706 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32707 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32708
32709
32710
32711 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32712 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32713 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32714 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32715 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32716 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32717 they cause errors.
32718
32719 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32720 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32721 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32722 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32723 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32724 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32725 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32726
32727 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32728 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32729 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32730 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32731 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32732
32733 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32734 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32735 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32736 to which users' filter files can refer.
32737
32738
32739
32740 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32741 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32742 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32743 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32744 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32745
32746
32747
32748 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32749 .cindex "freezing messages"
32750 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32751 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32752 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32753 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32754 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32755 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32756 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32757 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32758 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32759 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32760 .code
32761 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32762 .endd
32763 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32764
32765 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32766 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32767 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32768 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32769 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32770 run.
32771
32772 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32773 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32774 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32775 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32776
32777 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32778 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32779 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32780 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32781 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32782 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32783 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32784 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32785 message. For example:
32786 .code
32787 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32788 because it contains attachments that we are \
32789 not prepared to receive."
32790 .endd
32791
32792 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32793 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32794 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32795 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32796 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32797 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32798 use, for example
32799 .code
32800 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32801 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32802 .endd
32803 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32804 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32805 generated by the filter.
32806
32807 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32808 &%defer%&,
32809 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32810 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32811 as
32812 .code
32813 mail ...
32814 freeze
32815 .endd
32816 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32817 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32818 take place.
32819
32820
32821
32822 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32823 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32824 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32825 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32826 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32827 .code
32828 headers add <string>
32829 headers remove <string>
32830 .endd
32831 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32832 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32833 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32834 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32835 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32836
32837 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32838 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32839 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32840 example:
32841 .code
32842 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32843 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32844 X-header-2: ...."
32845 .endd
32846 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32847 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32848 space after input continuations is ignored.
32849
32850 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32851 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32852 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32853 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32854 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32855
32856 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32857 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32858 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32859 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32860 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32861 used for all recipients of the message.
32862
32863 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32864 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32865 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32866 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32867 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32868 until the message is actually being written (see section
32869 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32870
32871 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32872 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32873 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32874 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32875 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32876 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32877 modified more than once.
32878
32879 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32880 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32881 For example:
32882 .code
32883 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32884 headers remove "Subject"
32885 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32886 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32887 .endd
32888
32889
32890
32891 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32892 .cindex "envelope sender"
32893 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32894 .code
32895 errors_to <some address>
32896 .endd
32897 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32898 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32899 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32900 might use
32901 .code
32902 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32903 .endd
32904 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32905 address if its delivery failed.
32906
32907
32908
32909 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32910 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32911 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32912 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32913 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32914 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32915 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32916 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32917 which implements such a filter:
32918 .code
32919 central_filter:
32920 check_local_user
32921 driver = redirect
32922 domains = +local_domains
32923 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32924 no_verify
32925 allow_filter
32926 allow_freeze
32927 .endd
32928 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32929 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32930 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32931 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32932
32933 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32934 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32935 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32936 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32937 normal way.
32938 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32939 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32940 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32941
32942
32943
32944
32945
32946
32947 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32948 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32949
32950 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32951 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32952 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32953 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32954 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32955 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32956 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32957 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32958
32959 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32960 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32961 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32962 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32963 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32964
32965 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32966 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32967 loopback interface specially in any way.
32968
32969 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32970 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32971
32972
32973
32974
32975 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32976 .cindex "message" "submission"
32977 .cindex "submission mode"
32978 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32979 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32980 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32981 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32982 .code
32983 control = submission
32984 .endd
32985 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32986 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32987 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32988 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32989 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32990 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32991 .code
32992 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32993 control = submission
32994 .endd
32995 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32996 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32997 is used to separate options. For example:
32998 .code
32999 control = submission/sender_retain
33000 .endd
33001 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
33002 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
33003 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
33004 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
33005 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
33006 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
33007 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
33008
33009 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
33010 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
33011 example:
33012 .code
33013 control = submission/domain=some.domain
33014 .endd
33015 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
33016 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
33017 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
33018 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
33019 .code
33020 accept authenticated = *
33021 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
33022 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
33023 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
33024 .endd
33025 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
33026 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
33027 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
33028 .code
33029 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
33030 .endd
33031 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
33032 line would be:
33033 .code
33034 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
33035 .endd
33036 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
33037 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
33038 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
33039 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
33040
33041 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
33042 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
33043 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
33044 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
33045 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
33046 spoof another's address.
33047
33048 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
33049 .cindex "line endings"
33050 .cindex "carriage return"
33051 .cindex "linefeed"
33052 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
33053 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
33054 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
33055 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
33056 use CRLF or just CR.
33057
33058 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
33059 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
33060 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
33061 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
33062 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
33063 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
33064 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
33065 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
33066 follows:
33067
33068 .ilist
33069 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
33070 .next
33071 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
33072 is ignored.
33073 .next
33074 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
33075 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
33076 terminator.
33077 .next
33078 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
33079 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
33080 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
33081 people trying to play silly games.
33082 .next
33083 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
33084 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
33085 line.
33086 .endlist
33087
33088
33089
33090
33091
33092 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
33093 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
33094 .cindex "address" "qualification"
33095 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
33096 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
33097 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
33098 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
33099 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
33100
33101 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
33102 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
33103 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
33104 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
33105 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
33106
33107 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
33108 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
33109 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
33110 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
33111 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
33112 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
33113 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
33114 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
33115
33116
33117
33118
33119 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
33120 .cindex "&""From""& line"
33121 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
33122 .cindex "sender" "address"
33123 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
33124 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
33125 .cindex "envelope sender"
33126 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33127 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
33128 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
33129 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
33130 .code
33131 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
33132 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
33133 .endd
33134 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
33135 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
33136 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
33137 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
33138 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
33139 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
33140 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
33141 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
33142 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
33143
33144 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
33145 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
33146 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
33147 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
33148 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
33149 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
33150 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
33151
33152 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
33153 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
33154 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
33155
33156 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
33157 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
33158 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
33159 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
33160
33161
33162
33163 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
33164 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
33165 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
33166 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
33167 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
33168 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
33169 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
33170
33171 .blockquote
33172 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
33173 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
33174 .endblockquote
33175
33176 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
33177 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
33178 follows:
33179
33180 .ilist
33181 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
33182 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
33183 .next
33184 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
33185 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
33186 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
33187 .next
33188 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
33189 also removed.
33190 .next
33191 For a locally-submitted message,
33192 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
33193 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
33194 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
33195 included in log lines in this case.
33196 .next
33197 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
33198 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
33199 .endlist
33200
33201
33202
33203
33204 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33205 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33206 includes the header line:
33207 .code
33208 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33209 .endd
33210
33211 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33212 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33213 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33214 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33215 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33216 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33217
33218
33219 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33220 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33221 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33222 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33223 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33224
33225 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33226 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33227 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33228 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33229 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33230 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33231 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33232 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33233 messages.
33234
33235
33236 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33237 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33238 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33239 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33240 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33241 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33242 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33243 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33244 messages.
33245
33246
33247 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33248 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33249 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33250 .cindex "message" "submission"
33251 .cindex "submission mode"
33252 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33253 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33254
33255 .ilist
33256 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33257 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33258 .next
33259 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33260 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33261 .olist
33262 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33263 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33264 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33265 .next
33266 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33267 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33268 .next
33269 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33270 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33271 .endlist
33272 .endlist
33273
33274 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33275
33276 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33277 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33278 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33279 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33280 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33281 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33282 &%qualify_domain%&.
33283
33284 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33285 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33286 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33287 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33288
33289
33290 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33291 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33292 .cindex "message" "submission"
33293 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33294 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33295 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33296 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33297 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33298 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33299 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33300 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33301 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33302 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33303
33304
33305 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33306 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33307 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33308 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33309 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33310
33311 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33312 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33313 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33314 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33315
33316 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33317 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33318 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33319
33320
33321 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33322 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33323 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33324 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33325 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33326 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33327 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33328 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33329 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33330 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33331 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33332
33333
33334
33335 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33336 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33337 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33338 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33339 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33340 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33341 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33342 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33343
33344
33345
33346 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33347 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33348 .cindex "message" "submission"
33349 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33350 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33351 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33352 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33353 control setting.
33354
33355 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33356 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33357 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33358 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33359 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33360 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33361 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33362 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33363 line is added to the message.
33364
33365 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33366 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33367 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33368 options true at the same time.
33369
33370 .cindex "submission mode"
33371 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33372 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33373 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33374 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33375
33376 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33377 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33378 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33379 created as follows:
33380
33381 .ilist
33382 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33383 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33384 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33385 .next
33386 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33387 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33388 .next
33389 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33390 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33391 .endlist
33392
33393 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33394 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33395 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33396 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33397
33398 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33399 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33400 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33401 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33402
33403
33404
33405 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33406 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33407 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33408 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33409 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33410 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33411 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33412 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33413 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33414
33415 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33416 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33417 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33418 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33419 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33420 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33421
33422 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33423 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33424 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33425
33426 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33427 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33428 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33429 .code
33430 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33431 X-added-second: another added header line
33432 .endd
33433 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33434
33435 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33436 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33437 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33438
33439 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33440 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33441 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33442 not part of the names. For example:
33443 .code
33444 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33445 .endd
33446
33447 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33448 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33449 Each item is separately expanded.
33450 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33451 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33452 will act as list separators.
33453
33454 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33455 items are expanded at routing time,
33456 and then associated with all addresses that are
33457 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33458 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33459 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33460
33461 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33462 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33463 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33464 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33465
33466 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33467 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33468 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33469 requirements.
33470
33471 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33472 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33473 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33474 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33475 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33476 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33477 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33478
33479 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33480 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33481 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33482 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33483
33484 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33485 the following consequences:
33486
33487 .ilist
33488 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33489 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33490 to it, at all times.
33491 .next
33492 Header lines that are added by a router's
33493 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33494 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33495 .next
33496 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33497 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33498 .next
33499 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33500 a later router or by a transport.
33501 .next
33502 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33503 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33504 .code
33505 headers_remove = subject
33506 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33507 .endd
33508 .endlist
33509
33510 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33511 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33512
33513
33514
33515
33516
33517 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33518 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33519 .cindex "constructed address"
33520 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33521 the form
33522 .display
33523 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33524 .endd
33525 For example:
33526 .code
33527 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33528 .endd
33529 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33530 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33531 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33532 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33533 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33534 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33535 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33536 there is no password file entry.
33537
33538 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33539 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33540 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33541 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33542 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33543 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33544 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33545 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33546 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33547
33548
33549
33550 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33551 .cindex "case of local parts"
33552 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33553 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33554 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33555 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33556 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33557 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33558 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33559 router option.
33560
33561 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33562 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33563 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33564 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33565 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33566 .code
33567 correct_case:
33568 driver = redirect
33569 domains = +local_domains
33570 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33571 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33572 @$domain
33573 .endd
33574 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33575 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33576 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33577 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33578 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33579
33580
33581
33582 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33583 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33584 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33585 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33586 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33587 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33588 empty components for compatibility.
33589
33590
33591
33592 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33593 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33594 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33595 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33596 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33597 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33598
33599 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33600 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33601 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33602 example, a header such as
33603 .code
33604 To: hare@teaparty
33605 .endd
33606 might get rewritten as
33607 .code
33608 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33609 .endd
33610 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33611 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33612 been routed.
33613
33614 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33615 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33616 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33617 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33618 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33619 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33620 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33621
33622
33623
33624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33626
33627 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33628 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33629 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33630 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33631 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33632 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33633 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33634
33635 .ilist
33636 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33637 .next
33638 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33639 .next
33640 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33641 .endlist
33642
33643 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33644
33645 .ilist
33646 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33647 .next
33648 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33649 &"lmtp"&);
33650 .next
33651 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33652 transport);
33653 .next
33654 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33655 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33656 .endlist
33657
33658 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33659 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33660 used to contain the envelope information.
33661
33662
33663
33664 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33665 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33666 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33667 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33668 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33669 .cindex "EHLO"
33670 .cindex "HELO"
33671 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33672 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33673 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33674 processing is the same in both cases.
33675
33676 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33677 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33678 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33679 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33680 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33681 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33682 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33683 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33684 suppressed.
33685
33686 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33687 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33688 required for the transaction.
33689
33690 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33691 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33692 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33693 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33694 is called for verification.
33695
33696 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33697 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33698 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33699
33700 .cindex "carriage return"
33701 .cindex "linefeed"
33702 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33703 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33704 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33705 line terminator.
33706
33707 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33708 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33709 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33710 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33711 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33712 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33713 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33714 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33715 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33716
33717 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33718 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33719 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33720 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33721
33722 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33723 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33724 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33725 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33726
33727 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33728 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33729 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33730 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33731 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33732 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33733 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33734 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33735 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33736 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33737
33738 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33739 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33740
33741 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33742 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33743 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33744 square bracket of the IP address.
33745
33746
33747
33748
33749 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33750 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33751 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33752 .cindex "host" "error"
33753 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33754 message errors, and recipient errors.
33755
33756 .vlist
33757 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33758 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33759 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33760
33761 .ilist
33762 Connection refused or timed out,
33763 .next
33764 Any error response code on connection,
33765 .next
33766 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33767 .next
33768 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33769 .next
33770 I/O errors at any time,
33771 .next
33772 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33773 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33774 .endlist ilist
33775
33776 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33777 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33778 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33779 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33780 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33781 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33782 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33783 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33784
33785 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33786 .cindex "message" "error"
33787 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33788 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33789 message errors are:
33790
33791 .ilist
33792 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33793 the data,
33794 .next
33795 Timeout after MAIL,
33796 .next
33797 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33798 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33799 connection at any other time.
33800 .endlist ilist
33801
33802 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33803 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33804 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33805 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33806 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33807 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33808 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33809 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33810 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33811 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33812
33813 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33814 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33815 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33816 response to MAIL.
33817
33818 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33819 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33820 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33821 recipient errors are:
33822
33823 .ilist
33824 Any error response to RCPT,
33825 .next
33826 Timeout after RCPT.
33827 .endlist
33828
33829 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33830 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33831 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33832 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33833 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33834 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33835 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33836 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33837 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33838 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33839 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33840 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33841 the retry clock is reset.
33842
33843 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33844 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33845 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33846 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33847 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33848 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33849 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33850 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33851 recipient's retry time.
33852 .endlist
33853
33854 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33855 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33856 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33857 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33858 until the next delivery attempt.
33859
33860 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33861 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33862 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33863 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33864 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33865 is created.
33866
33867 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33868 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33869 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33870 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33871 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33872 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33873 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33874
33875 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33876 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33877 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33878 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33879 then to be treated as a host error.
33880
33881 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33882 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33883 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33884 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33885 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33886
33887
33888
33889
33890 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33891 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33892 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33893 .cindex "inetd"
33894 .cindex "daemon"
33895 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33896 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33897 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33898 .code
33899 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33900 .endd
33901 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33902 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33903 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33904 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33905 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33906 stream and exits with an error code.
33907
33908 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33909 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33910 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33911 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33912
33913 .cindex "carriage return"
33914 .cindex "linefeed"
33915 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33916 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33917 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33918 line terminator.
33919 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33920 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33921 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33922
33923 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33924 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33925 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33926 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33927 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33928 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33929 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33930 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33931
33932 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33933 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33934 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33935 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33936 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33937 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33938 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33939 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33940 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33941
33942 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33943 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33944 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33945
33946 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33947 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33948 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33949 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33950 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33951
33952 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33953 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33954 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33955 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33956 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33957 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33958 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33959
33960 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33961 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33962 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33963 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33964 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33965
33966 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33967 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33968 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33969 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33970 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33971 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33972 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33973 a delivery process.
33974
33975 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33976 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33977 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33978 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33979 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33980
33981 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33982 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33983 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33984 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33985
33986 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33987 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33988 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33989
33990
33991
33992 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33993 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33994 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33995 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33996 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33997 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33998 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33999 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
34000
34001
34002 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
34003 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
34004 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
34005 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
34006 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
34007 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
34008 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
34009 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
34010 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
34011 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
34012 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
34013
34014
34015
34016 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
34017 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
34018 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
34019 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
34020 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
34021 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
34022 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
34023 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
34024
34025 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
34026 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
34027 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
34028 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
34029 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
34030 counted.
34031
34032 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
34033 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
34034 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
34035
34036 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
34037 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
34038 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
34039 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
34040 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
34041
34042
34043
34044
34045 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
34046 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
34047 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
34048 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
34049 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34050
34051 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
34052 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
34053 called with the &%-bv%& option.
34054
34055 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
34056 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
34057 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
34058 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
34059 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
34060 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
34061 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
34062 RCPT failures.
34063
34064
34065
34066 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
34067 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
34068 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
34069 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
34070 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
34071 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
34072 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
34073
34074 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
34075 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
34076 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
34077 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
34078 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
34079 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
34080 argument. For example,
34081 .code
34082 ETRN #brigadoon
34083 .endd
34084 runs the command
34085 .code
34086 exim -R brigadoon
34087 .endd
34088 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
34089 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
34090 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
34091 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
34092 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
34093
34094 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
34095 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
34096 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
34097 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
34098 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
34099 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
34100 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
34101 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
34102
34103 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
34104 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
34105 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
34106 whatever the form of its argument. For
34107 example:
34108 .code
34109 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
34110 $sender_host_address
34111 .endd
34112 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34113 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
34114 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
34115 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
34116 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
34117 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
34118 for it to change them before running the command.
34119
34120
34121
34122 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
34123 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
34124 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
34125 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
34126 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
34127 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
34128 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
34129 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
34130 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
34131 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
34132 runs for RCPT commands:
34133 .code
34134 accept hosts = :
34135 .endd
34136 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
34137
34138
34139
34140 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
34141 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
34142 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
34143 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
34144 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
34145 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
34146 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
34147 envelope along with the message.
34148
34149 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
34150 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
34151 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
34152 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
34153 can be used to specify it.
34154
34155 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
34156 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
34157 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
34158 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
34159 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
34160
34161 .vindex "&$host$&"
34162 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
34163 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
34164 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
34165 router:
34166 .code
34167 begin routers
34168 route_append:
34169 driver = manualroute
34170 transport = smtp_appendfile
34171 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
34172
34173 begin transports
34174 smtp_appendfile:
34175 driver = appendfile
34176 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
34177 batch_max = 1000
34178 use_bsmtp
34179 user = exim
34180 .endd
34181 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
34182 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
34183 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
34184
34185
34186
34187 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
34188 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
34189 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
34190 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
34191 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
34192 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
34193 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
34194 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
34195 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
34196 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
34197
34198 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
34199 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
34200
34201 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
34202 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34203 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34204 make some use of automatically, for example:
34205 .code
34206 554 Unexpected end of file
34207 Transaction started in line 10
34208 Error detected in line 14
34209 .endd
34210 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34211 file, for example:
34212 .code
34213 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34214 The error message was:
34215
34216 501 '>' missing at end of address
34217
34218 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34219 The error was detected in line 12.
34220 The SMTP command at fault was:
34221
34222 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34223
34224 1 previous message was successfully processed.
34225 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34226 .endd
34227 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34228 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34229 accepted.
34230 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34231 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34232
34233
34234
34235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34237
34238 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34239 "Customizing messages"
34240 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34241 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34242 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34243 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34244 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34245
34246 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34247 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34248 option. Exim also adds the line
34249 .code
34250 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34251 .endd
34252 to all warning and bounce messages,
34253
34254
34255 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34256 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34257 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34258 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34259 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34260 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34261 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34262
34263 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34264 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34265 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34266 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34267 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34268 item.
34269
34270 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34271 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34272 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34273 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34274 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34275 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34276 option, rounded to a whole number.
34277
34278 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34279
34280 .ilist
34281 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34282 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34283 .next
34284 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34285 failing addresses with their error messages.
34286 .next
34287 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34288 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34289 .next
34290 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34291 The fields exist for back-compatibility
34292 .endlist
34293
34294 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34295 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34296 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34297 .code
34298 Subject: Mail delivery failed
34299 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34300 {: returning message to sender}}
34301 ****
34302 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34303
34304 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34305 {that you sent }{sent by
34306
34307 <$sender_address>
34308
34309 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34310 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34311 ****
34312 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34313 ****
34314 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34315 ------
34316 ****
34317 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34318 only the first
34319 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34320 ****
34321 .endd
34322 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34323 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34324 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34325 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34326 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34327 text sections:
34328
34329 .ilist
34330 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34331 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34332 .next
34333 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34334 the delayed addresses.
34335 .next
34336 The third item then ends the message.
34337 .endlist
34338
34339 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34340 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34341 .code
34342 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34343 $warn_message_delay
34344 ****
34345 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34346
34347 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34348 {that you sent }{sent by
34349
34350 <$sender_address>
34351
34352 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34353 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34354
34355 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34356 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34357 The date of the message is: $h_date
34358
34359 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34360 ****
34361 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34362 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34363 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34364 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34365 the message will be returned to you.
34366 .endd
34367 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34368 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34369 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34370 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34371 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34372 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34373 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34374 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34375 handled them.
34376
34377
34378
34379
34380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34382
34383 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34384 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34385 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34386
34387
34388
34389 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34390 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34391 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34392 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34393 routing explicitly:
34394 .code
34395 send_to_smart_host:
34396 driver = manualroute
34397 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34398 transport = remote_smtp
34399 .endd
34400 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34401 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34402 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34403 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34404 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34405
34406
34407
34408
34409 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34410 .cindex "mailing lists"
34411 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34412 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34413 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34414
34415 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34416 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34417 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34418 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34419 .code
34420 lists:
34421 driver = redirect
34422 domains = lists.example
34423 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34424 forbid_pipe
34425 forbid_file
34426 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34427 no_more
34428 .endd
34429 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34430 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34431 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34432 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34433
34434 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34435 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34436 a mailing list.
34437
34438 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34439 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34440 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34441 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34442 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34443
34444 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34445 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34446 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34447 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34448 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34449 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34450 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34451 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34452 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34453
34454
34455
34456 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34457 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34458 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34459 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34460 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34461 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34462 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34463
34464 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34465 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34466 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34467 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34468 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34469
34470
34471
34472 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34473 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34474 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34475 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34476 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34477 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34478 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34479 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34480 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34481 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34482
34483 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34484 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34485 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34486 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34487 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34488 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34489 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34490 pre-existing messages.
34491
34492 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34493 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34494 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34495 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34496 one level of expansion anyway.
34497
34498
34499
34500 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34501 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34502 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34503 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34504 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34505 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34506
34507 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34508 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34509 .code
34510 lists_request:
34511 driver = redirect
34512 domains = lists.example
34513 local_part_suffix = -request
34514 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34515 no_more
34516
34517 lists_post:
34518 driver = redirect
34519 domains = lists.example
34520 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34521 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34522 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34523 forbid_pipe
34524 forbid_file
34525 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34526 no_more
34527
34528 lists_closed:
34529 driver = redirect
34530 domains = lists.example
34531 allow_fail
34532 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34533 .endd
34534 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34535 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34536 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34537 mailing list.
34538
34539 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34540 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34541 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34542 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34543 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34544 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34545 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34546 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34547 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34548
34549 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34550 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34551 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34552
34553
34554
34555
34556 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34557 .cindex "VERP"
34558 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34559 .cindex "envelope sender"
34560 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34561 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34562 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34563 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34564 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34565 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34566
34567 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34568 .oindex &%return_path%&
34569 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34570 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34571 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34572 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34573 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34574 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34575 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34576 .code
34577 verp_smtp:
34578 driver = smtp
34579 max_rcpt = 1
34580 return_path = \
34581 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34582 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34583 .endd
34584 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34585 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34586 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34587 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34588 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34589 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34590 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34591 rewritten as
34592 .code
34593 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34594 .endd
34595 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34596 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34597 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34598 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34599 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34600 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34601
34602 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34603 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34604 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34605 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34606 .code
34607 dnslookup:
34608 driver = dnslookup
34609 domains = ! +local_domains
34610 transport = \
34611 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34612 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34613 no_more
34614 .endd
34615 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34616 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34617 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34618 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34619 address.
34620
34621 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34622 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34623 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34624 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34625 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34626 .code
34627 verp_dnslookup:
34628 driver = dnslookup
34629 domains = ! +local_domains
34630 transport = remote_smtp
34631 errors_to = \
34632 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34633 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34634 no_more
34635 .endd
34636 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34637 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34638 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34639 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34640 them.
34641
34642 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34643 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34644 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34645 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34646 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34647 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34648 used).
34649
34650
34651
34652
34653
34654
34655 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34656 .cindex "virtual domains"
34657 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34658 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34659 meanings:
34660
34661 .ilist
34662 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34663 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34664 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34665 .next
34666 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34667 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34668 have login accounts on that host.
34669 .endlist
34670
34671 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34672 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34673 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34674 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34675 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34676 to a router of this form:
34677 .code
34678 virtual:
34679 driver = redirect
34680 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34681 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34682 no_more
34683 .endd
34684 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34685 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34686 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34687 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34688 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34689 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34690
34691 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34692 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34693 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34694 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34695
34696 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34697 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34698 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34699 .code
34700 my_domains:
34701 driver = accept
34702 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34703 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34704 transport = my_mailboxes
34705 .endd
34706 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34707 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34708 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34709 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34710 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34711 follows:
34712 .code
34713 my_mailboxes:
34714 driver = appendfile
34715 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34716 user = mail
34717 .endd
34718 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34719 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34720
34721 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34722 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34723 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34724 information about the domains.
34725
34726
34727
34728 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34729 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34730 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34731 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34732 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34733 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34734 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34735 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34736 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34737 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34738 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34739 example, consider this router:
34740 .code
34741 userforward:
34742 driver = redirect
34743 check_local_user
34744 file = $home/.forward
34745 local_part_suffix = -*
34746 local_part_suffix_optional
34747 allow_filter
34748 .endd
34749 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34750 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34751 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34752 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34753 .code
34754 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34755 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34756 endif
34757 .endd
34758 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34759 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34760 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34761 control over which suffixes are valid.
34762
34763 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34764 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34765 another MTA:
34766 .code
34767 userforward:
34768 driver = redirect
34769 check_local_user
34770 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34771 local_part_suffix = -*
34772 local_part_suffix_optional
34773 allow_filter
34774 .endd
34775 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34776 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34777 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34778 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34779 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34780
34781
34782
34783 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34784 .cindex "vacation processing"
34785 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34786 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34787 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34788 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34789 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34790
34791 .ilist
34792 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34793 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34794 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34795 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34796 .code
34797 spqr, vacation-spqr
34798 .endd
34799 .next
34800 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34801 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34802 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34803 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34804 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34805 message.
34806 .endlist
34807
34808 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34809 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34810
34811
34812
34813 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34814 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34815 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34816 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34817 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34818 each day's messages.
34819
34820 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34821 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34822 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34823 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34824
34825
34826
34827 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34828 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34829 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34830 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34831 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34832 permanently connected.
34833
34834 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34835 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34836 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34837
34838
34839 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34840 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34841 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34842 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34843 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34844 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34845 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34846 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34847
34848 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34849 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34850 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34851 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34852 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34853 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34854 if required.
34855
34856 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34857 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34858 intermittent host. For example:
34859 .code
34860 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34861 .endd
34862 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34863 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34864 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34865 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34866 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34867 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34868 immediately.
34869
34870 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34871 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34872 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34873 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34874 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34875 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34876 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34877
34878
34879
34880 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34881 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34882 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34883 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34884 delivered immediately.
34885
34886 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34887 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34888 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34889 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34890 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34891 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34892 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34893 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34894 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34895 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34896 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34897 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34898 single SMTP connection.
34899
34900
34901
34902 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34903 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34904
34905 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34906 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34907 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34908 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34909 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34910 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34911 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34912 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34913 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34914 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34915 messages this way.
34916
34917 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34918 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34919 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34920 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34921 email is not desirable.
34922
34923 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34924 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34925 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34926 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34927 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34928 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34929 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34930
34931 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34932 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34933 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34934 before sending a message to the smart host.
34935
34936 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34937 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34938 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34939
34940 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34941 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34942 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34943 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34944 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34945 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34946 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34947
34948 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34949 following ways:
34950
34951 .ilist
34952 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34953 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34954 .next
34955 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34956 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34957 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34958 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34959 successful, a zero return code is given.
34960 .next
34961 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34962 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34963 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34964 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34965 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34966 are.
34967 .next
34968 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34969 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34970 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34971 .next
34972 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34973 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34974 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34975 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34976 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34977 .next
34978 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34979 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34980 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34981 .next
34982 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34983 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34984 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34985 are ever generated.
34986 .next
34987 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34988 .next
34989 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34990 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34991 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34992 .endlist
34993
34994 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34995 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34996 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34997 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34998 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34999 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
35000
35001
35002
35003
35004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35005 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35006
35007 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
35008 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
35009 .cindex "log" "types of"
35010 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
35011 and the panic log:
35012
35013 .ilist
35014 .cindex "main log"
35015 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
35016 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
35017 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
35018 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
35019 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
35020 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
35021 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
35022 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
35023 .next
35024 .cindex "reject log"
35025 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
35026 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
35027 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
35028 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
35029 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
35030 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
35031 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
35032 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
35033 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
35034 false.
35035 .next
35036 .cindex "panic log"
35037 .cindex "system log"
35038 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
35039 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
35040 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
35041 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
35042 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
35043 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
35044 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
35045 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
35046 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
35047 .endlist
35048
35049 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
35050 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
35051 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
35052 .code
35053 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
35054 by QUIT
35055 .endd
35056 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
35057 ways of changing this:
35058
35059 .ilist
35060 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
35061 you set
35062 .code
35063 timezone = UTC
35064 .endd
35065 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
35066 .next
35067 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
35068 example:
35069 .code
35070 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
35071 .endd
35072 .endlist
35073
35074 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35075 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35076 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
35077 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
35078 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
35079 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
35080
35081
35082
35083
35084 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
35085 .cindex "log" "destination"
35086 .cindex "log" "to file"
35087 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
35088 .cindex "syslog"
35089 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
35090 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
35091 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
35092 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
35093 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
35094 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
35095 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
35096
35097 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
35098 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
35099 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
35100 references to the host name:
35101 .code
35102 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
35103 .endd
35104 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
35105 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
35106 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
35107 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
35108 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
35109 log at all.
35110
35111 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
35112 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
35113 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
35114 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
35115 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
35116 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
35117 implying the use of a default path.
35118
35119 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
35120 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
35121 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
35122 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
35123 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
35124 equivalent to the setting:
35125 .code
35126 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
35127 .endd
35128 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
35129 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
35130 that is where the logs are written.
35131
35132 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
35133 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
35134
35135 Here are some examples of possible settings:
35136 .display
35137 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
35138 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
35139 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
35140 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
35141 .endd
35142 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
35143 error is logged.
35144
35145
35146
35147 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
35148 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35149 .cindex "cycling logs"
35150 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35151 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
35152 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
35153 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
35154 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
35155 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
35156 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
35157
35158 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
35159 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
35160 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
35161 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
35162 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
35163 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
35164 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
35165 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
35166 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
35167 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
35168 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
35169 renamed.
35170
35171
35172
35173 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
35174 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
35175 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
35176 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
35177 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
35178 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
35179 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
35180 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
35181 .code
35182 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
35183 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
35184 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
35185 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
35186 .endd
35187 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
35188 examples of names generated by the above examples:
35189 .code
35190 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
35191 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
35192 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
35193 /var/log/exim/main.200212
35194 .endd
35195 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
35196 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
35197 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
35198 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
35199
35200 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
35201 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
35202 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35203 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35204 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35205 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35206 log names:
35207 .code
35208 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35209 /var/log/exim-panic.log
35210 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35211 /var/log/exim/panic
35212 .endd
35213
35214
35215 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35216 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35217 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35218 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35219 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35220 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35221 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35222 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35223 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35224 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35225 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35226 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35227 the time and host name to each line.
35228 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35229
35230 .ilist
35231 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35232 .next
35233 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35234 .next
35235 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35236 .endlist
35237
35238 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35239 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35240 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35241 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35242
35243 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35244 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35245 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35246 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35247 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35248 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35249 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35250 RFC 3164, you should set
35251 .code
35252 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35253 .endd
35254 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35255 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35256
35257 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35258 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35259 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35260 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35261 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35262 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35263 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35264 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35265 name, and pid as added by syslog:
35266 .code
35267 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35268 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35269 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35270 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35271 [5/5] mple>)
35272 .endd
35273 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35274 (LOG_NOTICE):
35275 .code
35276 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35277 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35278 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35279 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35280 [5\18] .example>)
35281 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35282 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35283 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35284 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35285 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35286 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
35287 [12\18] F From: <>
35288 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35289 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
35290 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35291 [16\18] le>
35292 [17\18] B Bcc:
35293 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35294 .endd
35295 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35296 without modification.
35297
35298 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35299 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35300 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35301 where it is.
35302
35303
35304
35305 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35306 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35307 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35308 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35309 timestamp. The flags are:
35310 .display
35311 &`<=`& message arrival
35312 &`=>`& normal message delivery
35313 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
35314 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35315 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35316 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35317 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35318 .endd
35319
35320
35321 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35322 .cindex "log" "reception line"
35323 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35324 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35325 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35326 .code
35327 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35328 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35329 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35330 .endd
35331 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35332 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35333 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35334 .code
35335 R=<message id>
35336 .endd
35337 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35338
35339 .cindex "HELO"
35340 .cindex "EHLO"
35341 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35342 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35343 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35344 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35345 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35346 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35347 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35348 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35349 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35350 name in parentheses.
35351
35352 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35353 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35354 the log containing text like these examples:
35355 .code
35356 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35357 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35358 .endd
35359 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35360 on.
35361
35362 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35363 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35364 of Exim.
35365
35366 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35367 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35368 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35369 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35370 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35371 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35372 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35373 suite that was used.
35374
35375 .cindex log protocol
35376 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35377 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35378 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35379 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35380 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35381 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35382 authenticator name.
35383
35384 .cindex "size" "of message"
35385 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35386 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35387 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35388 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35389 other).
35390
35391 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35392 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35393
35394
35395
35396 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35397 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35398 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35399 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35400 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35401 to fit it on the page:
35402 .code
35403 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35404 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35405 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35406 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35407 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35408 .endd
35409 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35410 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35411 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35412 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35413 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35414
35415 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35416 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35417 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35418 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35419
35420 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35421 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35422 .display
35423 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35424 .endd
35425 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35426 parentheses afterwards.
35427
35428 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35429 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35430 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35431 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35432 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35433 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35434
35435 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35436 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35437 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35438 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35439 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35440
35441 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35442 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35443
35444 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35445 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35446
35447
35448 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35449 .cindex "discarded messages"
35450 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35451 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35452 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35453 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35454 .code
35455 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35456 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35457 .endd
35458 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35459 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35460 .code
35461 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35462 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35463 .endd
35464
35465
35466 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35467 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35468 .code
35469 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35470 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35471 .endd
35472 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35473 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35474 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35475 .code
35476 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35477 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35478 .endd
35479 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35480 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35481 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35482
35483
35484
35485 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35486 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35487 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35488 following form is logged:
35489 .code
35490 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35491 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35492 .endd
35493 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35494 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35495 .code
35496 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35497 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35498 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35499 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35500 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35501 .endd
35502 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35503 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35504 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35505 flagged with &`**`&.
35506
35507
35508
35509 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35510 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35511 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35512 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35513 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35514
35515
35516
35517 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35518 A line of the form
35519 .code
35520 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35521 .endd
35522 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35523 at the end of its processing.
35524
35525
35526
35527
35528 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35529 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35530 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35531 the following table:
35532 .display
35533 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35534 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35535 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35536 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35537 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35538 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35539 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35540 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35541 &`H `& host name and IP address
35542 &`I `& local interface used
35543 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35544 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35545 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35546 &`PRX `& on &'<='& and&`=>`& lines: proxy address
35547 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35548 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35549 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35550 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35551 &`S `& size of message
35552 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35553 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35554 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35555 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35556 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35557 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35558 .endd
35559
35560
35561 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35562 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35563 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35564
35565 .ilist
35566 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35567 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35568 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35569 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35570 during the first delivery attempt.
35571 .next
35572 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35573 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35574 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35575 .next
35576 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35577 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35578 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35579 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35580 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35581 doing.
35582 .next
35583 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35584 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35585 message:
35586 .olist
35587 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35588 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35589 .next
35590 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35591 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35592 .next
35593 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35594 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35595 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35596 .code
35597 errors_to = <>
35598 .endd
35599 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35600 .endlist olist
35601 .endlist ilist
35602
35603
35604
35605
35606
35607 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35608 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35609 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35610 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35611 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35612 example:
35613 .code
35614 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35615 .endd
35616 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35617 selection marked by asterisks:
35618 .display
35619 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35620 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35621 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35622 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35623 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35624 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35625 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35626 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35627 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35628 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35629 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35630 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35631 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35632 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35633 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35634 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35635 .new
35636 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35637 .wen
35638 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35639 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35640 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35641 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35642 &` pid `& Exim process id
35643 .new
35644 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
35645 .wen
35646 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35647 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35648 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35649 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35650 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35651 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35652 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35653 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35654 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35655 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35656 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35657 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35658 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35659 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35660 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35661 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35662 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35663 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35664 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35665 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35666 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35667 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35668
35669 &` all `& all of the above
35670 .endd
35671 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35672 section &<<SECID99>>&
35673
35674 More details on each of these items follows:
35675
35676 .ilist
35677 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35678 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35679 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35680 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35681 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35682 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35683 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35684 .next
35685 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35686 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35687 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35688 this log selector is set.
35689 .next
35690 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35691 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35692 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35693 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35694 such users cannot access the log).
35695 .next
35696 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35697 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35698 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35699 parentheses between them.
35700 .next
35701 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35702 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35703 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35704 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35705 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35706 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35707 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35708 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35709 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35710 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35711 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35712 between the caller and Exim.
35713 .next
35714 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35715 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35716 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35717 .next
35718 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35719 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35720 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35721 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35722 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35723 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35724 .next
35725 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35726 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35727 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35728 .next
35729 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35730 .cindex "size" "of message"
35731 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35732 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35733 .next
35734 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35735 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35736 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35737 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35738 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35739 .next
35740 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35741 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35742 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35743 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35744 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35745 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35746 .next
35747 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35748 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35749 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35750 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35751 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35752 .next
35753 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35754 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35755 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35756 client's ident port times out.
35757 .next
35758 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35759 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35760 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35761 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35762 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35763 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35764 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35765 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35766 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35767 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35768 .new
35769 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35770 .wen
35771 .next
35772 .new
35773 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
35774 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
35775 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
35776 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
35777 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
35778 on a proxied connection
35779 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection..
35780 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
35781 .wen
35782 .next
35783 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35784 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35785 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35786 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35787 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35788 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35789 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35790 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35791 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35792 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35793 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35794 .next
35795 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35796 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35797 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35798 .next
35799 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35800 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35801 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35802 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35803 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35804 .new
35805 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35806 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35807 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35808 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35809 .wen
35810 .next
35811 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35812 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35813 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35814 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35815 containing => tags) following the IP address.
35816 .new
35817 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35818 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35819 .wen
35820 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35821 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35822 local port is a random ephemeral port.
35823 .next
35824 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35825 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35826 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35827 immediately after the time and date.
35828 .next
35829 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35830 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35831 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35832 .next
35833 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35834 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35835 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35836 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35837 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35838 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35839 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35840 message has been successfully received.
35841 .next
35842 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35843 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35844 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35845 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35846 .next
35847 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35848 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35849 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35850 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35851 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35852 has taken place.
35853 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35854 in the list.
35855 .next
35856 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35857 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35858 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35859 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35860 .next
35861 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35862 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35863 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35864 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35865 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35866 .next
35867 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35868 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35869 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35870 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35871 attempt.
35872 .next
35873 .cindex "log" "return path"
35874 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35875 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35876 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35877 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35878 .next
35879 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35880 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35881 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35882 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35883 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35884 .next
35885 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35886 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35887 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35888 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35889 detail is lost.
35890 .next
35891 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35892 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35893 it is too big.
35894 .next
35895 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35896 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35897 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35898 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35899 it.
35900 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35901 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35902 .next
35903 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35904 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35905 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35906 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35907 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35908 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35909 response.
35910 .next
35911 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35912 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35913 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35914 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35915 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35916 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35917 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35918 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35919 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35920 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35921
35922 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35923 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35924 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35925 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35926 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35927 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35928 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35929 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35930 .next
35931 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35932 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35933 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35934 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35935 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35936 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35937 .next
35938 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35939 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35940 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35941 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35942 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35943 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35944 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35945 already have their own log lines.
35946
35947 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35948 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35949 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35950 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35951 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35952 the same logging options.
35953
35954 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35955 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35956 .code
35957 C=EHLO,QUIT
35958 .endd
35959 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35960 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35961 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35962 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35963 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35964 .next
35965 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35966 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35967 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35968 was accepted or used.
35969 .next
35970 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35971 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35972 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35973 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35974 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35975 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35976 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35977 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35978 .next
35979 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35980 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35981 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35982 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35983 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35984 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35985 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35986 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35987 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35988 .next
35989 .cindex "log" "subject"
35990 .cindex "subject, logging"
35991 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35992 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35993 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35994 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35995 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35996 .next
35997 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35998 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35999 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
36000 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
36001 .next
36002 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
36003 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
36004 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36005 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
36006 .next
36007 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
36008 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
36009 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
36010 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
36011 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
36012 .next
36013 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
36014 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
36015 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
36016 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
36017 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
36018 .next
36019 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
36020 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
36021 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
36022 .endlist
36023
36024
36025 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
36026 .cindex "message" "log file for"
36027 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
36028 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
36029 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
36030 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
36031 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
36032 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
36033 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
36034 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
36035 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
36036 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
36037 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
36038
36039 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
36040 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
36041 &%message_logs%& option false.
36042 .ecindex IIDloggen
36043
36044
36045
36046
36047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36049
36050 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
36051 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
36052 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
36053 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
36054 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
36055
36056 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
36057 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
36058 "list what Exim processes are doing"
36059 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
36060 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
36061 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
36062 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
36063 various criteria"
36064 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
36065 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
36066 "extract statistics from the log"
36067 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
36068 "check address acceptance from given IP"
36069 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
36070 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
36071 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
36072 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
36073 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
36074 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
36075 .endtable
36076
36077 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
36078 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
36079 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
36080
36081
36082
36083
36084 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
36085 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
36086 .cindex "process, querying"
36087 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
36088 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
36089 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
36090 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
36091 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
36092 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
36093 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
36094 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
36095 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
36096
36097 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
36098 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
36099 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
36100
36101
36102 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
36103 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
36104 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
36105 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
36106 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
36107 options:
36108 .display
36109 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
36110 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
36111 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
36112 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
36113 .endd
36114 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
36115 .code
36116 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
36117 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
36118 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
36119 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
36120 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
36121 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
36122 .endd
36123 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
36124 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
36125
36126
36127
36128 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
36129 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
36130 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
36131 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
36132 .code
36133 exim -bpu
36134 .endd
36135 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
36136 .code
36137 exim -bp
36138 .endd
36139 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
36140 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
36141
36142 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
36143 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
36144
36145 .vlist
36146 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
36147 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36148 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
36149 .code
36150 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
36151 .endd
36152 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
36153 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
36154 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
36155
36156 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
36157 Match against the size field.
36158
36159 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36160 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
36161
36162 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
36163 Match messages that are older than the given time.
36164
36165 .vitem &*-z*&
36166 Match only frozen messages.
36167
36168 .vitem &*-x*&
36169 Match only non-frozen messages.
36170 .endlist
36171
36172 The following options control the format of the output:
36173
36174 .vlist
36175 .vitem &*-c*&
36176 Display only the count of matching messages.
36177
36178 .vitem &*-l*&
36179 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
36180 the default.
36181
36182 .vitem &*-i*&
36183 Display message ids only.
36184
36185 .vitem &*-b*&
36186 Brief format &-- one line per message.
36187
36188 .vitem &*-R*&
36189 Display messages in reverse order.
36190
36191 .vitem &*-a*&
36192 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
36193 .endlist
36194
36195 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
36196
36197
36198
36199 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
36200 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
36201 .cindex "queue" "summary"
36202 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
36203 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
36204 running a command such as
36205 .code
36206 exim -bp | exiqsumm
36207 .endd
36208 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
36209 it, as in the following example:
36210 .code
36211 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
36212 .endd
36213 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
36214 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
36215 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
36216 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
36217
36218 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36219 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36220 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36221 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36222 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36223 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36224 sender.
36225
36226 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36227 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36228 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36229 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36230 level"& addresses).
36231
36232
36233
36234
36235 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36236 "SECTextspeinf"
36237 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36238 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36239 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36240 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36241 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36242 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36243 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36244 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36245 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36246 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36247 .display
36248 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36249 .endd
36250 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36251
36252 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36253 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36254 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36255
36256 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36257 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36258 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36259 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36260 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36261
36262 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36263 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36264 regular expression.
36265
36266 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36267 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36268
36269 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36270 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36271 normally.
36272
36273 Example of &%-M%&:
36274 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36275 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36276 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36277 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36278 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36279 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36280 search term.
36281
36282 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36283 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36284 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36285 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36286 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36287
36288
36289 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36290 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
36291 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36292 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36293 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36294 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36295 the &%--help%& option.
36296
36297
36298 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36299 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36300 .cindex "cycling logs"
36301 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36302 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36303 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36304 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36305 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36306 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36307 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36308 .ilist
36309 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36310 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36311 .next
36312 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36313 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36314 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36315 configuration.
36316 .endlist
36317
36318 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36319 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36320 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36321 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36322 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36323 logs are handled similarly.
36324
36325 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36326 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36327 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36328 any existing log files.
36329
36330 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36331 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36332 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36333 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36334 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36335 .code
36336 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36337 .endd
36338 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36339 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36340
36341
36342
36343 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36344 .cindex "statistics"
36345 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36346 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36347 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36348 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36349 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36350
36351 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36352 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36353 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36354 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36355 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36356 .code
36357 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36358 .endd
36359 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36360 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36361 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36362 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36363 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36364 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36365 also produced per user.
36366
36367 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36368 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36369 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36370 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36371 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36372
36373 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36374 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36375 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36376 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36377 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36378 an entirely separate message.
36379
36380 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36381 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36382 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36383 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36384 least one address that failed.
36385
36386 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36387 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36388 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36389 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36390 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36391 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36392 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36393
36394 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36395 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36396 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36397
36398 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36399 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36400 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36401 .code
36402 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36403 .endd
36404
36405 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36406 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36407 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36408 .cindex "checking access"
36409 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36410 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36411 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36412 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36413 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36414 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36415
36416 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36417 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36418 .code
36419 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36420 .endd
36421 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36422 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36423 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36424 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36425 .code
36426 Rejected:
36427 550 Relay not permitted
36428 .endd
36429 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36430 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36431 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36432 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36433 you can use:
36434 .code
36435 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36436 -f himself@there.example
36437 .endd
36438 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36439 mandatory arguments.
36440
36441 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36442 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36443 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36444
36445
36446
36447 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36448 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36449 .cindex "building DBM files"
36450 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36451 .cindex "lower casing"
36452 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36453 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36454 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36455 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36456 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36457 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36458
36459 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36460 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36461 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36462 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36463 files.
36464
36465 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36466 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36467 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36468 well.
36469
36470 .cindex "USE_DB"
36471 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36472 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36473 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36474 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36475 .code
36476 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36477 .endd
36478 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36479 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36480
36481 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36482 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36483 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36484 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36485 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36486 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36487
36488 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36489 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36490 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36491 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36492 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36493 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36494 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36495 return code is 2.
36496
36497
36498
36499
36500 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36501 .cindex "retry" "times"
36502 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36503 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36504 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36505 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36506 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36507 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36508 output. For example:
36509 .code
36510 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36511 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36512 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36513 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36514 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36515 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36516 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36517 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36518 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36519 past final cutoff time
36520 .endd
36521 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36522 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36523 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36524 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36525 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36526 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36527 run very often.
36528
36529 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36530 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36531 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36532 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36533 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36534 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36535
36536
36537
36538 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36539 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36540 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36541 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36542 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36543 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36544 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36545
36546 .ilist
36547 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36548 .next
36549 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36550 for remote hosts
36551 .next
36552 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36553 .next
36554 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36555 .next
36556 &'misc'&: other hints data
36557 .endlist
36558
36559 The &'misc'& database is used for
36560
36561 .ilist
36562 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36563 .next
36564 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36565 &(smtp)& transport)
36566 .next
36567 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36568 in a transport)
36569 .endlist
36570
36571
36572
36573 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36574 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36575 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36576 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36577 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36578 .code
36579 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36580 .endd
36581 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36582 .code
36583 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36584 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36585 .endd
36586 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36587 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36588 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36589 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36590 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36591 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36592 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36593 and a textual description of the error.
36594
36595 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36596 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36597 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36598 exceeded.
36599
36600 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36601 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36602 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36603 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36604 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36605 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36606 cross-references.
36607
36608
36609
36610 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36611 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36612 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36613 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36614 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36615 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36616 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36617 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36618 updated sufficiently often.
36619
36620 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36621 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36622 the retry database:
36623 .code
36624 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36625 .endd
36626 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36627 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36628 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36629 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36630 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36631 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36632 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36633 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36634 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36635 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36636 whenever it removes information from the database.
36637
36638 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36639 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36640 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36641 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36642 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36643
36644 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36645 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36646 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36647 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36648 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36649 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36650 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36651 tidied.
36652
36653 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36654 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36655
36656
36657
36658
36659 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36660 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36661 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36662 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36663 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36664 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36665 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36666 displayed.
36667
36668 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36669 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36670 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36671 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36672 by new data, for example:
36673 .code
36674 > 4 951102:1000
36675 .endd
36676 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36677 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36678 used as optional separators.
36679
36680
36681
36682
36683 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36684 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36685 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36686 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36687 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36688 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36689 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36690 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36691 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36692 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36693 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36694 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36695 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36696
36697 .vlist
36698 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36699 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36700
36701 .vitem &%-flock%&
36702 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36703 supports it.
36704
36705 .vitem &%-interval%&
36706 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36707 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36708
36709 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36710 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36711
36712 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36713 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36714
36715 .vitem &%-q%&
36716 Suppress verification output.
36717
36718 .vitem &%-retries%&
36719 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36720 the lock (default 10).
36721
36722 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36723 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36724 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36725 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36726 subsequently sees.
36727
36728 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36729 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36730 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36731 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36732
36733 .vitem &%-v%&
36734 Generate verbose output.
36735 .endlist
36736
36737 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36738 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36739 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36740 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36741 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36742 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36743 more than 30 minutes old.
36744
36745 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36746 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36747 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36748 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36749 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36750 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36751
36752 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36753 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36754 suppresses all output except error messages.
36755
36756 A command such as
36757 .code
36758 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36759 .endd
36760 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36761 .display
36762 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36763 <&'some commands'&>
36764 &`End`&
36765 .endd
36766 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36767 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36768 such as
36769 .code
36770 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36771 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36772 .endd
36773 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36774 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36775 .ecindex IIDutils
36776
36777
36778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36780
36781 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36782 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36783 .cindex "X-windows"
36784 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36785 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36786 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36787 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36788 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36789 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36790 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36791 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36792
36793
36794
36795 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36796 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36797 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36798 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36799 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36800 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36801 parameters are for.
36802
36803 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36804 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36805 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36806 .code
36807 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36808 .endd
36809 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36810 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36811 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36812 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36813 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36814
36815 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36816 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36817 .code
36818 Eximon*background: gray94
36819 .endd
36820 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36821 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36822 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36823 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36824 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36825 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36826 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36827 .code
36828 xrdb -merge <<End
36829 Eximon*highlight: gray
36830 End
36831 .endd
36832 .cindex "admin user"
36833 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36834 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36835
36836 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36837 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36838 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36839 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36840 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36841
36842 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36843 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36844 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36845 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36846 different parts of the display.
36847
36848
36849
36850
36851 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36852 .cindex "stripchart"
36853 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36854 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36855 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36856 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36857 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36858 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36859 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36860 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36861 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36862
36863 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36864 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36865 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36866 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36867
36868 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36869 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36870 to a single partition.
36871
36872 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36873 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36874 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36875 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36876 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36877 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36878 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36879
36880
36881
36882
36883 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36884 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36885 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36886 .cindex "window size"
36887 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36888 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36889 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36890 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36891 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36892 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36893
36894 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36895 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36896 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36897 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36898
36899 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36900 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36901 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36902 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36903 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36904 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36905
36906 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36907 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36908 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36909
36910
36911
36912 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36913 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36914 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36915 the main log is maintained.
36916 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36917 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36918 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36919 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36920 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36921
36922 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36923 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36924 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36925 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36926 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36927 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36928 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36929 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36930 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36931 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36932 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36933
36934 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36935 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36936 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36937 It cannot go further back up the log.
36938
36939 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36940 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36941 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36942 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36943 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36944 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36945
36946 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36947 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36948 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36949 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36950 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36951 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36952
36953 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36954 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36955 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36956 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36957 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36958 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36959 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36960 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36961 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36962 window.
36963
36964
36965
36966 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36967 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36968 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36969 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36970 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36971 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36972 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36973 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36974 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36975 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36976
36977 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36978 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36979 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36980 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36981 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36982 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36983 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36984
36985 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36986 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36987 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36988 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36989 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36990 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36991 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36992
36993 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36994 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36995 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36996 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36997
36998 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36999 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
37000 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
37001 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
37002 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
37003 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
37004 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
37005 not shown.
37006
37007 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
37008 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
37009
37010 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
37011 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
37012 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
37013 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
37014 display is updated.
37015
37016
37017
37018 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
37019 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
37020 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
37021 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
37022 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
37023 any selected text.
37024
37025 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
37026 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
37027 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
37028 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
37029 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
37030 .code
37031 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
37032 .endd
37033 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
37034 follows:
37035
37036 .ilist
37037 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
37038 in a new text window.
37039 .next
37040 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
37041 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
37042 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
37043 .next
37044 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
37045 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
37046 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
37047 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
37048 .next
37049 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
37050 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
37051 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
37052 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
37053 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
37054 .next
37055 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
37056 that the message be frozen.
37057 .next
37058 .cindex "thawing messages"
37059 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
37060 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
37061 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
37062 that the message be thawed.
37063 .next
37064 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
37065 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
37066 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
37067 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
37068 .next
37069 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
37070 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
37071 message.
37072 .next
37073 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
37074 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37075 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37076 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37077 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
37078 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
37079 which case no action is taken.
37080 .next
37081 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
37082 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
37083 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
37084 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
37085 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
37086 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
37087 case no action is taken.
37088 .next
37089 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
37090 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
37091 .next
37092 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
37093 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
37094 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
37095 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
37096 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
37097 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
37098 the address is qualified with that domain.
37099 .endlist
37100
37101 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
37102 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
37103 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
37104 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
37105 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
37106 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
37107 if no output is generated.
37108
37109 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
37110 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
37111 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
37112 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
37113
37114 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
37115 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
37116 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
37117 .ecindex IIDeximon
37118
37119
37120
37121
37122
37123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37125
37126 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
37127 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
37128 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
37129 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
37130
37131 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
37132 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
37133 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
37134 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
37135 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
37136 its security as compared with other MTAs.
37137
37138 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
37139 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
37140 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
37141 as soon as possible.
37142
37143
37144 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
37145 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
37146 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
37147 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
37148 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
37149 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
37150
37151 .ilist
37152 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
37153 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
37154 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
37155 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
37156 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
37157 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
37158
37159 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
37160 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
37161 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
37162 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
37163 .next
37164
37165 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
37166 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
37167 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
37168 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
37169 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
37170 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
37171 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
37172 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
37173 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
37174 separate commands.
37175
37176 .next
37177 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
37178 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
37179 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
37180 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
37181 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
37182 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
37183 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
37184 .next
37185 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
37186 is disabled.
37187 .next
37188 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
37189 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
37190 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
37191 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
37192 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
37193 .endlist
37194
37195
37196
37197 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
37198 .cindex "setuid"
37199 .cindex "root privilege"
37200 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
37201 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
37202 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
37203 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
37204 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
37205 is required for two things:
37206
37207 .ilist
37208 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
37209 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
37210 not required.
37211 .next
37212 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
37213 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
37214 configuration.
37215 .endlist
37216
37217 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
37218 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37219 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37220 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37221 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37222 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37223 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37224 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37225
37226 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37227 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37228 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37229
37230 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37231 uid and gid in the following cases:
37232
37233 .ilist
37234 .oindex "&%-C%&"
37235 .oindex "&%-D%&"
37236 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37237 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37238 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37239 the calling process.
37240 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37241 option may not be used at all.
37242 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37243 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37244 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37245 .next
37246 .oindex "&%-be%&"
37247 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
37248 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
37249 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37250 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37251 calling process.
37252 .next
37253 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37254 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37255 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37256 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37257 testing address verification
37258 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
37259 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
37260 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37261 option).
37262 .next
37263 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37264 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37265 .endlist
37266
37267 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37268
37269 .ilist
37270 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37271 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37272 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37273 will be used during message reception.
37274 .next
37275 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37276 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37277 .next
37278 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37279 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37280 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37281 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37282 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37283 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37284 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37285 generating bounce and warning messages.
37286
37287 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37288 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37289 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37290 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37291 .next
37292 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37293 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37294 .endlist
37295
37296
37297
37298
37299 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37300 .cindex "privilege, running without"
37301 .cindex "unprivileged running"
37302 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37303 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37304 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37305 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37306 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37307 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37308 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37309 to any other uid.
37310
37311 .cindex SIGHUP
37312 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37313 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37314 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37315 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37316
37317 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37318 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37319 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37320 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37321 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37322
37323 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37324 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37325 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37326 effect.
37327
37328 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37329 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37330 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37331
37332 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37333 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37334 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37335 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37336 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37337 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37338 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37339 address this problem at this time.
37340
37341 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37342 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37343 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37344 be used in the most straightforward way.
37345
37346 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37347 number of restrictions on what you can do:
37348
37349 .ilist
37350 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37351 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37352 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37353 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37354 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37355 .next
37356 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37357 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37358 .next
37359 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37360 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37361 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37362 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37363 .next
37364 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37365 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37366
37367 .olist
37368 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37369 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37370 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37371 .next
37372 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37373 owned by the Exim user.
37374 .next
37375 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37376 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37377 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37378 .endlist olist
37379 .endlist ilist
37380
37381
37382 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37383 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37384 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37385 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37386
37387 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37388 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37389
37390
37391
37392
37393 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37394 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37395 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37396
37397
37398
37399 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37400 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37401 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37402 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37403 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37404 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37405 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37406
37407 .ilist
37408 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37409 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37410 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37411 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37412 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37413 .next
37414 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37415 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37416 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37417 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37418 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37419 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37420 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37421 .next
37422 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37423 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37424 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37425 .next
37426 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37427 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37428 .next
37429 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37430 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37431 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37432 .next
37433 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37434 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37435 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37436 of opaque strings.
37437 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37438 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37439 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37440 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37441 .endlist
37442
37443
37444
37445
37446 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37447 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37448 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37449 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37450 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37451 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37452 are some issues to be aware of:
37453
37454 .ilist
37455 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37456 .next
37457 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37458 .next
37459 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37460 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37461 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37462 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37463 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37464 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37465 data.
37466 .next
37467 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37468 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37469 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37470 .next
37471 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37472 expected to yield one result.
37473 .endlist
37474
37475
37476
37477
37478 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37479 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37480 .cindex "IP source routing"
37481 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37482 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37483 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37484 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37485
37486
37487
37488 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37489 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37490 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37491
37492
37493
37494
37495 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37496 .cindex "trusted users"
37497 .cindex "admin user"
37498 .cindex "privileged user"
37499 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37500 .cindex "user" "admin"
37501 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37502 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37503 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37504 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37505 permit a remote host to be specified.
37506
37507 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37508 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37509 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37510 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37511 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37512 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37513 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37514
37515 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37516 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37517 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37518 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37519 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37520
37521 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37522 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37523 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37524 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37525 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37526
37527 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37528 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37529 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37530 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37531 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37532 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37533 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37534 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37535
37536 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37537 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37538 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37539 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37540 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37541 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37542 files.
37543
37544
37545
37546 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37547 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37548 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37549 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37550 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37551 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37552
37553
37554
37555 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37556 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37557 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37558 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37559 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37560 this.
37561
37562
37563
37564 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37565 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37566 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37567 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37568 converted output.
37569
37570
37571
37572 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37573 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37574 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37575 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37576 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37577
37578
37579
37580 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37581 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37582 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37583 loading it.
37584
37585
37586 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37587 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37588 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37589 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37590 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37591 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37592 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37593
37594 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37595 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37596 string.
37597
37598
37599
37600 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37601 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37602 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37603 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37604
37605
37606
37607 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37608 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37609 enough to hold the result.
37610 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37611
37612
37613
37614
37615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37617
37618 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37619 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37620 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37621 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37622 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37623 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37624 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37625 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37626 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37627 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37628 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37629 themselves are recoverable.
37630
37631 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37632 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37633 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37634
37635 .ilist
37636 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37637 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37638 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37639 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37640 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37641 .next
37642 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37643 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37644 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37645 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37646 will always be the case.
37647 .next
37648 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37649 .next
37650 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37651 signature.
37652 .endlist
37653 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37654
37655 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37656 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37657 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37658 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37659 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37660 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37661 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37662 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37663 attempt.
37664
37665 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37666 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37667 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37668 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37669 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37670 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37671 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37672 normally the Exim user.
37673
37674 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37675 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37676 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37677 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37678 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37679 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37680 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37681 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37682
37683 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37684 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37685 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37686 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37687
37688 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37689 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37690
37691 .vlist
37692 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37693 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37694 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37695 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37696 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37697 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37698 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37699 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37700 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37701 newlines.
37702
37703 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37704 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37705 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37706 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37707 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37708 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37709
37710 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37711 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37712 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37713 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37714 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37715 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37716
37717 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37718 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37719 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37720
37721 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37722 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37723 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37724 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37725 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37726
37727 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37728 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37729 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37730 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37731 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37732
37733 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37734 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37735 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37736
37737 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37738 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37739 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37740
37741 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37742 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37743 present.
37744
37745 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37746 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37747 present if the number is greater than zero.
37748
37749 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37750 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37751 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37752
37753 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37754 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37755 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37756
37757 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37758 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37759 command.
37760
37761 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37762 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37763 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37764 messages.
37765
37766 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37767 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37768 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37769 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37770
37771 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37772 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37773 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37774
37775 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37776 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37777 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37778 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37779 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37780 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37781
37782 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37783 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37784 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37785 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37786 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37787
37788 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37789 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37790 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37791 generated messages.
37792
37793 .vitem &%-local%&
37794 The message is from a local sender.
37795
37796 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37797 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37798
37799 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37800 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37801 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37802 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37803
37804 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37805 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37806 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37807
37808 .vitem &%-N%&
37809 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37810 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37811 &%-N%& is assumed.
37812
37813 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37814 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37815 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37816
37817 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37818 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37819 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37820
37821 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37822 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37823 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37824
37825 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37826 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37827 certificate was verified by the server.
37828
37829 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37830 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37831 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37832
37833 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37834 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37835 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37836 certificate.
37837 .endlist
37838
37839 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37840 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37841 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37842 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37843 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37844 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37845 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37846 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37847 addresses are complete.
37848
37849 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37850 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37851 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37852 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37853 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37854 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37855 .code
37856 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37857 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37858 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37859 .endd
37860 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37861 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37862 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37863 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37864 example:
37865 .code
37866 4
37867 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37868 darcy@austen.fict.example
37869 rdo@foundation
37870 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37871 .endd
37872 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37873 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37874 line is of the following form:
37875 .display
37876 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37877 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37878 .endd
37879 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37880 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37881 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37882 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37883 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37884 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37885 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37886 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37887
37888
37889 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37890 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37891 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37892 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37893 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37894 following:
37895
37896 .table2 50pt
37897 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37898 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37899 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37900 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37901 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37902 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37903 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37904 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37905 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37906 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37907 .endtable
37908
37909 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37910 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37911 typical set of headers:
37912 .code
37913 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37914 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37915 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37916 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37917 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37918 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37919 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37920 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37921 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37922 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37923 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37924 .endd
37925 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37926 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37927 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37928 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37929 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37930 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37931
37932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37933 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37934
37935 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37936 "DKIM Support"
37937 .cindex "DKIM"
37938
37939 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37940 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37941 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37942 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37943
37944 .new
37945 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
37946 .wen
37947 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
37948
37949 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37950 .olist
37951 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37952 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37953 (including transport filters)
37954 except cutthrough delivery.
37955 .next
37956 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37957 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37958 different signature contexts.
37959 .endlist
37960
37961 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37962 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37963 Exim's standard controls.
37964
37965 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37966 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37967 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37968 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37969 .code
37970 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37971 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37972 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37973 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37974 .endd
37975 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37976 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37977 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37978 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37979 senders).
37980
37981
37982 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37983 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37984
37985 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37986 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37987
37988 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37989 MANDATORY:
37990 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37991 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37992
37993 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37994 MANDATORY:
37995 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37996 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37997 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37998 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37999
38000 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
38001 MANDATORY:
38002 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
38003 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
38004 The result can either
38005 .ilist
38006 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
38007 .next
38008 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
38009 the private key.
38010 .next
38011 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
38012 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
38013 is set.
38014 .endlist
38015
38016 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
38017 OPTIONAL:
38018 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
38019 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
38020 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
38021 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
38022
38023 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
38024 OPTIONAL:
38025 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
38026 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
38027 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
38028 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
38029 variables here.
38030
38031 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
38032 OPTIONAL:
38033 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
38034 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
38035 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
38036 used.
38037
38038
38039 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
38040 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
38041
38042 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
38043 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
38044 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
38045 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
38046 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
38047 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
38048 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
38049
38050 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
38051 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
38052 runtime of the ACL.
38053
38054 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
38055 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
38056 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
38057 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
38058
38059 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
38060 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
38061 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
38062 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
38063 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
38064 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
38065 it defaults as:
38066 .code
38067 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
38068 .endd
38069 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
38070 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
38071 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
38072 .code
38073 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
38074 .endd
38075 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
38076 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
38077 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
38078 .code
38079 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
38080 .endd
38081
38082 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
38083 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
38084
38085
38086 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
38087 available (from most to least important):
38088
38089
38090 .vlist
38091 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
38092 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
38093 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
38094 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
38095 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
38096 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
38097 .ilist
38098 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
38099 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38100 .next
38101 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
38102 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38103 .next
38104 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
38105 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
38106 .next
38107 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
38108 .endlist
38109 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
38110 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
38111 "fail" or "invalid". One of
38112 .ilist
38113 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
38114 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
38115 .next
38116 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
38117 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
38118 .next
38119 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
38120 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
38121 means that the message body was modified in transit.
38122 .next
38123 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
38124 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
38125 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
38126 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
38127 .endlist
38128 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
38129 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
38130 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
38131 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38132 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
38133 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
38134 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
38135 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
38136 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
38137 The key record selector string.
38138 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
38139 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
38140 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
38141 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38142 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
38143 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
38144 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
38145 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
38146 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
38147 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
38148 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
38149 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
38150 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
38151 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
38152 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
38153 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
38154 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
38155 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
38156 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
38157 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
38158 integer size comparisons against this value.
38159 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
38160 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
38161 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
38162 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
38163 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
38164 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
38165 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
38166 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38167 in the key record.
38168 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
38169 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
38170 in the key record.
38171 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
38172 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
38173 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
38174 Number of bits in the key.
38175 .endlist
38176
38177 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
38178
38179 .vlist
38180 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
38181 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
38182 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
38183 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
38184 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
38185
38186 .code
38187 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
38188 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
38189 sender_domains = gmail.com
38190 dkim_signers = gmail.com
38191 dkim_status = none
38192 .endd
38193
38194 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
38195 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
38196 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
38197 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
38198
38199 .code
38200 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
38201 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
38202 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
38203 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
38204 .endd
38205
38206 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
38207 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
38208 for more information of what they mean.
38209 .endlist
38210
38211 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38212 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38213
38214 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
38215 "Proxy support"
38216 .cindex "proxy support"
38217 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
38218
38219 .new
38220 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
38221 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
38222
38223
38224 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
38225 .cindex proxy inbound
38226 .cindex proxy "server side"
38227 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
38228 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
38229
38230 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
38231 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
38232 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
38233 in Local/Makefile.
38234
38235 It was built on specifications from:
38236 http://haproxy.1wt.eu/download/1.5/doc/proxy-protocol.txt
38237 That URL was revised in May 2014 to version 2 spec:
38238 http://git.1wt.eu/web?p=haproxy.git;a=commitdiff;h=afb768340c9d7e50d8e
38239
38240 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
38241 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
38242 to distribute load.
38243 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
38244 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
38245 There is no logging if a host passes or
38246 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
38247 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
38248
38249 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
38250 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
38251 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
38252
38253 The following expansion variables are usable
38254 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
38255 of the proxy):
38256 .display
38257 &'proxy_host_address '& internal IP address of the proxy
38258 &'proxy_host_port '& internal TCP port of the proxy
38259 &'proxy_target_address '& external IP address of the proxy
38260 &'proxy_target_port '& external TCP port of the proxy
38261 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
38262 .endd
38263 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_host_address$& is empty
38264 there was a protocol error.
38265
38266 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
38267 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
38268 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
38269 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
38270 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
38271 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
38272 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
38273 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
38274 A possible solution is:
38275 .display
38276 # Set max number of connections per host
38277 LIMIT = 5
38278 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
38279 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
38280
38281 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
38282 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
38283 .endd
38284
38285
38286
38287 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
38288 .cindex proxy outbound
38289 .cindex proxy "client side"
38290 .cindex proxy SOCKS
38291 .cindex SOCKS proxy
38292 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
38293 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
38294 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
38295 Local/Makefile.
38296
38297 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
38298 on an smtp transport.
38299 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
38300 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
38301 Each proxy specifier is a list
38302 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
38303 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
38304
38305 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
38306 The list of options is in the following table:
38307 .display
38308 &'auth '& authentication method
38309 &'name '& authentication username
38310 &'pass '& authentication password
38311 &'port '& tcp port
38312 &'tmo '& connection timeout
38313 &'pri '& priority
38314 &'weight '& selection bias
38315 .endd
38316
38317 More details on each of these options follows:
38318
38319 .ilist
38320 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
38321 .cindex proxy authentication
38322 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
38323 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
38324 for access to the proxy.
38325 Default is &"none"&.
38326 .next
38327 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
38328 Default is empty.
38329 .next
38330 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
38331 Default is empty.
38332 .next
38333 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
38334 Default is 1080.
38335 .next
38336 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
38337 Default is 5.
38338 .next
38339 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
38340 higher values being tried first.
38341 The default priority is 1.
38342 .next
38343 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
38344 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
38345 weighted by this value.
38346 The default value for selection bias is 1.
38347 .endlist
38348
38349 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
38350 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
38351 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
38352
38353 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
38354 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
38355 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
38356 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
38357 .wen
38358
38359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38361
38362 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
38363 "Internationalisation""
38364 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
38365 .cindex EAI
38366 .cindex i18n
38367 .cindex UTF-8 "mail name handling"
38368
38369 .new
38370 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
38371 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
38372 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
38373
38374 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
38375 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
38376 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
38377 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
38378 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
38379 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
38380
38381 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
38382 international handling for the message is enabled and
38383 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
38384
38385 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
38386 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
38387 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
38388 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
38389
38390 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
38391 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
38392 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
38393 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
38394
38395 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
38396 components expanded to a-label form,
38397 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
38398 form of the name.
38399
38400 .cindex log protocol
38401 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
38402 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
38403 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
38404
38405 The following expansion operator can be used:
38406 .code
38407 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
38408 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
38409 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
38410 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
38411 .endd
38412
38413 ACLs may use the following modifier:
38414 .display
38415 control = utf8_downconvert
38416 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
38417 .endd
38418 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
38419 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
38420 Message Submission Agent context.
38421 If a value is appended it may be:
38422 .display
38423 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
38424 &`0 `& no downconversion
38425 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
38426 .endd
38427
38428 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
38429 is initially set to -1.
38430
38431
38432 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
38433 Configurations supporting these should inspect
38434 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
38435
38436 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
38437 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
38438 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
38439
38440 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
38441 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
38442
38443
38444
38445 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
38446 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
38447 the following expansion operator can be used:
38448 .code
38449 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
38450 .endd
38451
38452 The string is converted from the charset specified by
38453 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
38454 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
38455 to the
38456 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
38457 with the following exception: All occurences of <sep>
38458 (which has to be a single character)
38459 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
38460 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
38461
38462 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
38463 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
38464
38465 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
38466 by many other IMAP servers.
38467
38468 Examples:
38469 .display
38470 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
38471 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
38472 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
38473 .endd
38474
38475 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
38476 must be representable in UTF-16.
38477
38478 .wen
38479
38480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38482
38483 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
38484 "Events"
38485 .cindex events
38486
38487 .new
38488 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
38489 of points. It was originally invented to giave a way to do customised logging
38490 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
38491 processing actions.
38492
38493 Most installations will never need to use Events.
38494 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
38495 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
38496
38497 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
38498 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
38499 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
38500
38501 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
38502 An example might look like:
38503 .cindex logging custom
38504 .code
38505 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
38506 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
38507 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
38508 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
38509 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
38510 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
38511 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
38512 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
38513 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
38514 } {}}
38515 .endd
38516
38517 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
38518 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
38519 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
38520
38521 The current list of events is:
38522 .display
38523 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
38524 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
38525 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
38526 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
38527 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
38528 &`msg:fail:delivery after main `& per recipient
38529 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
38530 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
38531 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
38532 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
38533 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
38534 .endd
38535 New event types may be added in future.
38536
38537 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
38538 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
38539 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
38540
38541 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
38542 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
38543 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
38544
38545 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
38546 with the event type:
38547 .display
38548 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation mssage
38549 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
38550 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
38551 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
38552 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
38553 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
38554 .endd
38555
38556 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
38557
38558 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
38559 however due to the multiple contextx that Exim operates in during
38560 the course of its processing:
38561 .ilist
38562 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
38563 transport call
38564 .next
38565 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
38566 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
38567 .endlist
38568 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
38569 a useful way of writing to the main log.
38570
38571 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
38572 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
38573 following will be forced:
38574 .display
38575 &`msg:delivery `& (ignored)
38576 &`msg:host:defer `& (ignored)
38577 &`msg:fail:delivery`& (ignored)
38578 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
38579 &`tcp:close `& (ignored)
38580 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
38581 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
38582 .endd
38583 No other use is made of the result string.
38584
38585 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
38586 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
38587 the target system.
38588
38589 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
38590 chain element received on the connection.
38591 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
38592 loaded locally.
38593 .wen
38594
38595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38597
38598 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
38599 "Adding drivers or lookups"
38600 .cindex "adding drivers"
38601 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
38602 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
38603 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
38604 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
38605
38606 .olist
38607 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38608 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38609 .next
38610 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38611 .display
38612 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38613 .endd
38614 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38615 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38616 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38617 .next
38618 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38619 .code
38620 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38621 .endd
38622 .next
38623 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38624 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38625 .next
38626 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38627 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38628 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38629 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38630 simple form that most lookups have.
38631 .next
38632 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38633 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38634 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38635 .next
38636 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38637 &_src_&.
38638 .next
38639 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38640 as for other drivers and lookups.
38641 .endlist
38642
38643 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38644 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38645 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38646 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38647 searched using a binary chop procedure.
38648
38649 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38650 the interface that is expected.
38651
38652
38653
38654
38655 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38657
38658 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38659 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38660 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38661 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38662 . processors.
38663 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38664
38665 .literal xml
38666 <?sdop
38667 format="newpage"
38668 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38669 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38670 ?>
38671 .literal off
38672
38673 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
38674 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38675 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38676
38677
38678 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38679 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////